Chapter 3—Specialist liability rules
Part 3‑32—Co‑operatives and mutual entities
Division 315—Demutualisation of private health insurers
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 315
315‑A Capital gains and losses
connected with a demutualisation of a private health insurer to be disregarded
315‑B Cost base of certain shares
and rights in private health insurers
315‑C Lost policy holders trust
315‑D Special cost base rules for
certain shares and rights in holding companies
315‑E Special CGT rule for legal
personal representatives and beneficiaries
315‑F Non‑CGT consequences of
demutualisation
Guide to Division 315
315‑1 What this Division is about
This Division sets
out the taxation consequences of the demutualisation of private health
insurers.
Policy holders,
demutualising health insurers and certain other entities can disregard capital
gains and losses arising under a demutualisation (see Subdivision 315‑A).
Shares and rights
issued under the demutualisation are given a cost base based on the market
value of the demutualising health insurer at the time of issue (see
Subdivisions 315‑B and 315‑D).
Assets held by a lost policy holders trust are given roll‑over
relief if transferred to the lost policy holder, or if the lost policy holder
becomes absolutely entitled to them. Otherwise the trustee of the lost policy
holders trust is taxed on any capital gains (see Subdivision 315‑C).
A legal personal
representative can disregard capital gains and losses made when passing an
asset to a beneficiary of a policy holder’s estate (see Subdivision 315‑E).
Shares, rights or
cash received under a demutualisation are not assessable income and not exempt
income (see Subdivision 315‑F).
Subdivision 315‑A—Capital gains and losses connected with a demutualisation of
a private health insurer to be disregarded
Table of sections
Rules for policy holders
315‑5 Policy holders to
disregard capital gains and losses related to demutualisation of private health
insurer
315‑10 Effect on the legal
personal representative or beneficiary
315‑15 Demutualisations to which
this Division applies
315‑20 What assets are covered
Rules for demutualising health
insurer
315‑25 Demutualising health
insurers to disregard capital gains and losses related to demutualisation
Rules for other entities
315‑30 Other entities to disregard
capital gains and losses related to demutualisation
Rules for policy
holders
315‑5 Policy holders to disregard
capital gains and losses related to demutualisation of private health insurer
Disregard
a *capital gain or *capital loss of an
individual from a *CGT event that happens in relation to a *CGT asset if:
(a) the
CGT event happens under a demutualisation to which this Division applies; and
(b) the
individual is, or has been, a policy holder (within the meaning of the Private
Health Insurance Act 2007) of, or another person insured through, the
demutualising entity (the demutualising health insurer); and
(c) the CGT asset is
covered by section 315‑20.
315‑10 Effect on the legal personal
representative or beneficiary
Disregard a *capital gain or *capital loss of an
entity from a *CGT event that happens in relation to a *CGT asset if:
(a) the CGT asset
forms part of the estate of a deceased individual who is mentioned in paragraph 315‑5(b);
and
(b) the entity is the
deceased individual’s *legal personal
representative or a beneficiary in the deceased individual’s estate; and
(c) the CGT asset
devolves to the entity or *passes to the entity;
and
(d) the CGT event
happens under a demutualisation to which this Division applies; and
(e) the CGT asset is
covered by section 315‑20.
315‑15 Demutualisations to which
this Division applies
This Division applies
to a demutualisation of an entity if:
(a) the entity:
(i) is an
entity to which item 6.3 of the table in section 50‑30 applies; and
(ii) is
not registered under Part 3 of the Life Insurance Act 1995; and
(iia) is not
an entity to whose demutualisation Division 316 applies; and
(iii) does
not have capital divided into shares; and
Note: Item 6.3 of the table in
section 50‑30 applies to a private health insurer within the meaning of
the Private Health Insurance Act 2007 that is not carried on for the
profit or gain of its individual members.
(b) an application by
the entity to convert to being registered as a for profit insurer (within the
meaning of the Private Health Insurance Act 2007) is approved under
subsection 126‑42(5) of that Act; and
(c) consistently with
the conversion scheme mentioned in paragraph 126‑42(2)(b) of that Act, the
entity becomes registered as a for profit insurer (within the meaning of that
Act).
315‑20 What assets are covered
These *CGT assets are covered:
(a) an interest in
the demutualising health insurer as a policy holder;
(b) a membership
interest in the demutualising health insurer;
(c) a right or
interest of another kind in the demutualising health insurer;
(d) a right or
interest of another kind that arises under the demutualisation.
Rules for
demutualising health insurer
315‑25 Demutualising health insurers
to disregard capital gains and losses related to demutualisation
Disregard a *capital gain or *capital loss of an
entity from a *CGT event if:
(a) the CGT event
happened under a demutualisation to which this Division applies; and
(b) the entity is the
demutualising health insurer.
Rules for other
entities
315‑30 Other entities to disregard
capital gains and losses related to demutualisation
Disregard a *capital gain or *capital loss of an
entity from a *CGT event if:
(a) the entity is
established solely for the purpose of participating in a demutualisation to
which this Division applies; and
(b) the entity is not
a trust covered by Subdivision 315‑C (about lost policy holders); and
(c) the CGT event:
(i) happened
under a demutualisation to which this Division applies; and
(ii) happened
before or at the same time as the allocation or distribution (in the form of
shares or cash) of the accumulated surplus of the demutualising health insurer;
and
(iii) was
connected to that allocation or distribution.
Note: The allocation or
distribution of the accumulated surplus could happen through an arrangement
involving more than one transaction.
Subdivision 315‑B—Cost base of certain shares and rights in private health
insurers
Table of sections
315‑80 Cost base and acquisition
time of demutualisation assets
315‑85 Demutualisation asset
315‑90 Participating policy
holders
315‑80 Cost base and acquisition
time of demutualisation assets
Cost base adjustment
(1) The first element of the
*cost base and *reduced cost base of a *CGT asset is its *market value on the day
it is issued if:
(a) the asset is
covered by section 315‑85 (a demutualisation asset); and
(b) the asset is
issued to an entity (a participating policy holder) covered by
section 315‑90.
Note: There is an exception to this
rule in Subdivision 315‑D where the asset is a share or right in a holding
company with other assets.
Acquisition rule
(2) The participating policy
holder is taken to have *acquired the
demutualisation asset at the time it is issued.
315‑85 Demutualisation asset
(1) This section covers an
asset if:
(a) the asset is:
(i) a
share in the demutualising health insurer; or
(ii) a
right to *acquire a share in the demutualising
health insurer; or
(iii) a
share in an entity that owns all of the shares in the demutualising health
insurer; or
(iv) a
right to acquire a share in an entity mentioned in subparagraph (iii); and
(b) the share or
right is issued under a demutualisation to which this Division applies; and
(c) the share or
right is issued in connection with:
(i) the
variation or abrogation of rights attaching to or consisting of a *CGT asset covered by section 315‑20; or
(ii) the
conversion, cancellation, extinguishment or redemption of such a CGT asset.
Exclusion for rights with an exercise
price
(2) Despite subsection (1),
this section does not cover a right to *acquire
a share in an entity if the holder of the right must pay an amount to exercise
the right.
Exclusion where assets not issued
simultaneously
(3) Despite subsection (1),
an asset is not covered by this section unless all of the assets covered by subsection (1)
for the demutualisation in question are issued:
(a) at the same time;
and
(b) to an entity that
is either:
(i) a
participating policy holder (see section 315‑90); or
(ii) the
trustee of a trust covered by Subdivision 315‑C (about the lost policy
holders trust).
315‑90 Participating policy holders
(1) This section covers an
individual who:
(a) is, or has been,
a policy holder (within the meaning of the Private Health Insurance Act 2007)
of, or another person insured through, the demutualising health insurer; and
(b) is entitled,
under the demutualisation, to an allocation of demutualisation assets.
(2) This section also covers
an entity who became entitled to an allocation of demutualisation assets
because of the death of an individual mentioned in subsection (1).
Subdivision 315‑C—Lost policy holders trust
Table of sections
315‑140 Lost policy holders trust
315‑145 CGT treatment of
demutualisation assets in lost policy holders trust
315‑150 Roll‑over where assets
transferred to lost policy holder
315‑155 Trustee assessed if assets
dealt with not for benefit of lost policy holder
315‑160 Subdivision 126‑E
does not apply to lost policy holders trust
315‑140 Lost policy holders trust
This Subdivision covers
a trust (a lost policy holders trust) in relation to a
demutualisation to which this Division applies if:
(a) the conversion
scheme mentioned in paragraph 126‑42(2)(b) of the Private Health
Insurance Act 2007 for the demutualisation provides for the trust; and
(b) under the
demutualisation, demutualisation assets (see section 315‑85) are issued to
the trustee of the trust; and
(c) the trust exists
solely for the purpose of holding shares or rights to *acquire
shares on behalf of:
(i) individuals
(lost policy holders) who are, or have been, policy holders
(within the meaning of the Private Health Insurance Act 2007) of, or
other persons insured through, the demutualising health insurer; or
(ii) if
the lost policy holder has died—the *legal personal
representative of the lost policy holder or a beneficiary in the estate of the
lost policy holder.
Example: An example of an individual on
whose behalf the trust might hold assets would be an individual who has not
completed a formal step required for them to be issued with demutualisation
assets directly. Another example might be an individual living overseas.
315‑145 CGT treatment of
demutualisation assets in lost policy holders trust
Cost base adjustment
(1) The first element of the
*cost base and *reduced cost base of a
demutualisation asset issued to the trustee of a lost policy holders trust is
its *market value on the day it is issued.
Note: There is an exception to this
rule in Subdivision 315‑D where the asset is a share or right in a holding
company with other assets.
Acquisition rule
(2) The trustee is taken to
have *acquired the demutualisation asset at the
time it is issued.
315‑150 Roll‑over where assets
transferred to lost policy holder
(1) This
section applies in relation to a *CGT event if:
(a) the CGT event
happens in relation to an asset held by the trustee of a lost policy holders
trust on behalf of a lost policy holder; and
(b) the CGT event
happens because the lost policy holder (or, if the lost policy holder has died,
the *legal personal representative of the lost
policy holder or a beneficiary in the estate of the lost policy holder) either:
(i) is
transferred the asset by the trustee; or
(ii) becomes
absolutely entitled to the asset.
Note: The asset may be a
demutualisation asset, or some other asset.
Consequence for trustee
(2) Disregard a *capital gain or *capital loss the trustee
makes from the *CGT event.
Consequence for lost policy holder
(3) The *cost base of the asset in the hands of the trustee of the lost
policy holders trust just before the *CGT event becomes
the first element of the cost base and *reduced
cost base of the asset in the hands of the lost policy holder, *legal personal representative or beneficiary.
(4) The lost policy holder, *legal personal representative or beneficiary is taken to have *acquired the asset when the trustee of the lost policy holders trust
acquired it.
315‑155 Trustee assessed if assets
dealt with not for benefit of lost policy holder
(1) This section applies in
relation to a *capital gain from a *CGT event if:
(a) the CGT event
happens in relation to an asset held by the trustee of a lost policy holders
trust; and
(b) section 315‑150
does not apply to the CGT event.
(2) If this section applies:
(a) sections 115‑215
and 115‑220 do not apply in relation to the *capital
gain; and
(b) for the purposes
of this Act, the trustee is taken to be *specifically
entitled to all of the capital gain.
315‑160 Subdivision 126‑E does
not apply to lost policy holders trust
Subdivision 126‑E
does not apply in relation to a demutualisation to which this Division applies.
Subdivision 315‑D—Special cost base rules for certain shares and rights in
holding companies
Table of sections
315‑210 Cost base for shares and
rights in certain holding companies
315‑210 Cost base for shares and
rights in certain holding companies
(1) This section applies in
relation to a *CGT asset that is a demutualisation asset
if:
(a) the demutualisation
asset is:
(i) a
share in an entity mentioned in subparagraph 315‑85(1)(a)(iii); or
(ii) a
right to *acquire a share in an entity mentioned in
that subparagraph; and
(b) the entity owns
other assets in addition to the shares in the demutualising health insurer; and
(c) the share or
right is issued to a participating policy holder or the trustee of a lost
policy holders trust.
This section applies despite sections 315‑80
and 315‑145.
Cost base adjustment
(2) The first element of the
*cost base and *reduced cost base of the
*CGT asset is worked out under the method statement.
Method
statement
Step 1. Start
with the *market value of the demutualising health
insurer on the day the asset is issued.
Step 2. Divide
the result of step 1 by the sum of:
(a) the
number of shares in the entity that are issued under the demutualisation; and
(b) the
number of shares in the entity that can be *acquired
under rights that are demutualisation assets issued under the demutualisation.
Step 3. The
result of step 2 is the first element of the *cost
base and *reduced cost base of the asset, unless the
asset is a right.
Step 4. If the
asset is a right, multiply the result of step 2 by the number of shares that
can be *acquired under the right. The result is
the first element of the *cost base and *reduced cost base of the asset.
Example: Wellbeing Health demutualises on
1 April 2008 and has a market value of $400 million on that day. It
distributes its accumulated mutual surplus in the form of rights to acquire
shares in its holding company Healthiness Insurance Ltd (Healthiness). The
rights do not have an exercise price.
A total of 800 million
shares can be acquired in Healthiness under rights issued under the
demutualisation. Each right allows the holder to acquire 50 shares. No shares
in Healthiness are issued.
Under the method
statement, the first element of the cost base and reduced cost base of each
right is worked out by dividing the market value of Wellbeing Health (step 1)
by the number of shares in Healthiness that can be acquired under the
demutualisation (step 2) and multiplying the result by the number of shares
that can be acquired under the right (step 4):

Acquisition rule
(3) The participating policy
holder or trustee is taken to have *acquired the *CGT asset at the time it is issued.
Subdivision 315‑E—Special CGT rule for legal personal representatives and
beneficiaries
Table of sections
315‑260 Special CGT rule for legal
personal representatives and beneficiaries
315‑260 Special CGT rule for legal
personal representatives and beneficiaries
(1) This section sets out
what happens if a *CGT asset:
(a) is a
demutualisation asset; and
(b) forms part of the
estate of a participating policy holder mentioned in subsection 315‑90(1)
who has died, but was not owned by the policy holder just before dying; and
(c) *passes to a beneficiary in the policy holder’s estate because the
asset is transferred to the beneficiary by the policy holder’s *legal personal representative.
Note: Division 128 deals with
the effect of death in relation to CGT assets a person owns just before dying.
(2) Disregard a *capital gain or *capital loss the *legal personal representative makes if the asset *passes to a beneficiary in the policy holder’s estate.
Consequence for beneficiary
(3) The
*cost base and *reduced cost base of the
asset in the hands of the *legal personal
representative just before the asset *passes to the
beneficiary becomes the first element of the cost base and reduced cost base of
the asset in the hands of the beneficiary.
(4) The beneficiary is taken
to have *acquired the asset when the *legal personal representative acquired it.
Subdivision 315‑F—Non‑CGT consequences of demutualisation
Table of sections
315‑310 General taxation
consequences of issue of demutualisation assets etc.
315‑310 General taxation
consequences of issue of demutualisation assets etc.
(1) An amount of *ordinary income or *statutory income of an
entity to which subsection (2) applies is not assessable and not *exempt income if:
(a) the amount would
otherwise be included in the ordinary income or statutory income of the entity
only because a demutualisation asset was issued to the entity; or
(b) the amount is a
payment made to the entity, under a demutualisation to which this Division
applies, in connection with:
(i) the
variation or abrogation of rights attaching to or consisting of a *CGT asset covered by section 315‑20; or
(ii) the
conversion, cancellation, extinguishment or redemption of such a CGT asset.
(2) This subsection applies
to an entity that:
(a) is, or has been,
a policy holder (within the meaning of the Private Health Insurance Act 2007)
of, or another person insured through, the demutualising health insurer; or
(b) is issued with
the demutualisation asset, or receives the payment, because of the death of a
policy holder mentioned in paragraph (a).
Division 316—Demutualisation of friendly society health
or life insurers
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 316
316‑A Application
316‑B Capital gains and losses
connected with the demutualisation
316‑C Cost base of shares and
rights issued under the demutualisation
316‑D Lost policy holders trust
316‑E Special CGT rules for legal
personal representatives and beneficiaries
316‑F Non‑CGT consequences of the demutualisation
Guide to Division 316
316‑1 What this Division is about
Special tax
consequences follow the demutualisation of a friendly society that provides
health insurance or life insurance, or has a wholly‑owned subsidiary that does.
Subdivision 316‑A—Application
Table of sections
316‑5 Application of this
Division
316‑5 Application of this Division
This Division applies
in relation to a demutualisation of a *friendly society
if:
(a) the society is,
or has a *wholly‑owned subsidiary (a health/life
insurance subsidiary) that is:
(i) a
private health insurer as defined in the Private Health Insurance Act 2007;
or
(ii) a
company registered under section 21 of the Life Insurance Act 1995;
and
(b) the society does
not have capital divided into *shares held by its *members; and
(c) after the
demutualisation the society is to be carried on for the object of securing a
profit or pecuniary gain for its *members.
Subdivision 316‑B—Capital gains and losses connected with the demutualisation
Guide to Subdivision 316‑B
316‑50 What this Subdivision is
about
Disregard capital
gains and losses made by any entity from a CGT event happening under the
demutualisation, unless the entity:
(a) is
or has been a member of the friendly society or insured through the society or
any of its wholly‑owned subsidiaries; and
(b) receives
money for the event.
Table of sections
Gains and losses of members,
insured entities and successors
316‑55 Disregarding capital
gains and losses, except some involving receipt of money
316‑60 Taking account of some
capital gains and losses involving receipt of money
316‑65 Valuation factor for
sections 316‑60, 316‑105 and 316‑165
316‑70 Value of the friendly
society
Friendly society’s gains and
losses
316‑75 Disregarding friendly
society’s capital gains and losses
Other entities’ gains and losses
316‑80 Disregarding other
entities’ capital gains and losses
Gains and losses of
members, insured entities and successors
316‑55 Disregarding capital gains
and losses, except some involving receipt of money
(1) Disregard an entity’s *capital gain or *capital loss from a *CGT event that happens under the demutualisation to a *CGT asset if:
(a) the entity:
(i) is or
has been a *member of the *friendly
society; or
(ii) is or
has been insured through the friendly society or a health/life insurance
subsidiary of the friendly society; and
(b) the CGT asset is
one of these (an interest affected by demutualisation):
(i) an
interest in the friendly society as the owner or holder of a policy of
insurance with the friendly society or health/life insurance subsidiary;
(ii) a *membership interest in the friendly society;
(iii) a
right or interest of another kind in the friendly society;
(iv) a
right or interest of another kind that arises under the demutualisation, except
an interest in a lost policy holders trust (see section 316‑155).
Note: Subdivision 316‑D deals
with the effects of CGT events happening to interests in lost policy holders
trusts.
(2) Disregard a *capital gain or *capital loss of an
entity (the successor) from a *CGT
event that happens under the demutualisation to a *CGT
asset if:
(a) the successor is
the *legal personal representative, or
beneficiary in the estate, of a deceased individual who was:
(i) a *member of the *friendly society; or
(ii) insured
through the friendly society or a health/life insurance subsidiary of the
friendly society; and
(b) the CGT asset:
(i) forms
part of the deceased individual’s estate; and
(ii) devolves
or *passes to the successor; and
(iii) is an
interest affected by demutualisation (see paragraph (1)(b)).
316‑60 Taking account of some
capital gains and losses involving receipt of money
(1) This section applies if:
(a) a *CGT event happens under the demutualisation to an entity’s interest
affected by demutualisation (see section 316‑55); and
(b) the event
involves:
(i) the
variation or abrogation of rights attaching to or consisting of the interest;
or
(ii) the
conversion, cancellation, extinguishment or redemption of the interest; and
(c) either:
(i) the
entity is one described in paragraph 316‑55(1)(a); or
(ii) the
entity is one described in paragraph 316‑55(2)(a) and the interest is a *CGT asset described in paragraph 316‑55(2)(b); and
(d) the *capital proceeds from the event include or consist of money received
by the entity.
(2) Work out whether the
entity makes a *capital gain or *capital
loss from the *CGT event, and the amount of the gain or
loss, assuming that:
(a) the *capital proceeds from the CGT event were the amount they would be if
they did not include any *market value of property
other than money; and
(b) the *cost base and *reduced cost base for
the interest were the amount worked out using the formula:

Example: Assume the entity receives $50
in money and 10 shares with a market value of $4 each in respect of CGT event
C2 happening, and that the valuation factor worked out under section 316‑65
is 0.9. The entity makes a capital gain from the event of $5, worked out as
follows:

This ignores the market
value of the shares because they are property other than money.
Note: Division 114 (Indexation
of cost base) is not relevant, because this section provides exhaustively for
working out the amount of the cost base.
(3) The *capital gain or *capital loss is not to
be disregarded, despite:
(a) section 316‑55;
and
(b) any provision of
this Act for disregarding the *capital gain or *capital loss because the interest affected by demutualisation was *acquired before 20 September 1985.
Note: The capital gain is not a
discount capital gain: see section 115‑55.
316‑65 Valuation factor for sections 316‑60,
316‑105 and 316‑165
(1) For the purposes of
sections 316‑60, 316‑105 and 316‑165, the valuation factor is the amount
worked out using the formula:

where:
embedded value of the friendly
society’s other business (if any) means the
amount that would be the value of the *friendly society
worked out under section 316‑70 assuming that neither the friendly
society, nor any health/life insurance subsidiary of it, *carried on any health insurance business within the meaning of the Private
Health Insurance Act 2007.
market value of the friendly
society’s health insurance business (if any)
means the total *market value of every health insurance
business, within the meaning of the Private Health Insurance Act 2007, *carried on by either or both of the *friendly
society and its health/life insurance subsidiaries (if any), taking account of
any consideration paid to the society or subsidiary for disposal or control of
that business.
(2) Disregard paragraph 316‑60(2)(a)
for the purposes of the formula in subsection (1) of this section.
316‑70 Value of the friendly society
(1) The value of the *friendly society is the sum, worked out in accordance with this
section, of the friendly society’s existing business value and its adjusted net
worth on the day (the applicable accounting day) identified under
subsection (3).
Eligible actuary and Australian
actuarial practice
(2) The sum is to be worked
out, according to Australian actuarial practice, by an *actuary
who is not an employee of:
(a) the *friendly society; or
(b) a health/life
insurance subsidiary of the friendly society; or
(c) an entity of
which the friendly society is to become a *wholly‑owned
subsidiary under the demutualisation.
Applicable accounting day
(3) The applicable
accounting day is:
(a) if an accounting
period of the *friendly society ends on the day (the demutualisation
resolution day) identified under subsection (4)—that day; or
(b) in any other
case—the last day of the most recent accounting period of the friendly society
ending before the demutualisation resolution day.
Demutualisation resolution day
(4) The demutualisation
resolution day is:
(a) the day on which
the resolution to proceed with the demutualisation is passed; or
(b) if, under the
demutualisation, the whole of the *life insurance
business of the *friendly society or of a health/life
insurance subsidiary of the friendly society is transferred to another company
under a scheme confirmed by the Federal Court of Australia—the day (or the last
day) on which the transfer takes place.
Adjustment for changes after
applicable accounting day
(5) In a case covered by paragraph (3)(b),
if any significant change in the amount of the existing business value or
adjusted net worth occurs between the applicable accounting day and the
demutualisation resolution day, the amount is to be adjusted to take account of
the change.
Continued business assumption
(6) In working out the
existing business value or the adjusted net worth, assume:
(a) that after the
applicable accounting day the *friendly society, and
any health/life insurance subsidiary of the friendly society, will continue to
conduct *business and any other activity in the
same way as before that day, and will not conduct any different business or
other activity; and
(b) that the
demutualisation will not occur; and
(c) that any
health/life insurance subsidiary of the friendly society will continue to be a *wholly‑owned subsidiary of the friendly society.
Expenditure assumption
(7) In working out the
existing business value, assume that expenditure that the *friendly society and any of its health/life insurance subsidiaries
will incur, in conducting *business, on recurring
items after the demutualisation resolution day will be of the same kinds and
amounts (increased to take account of any inflation) as it incurred in the
accounting period, or part of an accounting period, ending on the
demutualisation resolution day.
Friendly society’s
gains and losses
316‑75 Disregarding friendly
society’s capital gains and losses
Disregard
the *friendly society’s *capital gain or *capital loss from a *CGT event that happens under the demutualisation.
Other entities’
gains and losses
316‑80 Disregarding other entities’
capital gains and losses
Disregard an entity’s *capital gain or *capital loss from a *CGT event that happens under the demutualisation if:
(a) the entity is
established solely for the purpose of participating in the demutualisation and
is not a lost policy holders trust (see section 316‑155); and
(b) the CGT event:
(i) happens
before or at the same time as the allocation or distribution of the accumulated
surplus of the *friendly society; and
(ii) is
connected to that allocation or distribution.
Note: The allocation or
distribution of the accumulated surplus could happen through an arrangement
involving more than one transaction.
Subdivision 316‑C—Cost base of shares and rights issued under the
demutualisation
Guide to Subdivision 316‑C
316‑100 What this Subdivision is
about
The value of the
friendly society and its business affects cost bases of shares and certain
rights issued under the demutualisation to:
(a) entities
that are or were members of the friendly society; or
(b) entities
insured through the society or its subsidiaries; or
(c) successors
of such entities; or
(d) the
trustee of the lost policy holders trust.
Table of sections
316‑105 Cost base and time of
acquisition of shares and certain rights issued under demutualisation
316‑110 Demutualisation assets
316‑115 Entities to which section 316‑105
applies
316‑105 Cost base and time of
acquisition of shares and certain rights issued under demutualisation
First element of cost base
(1) The first element of the
*cost base and *reduced cost base of a *CGT asset is the amount worked out using the formula in subsection (2)
if:
(a) the asset is a
CGT asset (a demutualisation asset) covered by section 316‑110;
and
(b) the asset is
issued to an entity covered by section 316‑115.
(2) The formula is:

Time of acquisition
(3) The entity is taken to
have *acquired the *CGT
asset at the time it is issued.
316‑110 Demutualisation assets
(1) This
section covers a *CGT asset that:
(a) is:
(i) a *share in the *friendly society; or
(ii) a
right to *acquire a share in the friendly society;
or
(iii) a
share in an entity that owns all of the shares in the friendly society; or
(iv) a
right to acquire a share in an entity mentioned in subparagraph (iii); and
(b) is issued under
the demutualisation; and
(c) is issued in
connection with:
(i) the
variation or abrogation of rights attaching to or consisting of an interest
affected by demutualisation (see paragraph 316‑55(1)(b)); or
(ii) the
conversion, cancellation, extinguishment or redemption of an interest affected
by demutualisation.
Exclusion for rights with an exercise
price
(2) Despite subsection (1),
this section does not cover a right to *acquire
a *share in an entity if the holder of the right must pay an amount to
exercise the right.
Exclusion where assets not issued
simultaneously
(3) Despite subsection (1),
a *CGT asset is not covered by this section unless all of the CGT
assets covered by subsection (1) for the demutualisation are issued:
(a) at the same time;
and
(b) to entities that
are covered by section 316‑115.
316‑115 Entities to which section 316‑105
applies
(1) This section covers an
entity that:
(a) either:
(i) is or
has been a *member of the *friendly
society; or
(ii) is or
has been insured through the friendly society or a health/life insurance
subsidiary of the friendly society; and
(b) is entitled under
the demutualisation to an allocation of demutualisation assets.
(2) This section also covers
an entity that has become entitled to an allocation of demutualisation assets
because of the death of an individual who was an entity described in subsection (1).
(3) This section also covers
the trustee of a lost policy holders trust (see section 316‑155).
Subdivision 316‑D—Lost policy holders trust
Guide to Subdivision 316‑D
316‑150 What this Subdivision is
about
If the
demutualisation creates a trust just to hold shares, rights to acquire shares
or money for entities that were members of the friendly society or insured
through the society or its subsidiary, or are successors of such entities,
then:
(a) capital
gains or losses from CGT events happening to beneficiaries’ interests in the
trust are disregarded, except where the capital proceeds include money; and
(b) when
a CGT event happens involving the transfer of the shares or rights to a
beneficiary, or a beneficiary’s absolute entitlement to them, the trustee’s
capital gain or loss is disregarded and the beneficiary has the same cost base
and time of acquisition as the trustee; and
(c) the
trustee is assessed on any capital gains from other CGT events happening to the
shares or rights.
Table of sections
Application
316‑155 Lost policy holders trust
Effects of CGT events happening
to interests and assets in trust
316‑160 Disregarding
beneficiaries’ capital gains and losses, except some involving receipt of money
316‑165 Taking account of some
capital gains and losses involving receipt of money by beneficiaries
316‑170 Roll‑over where shares or
rights to acquire shares transferred to beneficiary of lost policy holders
trust
316‑175 Trustee assessed if shares
or rights dealt with not for benefit of beneficiary of lost policy holders
trust
316‑180 Subdivision 126‑E
does not apply
Application
316‑155 Lost policy holders trust
(1) This
Subdivision applies if the conditions in subsections (2) and (5) are met.
First condition
(2) The
first condition is that, under the demutualisation, a trust (the lost
policy holders trust) exists solely for one or both of the purposes
that are described in subsection (3) in relation to persons (beneficiaries
of the lost policy holders trust) covered by subsection (4).
(3) The purposes are as
follows:
(a) holding
demutualisation assets (see section 316‑110) that are *shares or rights to *acquire shares, or
proceeds from disposal of those assets, on behalf of one or more beneficiaries
of the lost policy holders trust and transferring those assets or proceeds to
those beneficiaries;
(b) holding on behalf
of one or more beneficiaries of the lost policy holders trust, and paying to
them, money payable to them for:
(i) the
variation or abrogation of rights attaching to or consisting of the
beneficiaries’ interests affected by demutualisation (see paragraph 316‑55(1)(b));
or
(ii) the
conversion, cancellation, extinguishment or redemption of those interests.
(4) This subsection covers:
(a) a person who is
or has been a *member of the friendly society or is or
has been insured through the *friendly society or a
health/life insurance subsidiary of the friendly society; and
(b) a *legal personal representative, or beneficiary in the estate, of such
a person who has died.
Second condition
(5) The second condition is
that, under the demutualisation, the trustee of the lost policy holders trust
is:
(a) issued with
demutualisation assets that are *shares, or rights to *acquire shares; or
(b) paid money
described in paragraph (3)(b) to hold and pay to beneficiaries of the lost
policy holders trust.
Effects of CGT
events happening to interests and assets in trust
316‑160 Disregarding beneficiaries’
capital gains and losses, except some involving receipt of money
Disregard a *capital gain or *capital loss of a
beneficiary of the lost policy holders trust from a *CGT
event that happens to the beneficiary’s interest in the trust.
316‑165 Taking account of some
capital gains and losses involving receipt of money by beneficiaries
(1) This section applies if:
(a) a *CGT event happens to an interest of a beneficiary of the lost policy
holders trust in that trust; and
(b) the *capital proceeds from the event include or consist of money received
by the beneficiary.
(2) Work out whether the
beneficiary makes a *capital gain or *capital loss from the *CGT event, and the
amount of the gain or loss, assuming that:
(a) the *capital proceeds from the CGT event were the amount they would be if
they did not include any *market value of property
other than money; and
(b) the *cost base and *reduced cost base for
the interest were the amount worked out using the formula:

Example: Assume that the beneficiary of
the lost policy holders trust is paid $50 in money by the trustee to satisfy
the beneficiary’s interest in the trust so that a CGT event happens, and that
the valuation factor worked out under section 316‑65 is 0.9. The
beneficiary makes a capital gain from the event of $5, worked out as follows:

Note: Division 114 (Indexation
of cost base) is not relevant, because this section provides exhaustively for
working out the amount of the cost base.
(3) The *capital gain or *capital loss is not to
be disregarded, despite sections 316‑55 and 316‑160.
Note: The capital gain is not a
discount capital gain: see section 115‑55.
316‑170 Roll‑over where shares or
rights to acquire shares transferred to beneficiary of lost policy holders
trust
(1) This section applies in
relation to a *CGT event if:
(a) the CGT event
happens in relation to an asset that:
(i) is a *share or a right to *acquire one or more
shares; and
(ii) is
held by the trustee of the lost policy holders trust on behalf of a beneficiary
of the lost policy holders trust; and
(b) the CGT event
happens because the beneficiary of the lost policy holders trust either:
(i) is
transferred the asset by the trustee; or
(ii) becomes
absolutely entitled to the asset.
Consequence for trustee
(2) Disregard a *capital gain or *capital loss the trustee
makes from the *CGT event.
Consequences for beneficiary
(3) The *cost base and *reduced cost base of the
asset in the hands of the trustee of the lost policy holders trust just before
the *CGT event becomes the first element of the
cost base and reduced cost base of the asset in the hands of the beneficiary of
the lost policy holders trust.
Note: Section 316‑105 affects
the cost base of the asset in the hands of the trustee of the lost policy
holders trust if the asset is covered by section 316‑110.
(4) The beneficiary of the
lost policy holders trust is taken to have *acquired
the asset when the trustee acquired it.
316‑175 Trustee assessed if shares
or rights dealt with not for benefit of beneficiary of lost policy holders
trust
(1) This section applies in
relation to a *capital gain from a *CGT event if:
(a) the CGT event
happens in relation to a demutualisation asset that:
(i) is a *share or a right to *acquire a share; and
(ii) is
held by the trustee of a lost policy holders trust; and
(b) section 316‑170
does not apply to the CGT event.
(2) If this section applies:
(a) sections 115‑215
and 115‑220 do not apply in relation to the *capital
gain; and
(b) for the purposes
of this Act, the trustee is taken to be *specifically
entitled to all of the capital gain.
316‑180 Subdivision 126‑E does
not apply
Subdivision 126‑E
does not apply in relation to the demutualisation.
Note: Subdivision 126‑E is
about an entitlement to shares after demutualisation and scrip for scrip roll‑over.
Subdivision 316‑E—Special CGT rules for legal personal representatives and
beneficiaries
Table of sections
316‑200 Demutualisation assets not
owned by deceased but passing to beneficiary in deceased estate
316‑205 Interest in lost policy
holders trust not owned by deceased but passing to beneficiary in deceased
estate
316‑200 Demutualisation assets not
owned by deceased but passing to beneficiary in deceased estate
(1) This section sets out
what happens if a *CGT asset:
(a) is a
demutualisation asset (see section 316‑110); and
(b) forms part of the
estate of an individual who is an entity described in subsection 316‑115(1)
and has died; and
(c) was not owned by
the individual just before dying; and
(d) *passes to a beneficiary in the individual’s estate because the asset
is transferred to the beneficiary by the individual’s *legal
personal representative.
Note: Division 128 deals with
the effect of death in relation to CGT assets a person owns just before dying.
Consequence for legal personal
representative
(2) Disregard a *capital gain or *capital loss the *legal personal representative makes because the asset *passes to the beneficiary.
Consequence for beneficiary
(3) The *cost base and *reduced cost base of the
asset in the hands of the *legal personal
representative just before the asset *passes to the
beneficiary becomes the first element of the cost base and reduced cost base of
the asset in the hands of the beneficiary.
(4) The beneficiary is taken
to have *acquired the asset when the *legal personal representative acquired it.
316‑205 Interest in lost policy
holders trust not owned by deceased but passing to beneficiary in deceased
estate
(1) This section sets out
what happens if a *CGT asset:
(a) is an interest in
a lost policy holders trust (see section 316‑155); and
(b) forms part of the
estate of an individual who is an entity described in subsection 316‑115(1)
and has died; and
(c) was not owned by
the individual just before dying; and
(d) *passes to a beneficiary in the individual’s estate because the asset
is transferred to the beneficiary by the individual’s *legal
personal representative.
Note: Division 128 deals with
the effect of death in relation to CGT assets a person owns just before dying.
Consequence for legal personal
representative
(2) Disregard a *capital gain or *capital loss the *legal personal representative makes because the asset *passes to the beneficiary.
Subdivision 316‑F—Non‑CGT consequences of the demutualisation
Guide to Subdivision 316‑F
316‑250 What this Subdivision is
about
In many cases, income
from demutualisation is assessed through the CGT provisions rather than as ordinary
income or other statutory income.
Franking debits arise
for the friendly society and its subsidiaries to ensure they do not enjoy a
franking surplus. Franking debits and credits arise to negate credits and
debits from things attributable to the time before demutualisation.
Table of sections
316‑255 General taxation
consequences of issue of demutualisation assets etc.
316‑260 Franking debits to stop
the friendly society and its subsidiaries having franking surpluses
316‑265 Franking debits to negate franking
credits from some distributions to friendly society and subsidiaries
316‑270 Franking debits to negate
franking credits from post‑demutualisation payments of pre‑demutualisation tax
316‑275 Franking credits to negate
franking debits from refunds of tax paid before demutualisation
316‑255 General taxation
consequences of issue of demutualisation assets etc.
(1) An amount of *ordinary income or *statutory income (other
than a *net capital gain) of an entity covered by subsection (2)
is not assessable income and is not *exempt income if:
(a) the amount would
otherwise be included in the ordinary income or statutory income of the entity
only because a demutualisation asset (see section 316‑110) was issued to
the entity; or
(b) the amount is a
payment made to the entity, under the demutualisation, in connection with:
(i) the
variation or abrogation of rights attaching to or consisting of an interest
affected by demutualisation (see paragraph 316‑55(1)(b)); or
(ii) the
conversion, cancellation, extinguishment or redemption of an interest affected
by demutualisation; or
(c) the amount would
otherwise be included in the ordinary income or statutory income of the entity
only because a *share or a right to *acquire one or more shares was transferred to the entity by the
trustee of a lost policy holders trust (see section 316‑155); or
(d) the amount is a
payment made to the entity from a lost policy holders trust in connection with:
(i) the
variation or abrogation of rights attaching to or consisting of an interest
affected by demutualisation; or
(ii) the
conversion, cancellation, extinguishment or redemption of an interest affected
by demutualisation.
(2) This
subsection covers an entity that:
(a) is or has been a *member of the *friendly society; or
(b) is or has been
insured through the friendly society or a health/life insurance subsidiary of
the friendly society; or
(c) is issued with
the demutualisation asset, or receives the payment, because of the death of a
person covered by paragraph (a) or (b); or
(d) is a beneficiary
of a lost policy holders trust (see section 316‑155).
316‑260 Franking debits to stop the
friendly society and its subsidiaries having franking surpluses
(1) A *franking debit arises in the *franking
account of the *friendly society or a *wholly‑owned subsidiary of the society if the account is in *surplus immediately before the demutualisation resolution day
identified under subsection 316‑70(4).
(2) The amount of the *franking debit equals the *surplus.
(3) The *franking debit arises at the start of that day.
316‑265 Franking debits to negate
franking credits from some distributions to friendly society and subsidiaries
(1) This section applies if
a *franking credit arises in the *franking
account of the *friendly society or a *wholly‑owned subsidiary of the society because a *distribution declared before the demutualisation resolution day
identified under subsection 316‑70(4) is made to the society or subsidiary
on or after that day.
(2) A *franking debit arises in that account.
(3) The amount of the *franking debit equals the amount of the *franking
credit.
(4) The *franking debit arises at the same time as the *franking credit arises.
316‑270 Franking debits to negate
franking credits from post‑demutualisation payments of pre‑demutualisation tax
(1) This section applies if
a *franking credit arises in the *franking
account of the *friendly society or a *wholly‑owned subsidiary of the society because, on or after the
demutualisation resolution day identified under subsection 316‑70(4), the
society or subsidiary *pays a PAYG instalment,
or *pays income tax, that is wholly or partly attributable to a period
before that day.
(2) A *franking debit arises in that account.
(3) The amount of the *franking debit is so much of the *franking
credit as is attributable to the period before that day.
(4) The *franking debit arises at the same time as the *franking credit arises.
316‑275 Franking credits to negate
franking debits from refunds of tax paid before demutualisation
(1) This section applies if
a *franking debit arises in the *franking
account of the *friendly society or a *wholly‑owned subsidiary of the society because, on or after the
demutualisation resolution day identified under subsection 316‑70(4), the
society or subsidiary *receives a refund of
income tax that is wholly or partly attributable to a period before that day.
(2) A *franking credit arises in that account.
(3) The amount of the *franking credit is so much of the *franking
debit as is attributable to the period before that day.
(4) The *franking credit arises at the same time as the *franking debit arises.
Part 3‑35—Insurance business
Division 320—Life insurance companies
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 320
320‑A Preliminary
320‑B What is included in a life
insurance company’s assessable income
320‑C Deductions and capital losses
320‑D Income tax, taxable income and
tax loss of life insurance companies
320‑E No‑TFN contributions of life
insurance companies that are RSA providers
320‑F Complying superannuation/FHSA
asset pool
320‑H Segregation of assets to
discharge exempt life insurance policy liabilities
320‑I Transfers of business
Guide to Division 320
320‑1 What this Division is about
This Division
provides for the taxation of life insurance companies in a broadly comparable
way to other entities that derive similar kinds of income.
Because of the nature
of the business of life insurance companies, the Division contains special
rules for working out their taxable income.
Those rules:
• include certain amounts in assessable income;
• identify
certain amounts of exempt income and non‑assessable non‑exempt income;
• identify
specific deductions.
Life insurance
companies can have one or both of these taxable incomes for any income year for
the purposes of working out their income tax for that year:
• a taxable
income of the complying superannuation/FHSA class, which consists of taxable
income that relates to complying superannuation business or FHSAs, and is taxed
at the rate of tax that applies to complying superannuation funds;
• a taxable
income of the ordinary class, which consists of taxable income that relates to
other businesses and is taxed at the corporate tax rate.
Life insurance
companies can also have tax losses that correspond to those 2 classes. The
Division provides that tax losses of a particular class can be deducted only
from incomes in respect of that class.
The Division ensures
that the income tax worked out on the basis of these taxable incomes and tax
losses is a single amount of income tax on one taxable income.
The Division also
contains rules for segregating the assets of life insurance companies into:
• assets
that relate to complying superannuation business or FHSAs;
• assets
that relate to immediate annuity and other exempt business.
This Division also
ensures that life insurance companies that are RSA providers are liable to pay
tax on no‑TFN contributions income.
Operative provisions
Subdivision 320‑A—Preliminary
320‑5 Object of Division
(1) The object of this
Division is to provide for the taxation of *life
insurance companies in a broadly comparable way to other entities that *derive similar kinds of income.
(2) To achieve this object,
the Division:
(a) identifies
certain amounts that are included in the assessable income, or are *exempt income or *non‑assessable non‑exempt
income, of a *life insurance company; and
(b) identifies
certain amounts that a life insurance company can deduct; and
(c) enables a life
insurance company to have taxable incomes and *tax
losses of the following classes for the purposes of working out its income tax
for an income year:
(i) the *complying superannuation/FHSA class;
(ii) the *ordinary class; and
(d) contains other
provisions necessary to enable the income tax on the taxable income of a life
insurance company to be worked out.
Note: Section 320‑5 of the Income
Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997 provides that the tax consequences
of certain transfers of assets of a life insurance company that is a friendly
society to a complying superannuation fund are to be disregarded.
Subdivision 320‑B—What is included in a life insurance company’s assessable
income
Guide to Subdivision 320‑B
320‑10 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision provides for certain amounts to be included in a
life insurance company’s assessable income and for certain other amounts to be
exempt income or non‑assessable non‑exempt income.
Table of sections
Operative provisions
320‑15 Assessable income—various
amounts
320‑30 Assessable income—special
provision for certain income years
320‑35 Exempt income
320‑37 Non‑assessable non‑exempt
income
320‑45 Tax treatment of gains or
losses from CGT events in relation to complying superannuation/FHSA assets
Operative provisions
320‑15 Assessable income—various
amounts
(1) A *life insurance company’s assessable income includes:
(a) the total amount
of the *life insurance premiums paid to the
company in the income year; and
(b) amounts received
or recovered under *contracts of reinsurance (except
amounts that relate to a risk, or part of a risk, in relation to which
subsection 148(1) of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 applies) to
the extent to which they relate to the *risk
components of claims paid under *life insurance policies;
and
(c) any
amount received or recovered that is a refund, or in the nature of a refund, of
the life insurance premium paid under a contract of reinsurance (except any
amount that relates to a risk, or part of a risk, in relation to which
subsection 148(1) of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 applies);
and
(ca) any reinsurance
commission received or recovered by the
company in respect of a contract of reinsurance (except any commission that
relates to a risk, or part of a risk, in relation to which subsection 148(1)
of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 applies); and
(d) any amount
received under a profit‑sharing arrangement contained in, or entered into in
relation to, a contract of reinsurance; and
(da) the *transfer values of assets transferred by the company from a *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool under subsection 320‑180(1)
or 320‑195(3); and
(db) the transfer
values of assets transferred by the company to a complying superannuation/FHSA
asset pool under subsection 320‑180(3) or 320‑185(1); and
(e) if an asset
(other than money) is transferred from or to a complying superannuation/FHSA
asset pool under subsection 320‑180(1) or (3), to a complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool under section 320‑185 or from a complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool under subsection 320‑195(2) or (3)—the
amount (if any) that is included in the company’s assessable income of the
income year in which the asset was transferred because of section 320‑200;
and
(f) the transfer
values of assets transferred by the company from the company’s *segregated exempt assets under subsection 320‑235(1) or 320‑250(2);
and
(g) if an asset
(other than money) is transferred to the company’s segregated exempt assets
under subsection 320‑235(3) or section 320‑240—the amount (if any)
that is included in the company’s assessable income because of section 320‑255;
and
(h) subject
to subsection (2), if the *value, at the end of the
income year, of the company’s liabilities under the *net
risk components of life insurance policies is less than the value, at the end
of the previous income year, of those liabilities—an amount equal to the
difference; and
Note: Where the value at the end of
the income year exceeds the value at the end of the previous income year, the
excess can be deducted: see section 320‑85.
(i) amounts
specified in agreements under section 295‑260; and
(j) *specified roll‑over amounts paid to the company; and
(ja) amounts imposed
by the company in respect of risk riders for *ordinary
investment policies in an income year in which the company did not receive any
life insurance premiums for those policies; and
(k) fees and charges
(not otherwise included in, or taken into account in working out, the company’s
assessable income) imposed by the company in respect of life insurance
policies; and
(l) if the company
is an *RSA provider—contributions made to *RSAs provided by the company that would be included in the company’s
assessable income under Subdivision 295‑C if that Subdivision applied to
the company.
(2) Paragraph (1)(h)
does not cover any liabilities under:
(a) a *life insurance policy that provides for *participating
benefits or *discretionary benefits; or
(b) an *exempt life insurance policy; or
(c) a *funeral policy.
(3) An amount included in
assessable income under paragraph (1)(i) is included for the income year
of the *life insurance company that includes the
last day of the transferor’s income year to which the agreement referred to in
section 295‑260 relates.
320‑30 Assessable income—special
provision for certain income years
(1) This
section applies to a *life insurance company for each
of the following income years (each a relevant income year):
(a) the
income year in which 1 July 2000 occurs;
(b) the
4 following income years.
Note: The
effect of this section is modified when the life insurance business of a life
insurance company is transferred to another life insurance company: see section 320‑340.
(2) If:
(a) the *value of the company’s liabilities at the end of 30 June 2000
under its *continuous disability policies (being the
value used by the company for the purposes of its *income
tax return);
exceeds
(b) the value of the
company’s liabilities at the end of 30 June 2000 under the *net risk components of its continuous disability policies as
calculated under subsection 320‑85(4);
the company’s assessable income for each
relevant income year includes an amount equal to one‑fifth of the excess.
(3) However, if a *life insurance company ceases in a relevant income year to carry on *life insurance business or to have any liabilities under the *net risk components of *continuous
disability policies, subsection (2) does not apply for that income year or
any future income years but the company’s assessable income for that income
year includes so much of the excess referred to in subsection (2) as has
not been included in the company’s assessable income for any previous relevant
income years.
320‑35 Exempt income
These amounts *derived by a *life insurance company
are exempt from income tax:
(a) amounts of *ordinary income and *statutory income accrued
before 1 July 1988 that were derived from assets that have become *complying superannuation/FHSA assets;
(b) if the company is
an *RSA provider—any amounts that are disregarded because of paragraph 320‑137(3)(d)
or (e) in working out the company’s taxable income of the *complying superannuation/FHSA class.
320‑37 Non‑assessable non‑exempt
income
(1) These amounts *derived by a *life insurance company
are not assessable income and are not *exempt income:
(a) amounts of
ordinary income and statutory income derived from *segregated
exempt assets, being income that relates to the period during which the assets
were segregated exempt assets;
(b) amounts of
ordinary income and statutory income derived from the *disposal
of units in a *pooled superannuation trust;
(c) if an *Australian/overseas fund or an *overseas
fund established by the company derived foreign establishment amounts—the
foreign resident proportion of the foreign establishment amounts;
(d) if the company is
a *friendly society:
(i) amounts
derived before 1 July 2001 that are exempt from income tax under section 50‑1;
and
(ii) amounts
derived on or after 1 July 2001 but before 1 January 2003, that are
attributable to *income bonds, *funeral
policies or *sickness policies; and
(iii) amounts
derived on or after 1 July 2001 but before 1 January 2003, that are
attributable to *scholarship plans and would have been
exempt from income tax under section 50‑1 if they had been received before
1 July 2001; and
(iv) amounts
derived on or after 1 January 2003 that are attributable to income bonds,
funeral policies or *sickness policies, that were
issued before 1 January 2003; and
(v) amounts
derived on or after 1 January 2003 that are attributable to scholarship
plans issued before 1 January 2003 and that would have been exempt from
income tax if they had been received before 1 July 2001.
Note: The effect of this section is
modified when the life insurance business of a life insurance company is
transferred to another life insurance company: see section 320‑325.
(1A) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(c),
foreign establishment amounts for the *life
insurance company means the total amount of assessable income that was *derived in the income year:
(a) in the course of
the carrying on by the company of a business in a foreign country at or through
a *permanent establishment of the company in that country; and
(b) from sources in
that or any other foreign country; and
(c) from assets that:
(i) are
attributable to the permanent establishment; and
(ii) are
held to meet the liabilities under the *life
insurance policies issued by the company at or through the permanent
establishment.
(2) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(c),
the foreign resident proportion of the *foreign
establishment amounts is the amount worked out using the formula:

where:
all foreign establishment policy
liabilities means the average value for the
income year (as calculated by an *actuary) of the policy
liabilities (as defined in the *Valuation Standard) for
all *life insurance policies that:
(a) were included in
the class of *life insurance business to which the
company’s *Australian/overseas fund or *overseas fund relates; and
(b) were issued by
the company at or through the *permanent
establishment to which the foreign establishment amounts relate.
foreign
resident foreign establishment policy liabilities means the average value for the income year (as calculated by an *actuary) of the policy liabilities (as defined in the *Valuation Standard) for all *life
insurance policies that:
(a) are *foreign resident life insurance policies; and
(b) were issued by
the company at or through the *permanent
establishment to which the foreign establishment amounts relate.
320‑45 Tax treatment of gains or
losses from CGT events in relation to complying superannuation/FHSA assets
(1) If
a *CGT event happens in respect of a *CGT
asset that is a *complying superannuation/FHSA asset of a *life insurance company, section 295‑85 and 295‑90 applies for
the purpose of working out the amount of any *capital
gain or *capital loss that arises from the event.
Note: See Subdivision 295‑B of
the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997 for rules about cost
base for assets owned by superannuation entities at the end of 30 June
1988.
(2) Subsection (1) has
effect despite anything in Division 230.
Subdivision 320‑C—Deductions and capital losses
Guide to Subdivision 320‑C
320‑50 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision
specifies particular deductions that are available to a life insurance company,
specifies particular amounts that a life insurance company cannot deduct and contains
provisions relating to a life insurance company’s capital losses.
Table
of sections
Operative
provisions
320‑55 Deduction for life
insurance premiums where liabilities under life insurance policies are to be
discharged from complying superannuation/FHSA assets
320‑60 Deduction for life
insurance premiums where liabilities under life insurance policies are to be
discharged from segregated exempt assets
320‑65 Deduction for life
insurance premiums in respect of life insurance policies that provide for
participating or discretionary benefits
320‑70 No deduction for life
insurance premiums in respect of certain life insurance policies payable only
on death or disability
320‑75 Deduction for ordinary
investment policies
320‑80 Deduction for certain
claims paid under life insurance policies
320‑85 Deduction for increase in
value of liabilities under net risk components of life insurance policies
320‑87 Deduction for assets
transferred from or to complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool
320‑100 Deduction for life
insurance premiums paid under certain contracts of reinsurance
320‑105 Deduction for assets
transferred to segregated exempt assets
320‑107 Deductions for increased
amount of lump sum death benefit
320‑110 Deduction for interest
credited to income bonds
320‑111 Deduction for funeral
policy payout
320‑112 Deduction for scholarship
plan payout
320‑115 No deduction for amounts
credited to RSAs
320‑120 Capital losses from assets
other than complying superannuation/FHSA assets or segregated exempt assets
320‑125 Capital losses from
complying superannuation/FHSA assets
Operative provisions
320‑55 Deduction for life insurance
premiums where liabilities under life insurance policies are to be discharged
from complying superannuation/FHSA assets
(1) This section applies to
a *life insurance company in respect of *life
insurance policies where the company’s liabilities under the policies are to be
discharged out of *complying superannuation/FHSA assets.
(2) The
company can deduct:
(a) the amounts of the
*life insurance premiums received in respect of the policies that are
transferred to its *complying superannuation/FHSA
assets in the income year;
less:
(b) so much of those
amounts as relate to the company’s liability to pay amounts on the death or disability
of a person.
(3) For the purposes of subsection (2)
only, the amount of a *life insurance premium
that relates to the company’s liability to pay amounts on the
death or disability of a person is:
(a) if the policy
provides for *participating benefits or *discretionary benefits—nil; or
(b) if paragraph (a)
does not apply and the policy states that the whole or a specified part of the
premium is payable in respect of such a liability—the whole or that part of the
premium, as appropriate; or
(c) if
neither paragraph (a) nor (b) applies:
(i) if
the policy is an *endowment policy—10% of the premium; or
(ii) if
the policy is a *whole of life policy—30% of the premium;
or
(iii) otherwise—so
much of the premium as an *actuary determines to be
attributable to such a liability.
320‑60 Deduction for life insurance
premiums where liabilities under life insurance policies are to be discharged
from segregated exempt assets
A *life insurance company can deduct the amounts of *life insurance premiums transferred in the income year to its *segregated exempt assets under subsection 320‑240(3).
320‑65 Deduction for life insurance
premiums in respect of life insurance policies that provide for participating
or discretionary benefits
A *life insurance company can deduct the amounts of *net premiums received in respect of *life
insurance policies (other than *complying
superannuation/FHSA life insurance policies or *exempt
life insurance policies) that provide for *participating
benefits or *discretionary benefits.
320‑70 No deduction for life
insurance premiums in respect of certain life insurance policies payable only
on death or disability
(1) A *life insurance company cannot deduct any part of the amounts of *life insurance premiums received in respect of *life insurance policies under which amounts are to be paid only on
the death or disability of a person.
(2) This
section does not apply to:
(a) *life insurance policies that provide for *participating
benefits or *discretionary benefits; or
(b) funeral policies.
320‑75 Deduction for ordinary
investment policies
(1) This section applies to
a *life insurance company in respect of *ordinary
investment policies issued by the company.
(2) The company can deduct,
in respect of *life insurance premiums received in the
income year for those policies:
(a) the sum of the *net premiums;
less:
(b) so much of the
net premiums as an *actuary determines to be
attributable to fees and charges charged in that income year.
(3) In making a determination
under subsection (2), an *actuary is to have
regard to:
(a) the changes over
the income year in the sum of the *net current
termination values of the policies; and
(b) the movements in
those values during the income year.
(4) In addition, if an *actuary determines that:
(a) there has been a
reduction in the income year (the current year) of exit fees that
were imposed in respect of those policies in a previous income year; and
(b) the reduction (or
a part of it) has not been taken into account in a determination under subsection (2)
for the current year;
the company can deduct so much of that
reduction as has not been so taken into account.
320‑80 Deduction for certain claims
paid under life insurance policies
(1) A *life insurance company can deduct the amounts paid in respect of the
*risk components of claims paid under *life
insurance policies during the income year.
(2) The risk component
of a claim paid under a *life insurance policy
is:
(a) if:
(i) the
policy does not provide for *participating benefits
or *discretionary benefits; and
(ii) the
policy is neither an *exempt life insurance policy nor
a *funeral policy; and
(iii) an
amount is payable under the policy only on the death or disability of the
insured person;
the amount paid
under the policy as a result of the occurrence of that event; or
(b) if the policy
provides for participating benefits or discretionary benefits or is an exempt
life insurance policy, *FHSA or a funeral
policy—nil; or
(c) otherwise—the
amount paid under the policy as a result of the death or disability of the
insured person less the *current termination
value of the policy (calculated by an *actuary)
immediately before the death, or the occurrence of the disability, of the
person.
(3) Except as provided by subsection (1),
a *life insurance company cannot deduct amounts paid in respect of
claims under *life insurance policies.
320‑85 Deduction for increase in
value of liabilities under net risk components of life insurance policies
(1) A *life insurance company can deduct the amount (if any) by which the *value, at the end of the income year, of its liabilities under the *net risk components of *life insurance
policies exceeds the value, at the end of the previous income year, of those
liabilities.
Note 1: Where the value at the end of
the income year is less than the value at the end of the previous income year,
the difference is included in assessable income: see paragraph 320‑15(1)(h).
Note 2: Section 320‑85 of the Income
Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997 makes special provision in respect
of the calculation of the value of a life insurance company’s liabilities under
the net risk components of life insurance policies at the end of the income
year immediately preceding the income year in which 1 July 2000 occurs.
(2) Subsection (1) does
not cover any liabilities under:
(a) a *life insurance policy that provides for *participating
benefits or *discretionary benefits; or
(b) an *exempt life insurance policy; or
(ba) is an *FHSA; or
(c) a *funeral policy.
(3) If a *life insurance policy is a *disability policy
(other than a *continuous disability policy), the value
at a particular time of the liabilities of the *life
insurance company under the *net risk component of
the policy is the *current termination value of the component
at that time (calculated by an *actuary).
(4) In the case of *life insurance policies other than policies to which subsection (3)
applies, the value at a particular time of the liabilities of the
*life insurance company under the *net
risk components of the policies is the amount calculated by an *actuary to be:
(a) the sum of the
policy liabilities (as defined in the *Valuation
Standard) in respect of the net risk components of the policies at that time;
less
(b) the sum of any
cumulative losses (as defined in the Valuation Standard) for the net risk
components of the policies at that time.
320‑87 Deduction for assets
transferred from or to complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool
(1) A *life insurance company can deduct the *transfer
values of assets that are transferred by the company in the income year from a *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool under subsection 320‑180(1)
or 320‑195(3).
(2) A *life insurance company can deduct the *transfer
values of assets that are transferred by the company in the income year to a *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool under subsection 320‑180(3)
or 320‑185(1).
(3) If an asset (other than
money) is transferred by a *life insurance company:
(a) from a *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool under subsection 320‑180(1)
or 320‑195(2) or (3); or
(b) to a complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool under subsection 320‑180(3) or section 320‑185;
the company can deduct the amount (if
any) that it can deduct because of section 320‑200.
320‑100 Deduction for life insurance
premiums paid under certain contracts of reinsurance
A *life insurance company can deduct amounts that:
(a) were paid by the
company in the income year as *life insurance premiums
under *contracts of reinsurance; and
(b) do not relate to
a risk, or part of a risk, in relation to which subsection 148(1) of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936 applies.
320‑105 Deduction for assets
transferred to segregated exempt assets
(1) A *life insurance company can deduct the *transfer
values of assets transferred in the income year to the company’s *segregated exempt assets under subsection 320‑235(3) or 320‑240(1).
(2) If an asset (other than
money) is transferred to a *life insurance company’s
*segregated exempt assets under subsection 320‑235(3) or section 320‑240,
the company can deduct the amount (if any) that it can deduct because of
section 320‑255.
320‑107 Deductions for increased
amount of lump sum death benefit
(1) A *life insurance company can deduct an amount under this section if:
(a) it pays a lump
sum because of the death of a person to the trustee of the deceased’s estate or
an individual who was a *spouse, former spouse or
*child of the deceased at the time of death or payment; and
(b) the payment is in
relation to the commutation of, or is of the capital amount payable on the
termination of, an *exempt life insurance policy or a
life insurance policy covered by subparagraph (b)(i) of the definition of complying
superannuation/FHSA life insurance policy in subsection 995‑1(1)
while the policy was held by the deceased by reason that the deceased would
have been entitled to receive the *annuity concerned;
and
(c) it increases the
lump sum by an amount (the tax saving amount) so that the amount of
the lump sum is the amount that the company could have paid if no tax were
payable on amounts included in its assessable income under Subdivision 320‑B.
(2) The company can deduct
the amount for the income year in which the lump sum is paid.
(3) The amount the company
can deduct is:

where:
complying superannuation/FHSA class
rate is the rate of tax imposed on the *complying superannuation/FHSA class of the company’s taxable income
for the income year.
(4) The amount the company
can deduct for a sum paid because of the death of a person to the trustee of
the deceased’s estate is so much of the subsection (3) amount as is
appropriate having regard to the extent to which individuals referred to in paragraph (1)(a)
can reasonably be expected to benefit from the estate.
320‑110 Deduction for interest
credited to income bonds
(1) A *life insurance company that is a *friendly
society can deduct interest credited in the income year to the holders of *income bonds issued after 31 December 2002 where the interest
accrued on or after 1 January 2003.
(2) This section has effect
despite subsection 320‑80(3).
320‑111 Deduction for funeral policy
payout
(1) A *life insurance company that is a *friendly
society can deduct the amount of a benefit provided in the income year by the
company under a *funeral policy issued after 31 December
2002, reduced by so much of the sum of the amounts deducted or deductible by
the company under section 320‑75 for any income year as is reasonably
related to the benefit.
(2) This section has effect
despite subsection 320‑80(3).
320‑112 Deduction for scholarship
plan payout
(1) A *life insurance company that is a *friendly
society can deduct the amount of a benefit it provides in the income year and
on or after 1 January 2003:
(a) under a *scholarship plan covered by subsection (2) or (3); and
(b) to, or on behalf
of, a person nominated in the plan as a beneficiary whose education is to be
helped by the benefit;
reduced by so much of the sum of the
amounts deducted or deductible by the company under section 320‑75 for any
income year as is reasonably related to the benefit.
(2) This subsection covers a
*scholarship plan issued by the *life
insurance company after 31 December 2002.
(3) This subsection covers a
*scholarship plan if:
(a) the plan was
issued by the *life insurance company before 1 January
2003; and
(b) no amount
received by the company on or after 1 January 2003 and attributable to the
plan is *non‑assessable non‑exempt income of the
company under paragraph 320‑37(1)(d).
(4) This section has effect
despite subsection 320‑80(3).
320‑115 No deduction for amounts
credited to RSAs
A *life insurance company that is an *RSA
provider cannot deduct amounts credited to *RSAs.
320‑120 Capital losses from assets
other than complying superannuation/FHSA assets or segregated exempt assets
(1) This section applies to
assets (ordinary assets) of a *life
insurance company other than:
(a) *complying superannuation/FHSA assets; or
(b) *segregated exempt assets.
(2) In working out a *life insurance company’s *net capital gain
or *net capital loss for the income year, *capital
losses from ordinary assets can be used only to reduce *capital
gains from ordinary assets.
(3) If some or all of a *capital loss from an ordinary asset cannot be applied in an income
year, the unapplied amount can be applied in the next income year in which the
company’s *capital gains from ordinary assets exceed
the company’s capital losses (if any) from ordinary assets.
(4) If the company has 2 or
more unapplied *net capital losses from ordinary assets,
the company must apply them in the order in which they were made.
Note: This section affects the
amount of assessable income that is to be taken into account in working out a
taxable income or tax loss of the ordinary class: see sections 320‑139 and
320‑143.
320‑125 Capital losses from
complying superannuation/FHSA assets
(1) In working out a *life insurance company’s *net capital gain
or *net capital loss for the income year, *capital
losses from *complying superannuation/FHSA assets can
be used only to reduce *capital gains from
complying superannuation/FHSA assets.
(2) If some or all of a *capital loss from a *complying
superannuation/FHSA asset cannot be applied in an income year, the unapplied
amount can be applied in the next income year in which the company’s *capital gains from *complying
superannuation/FHSA assets exceed the company’s capital losses (if any) from
complying superannuation/FHSA assets.
(3) If the company has 2 or
more unapplied *net capital losses from *complying superannuation/FHSA assets, the company must apply them in
the order in which they were made.
Note: This section affects the
amount of assessable income that is to be taken into account in working out a
taxable income or tax loss of the complying superannuation/FHSA class: see
sections 320‑137 and 320‑141.
Subdivision 320‑D—Income tax, taxable income and tax loss of life insurance
companies
Guide to Subdivision 320‑D
320‑130 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision
explains how a life insurance company’s income tax is worked out.
For that purpose,
this Subdivision enables a life insurance company to have taxable incomes and
tax losses of the following classes:
• the
complying superannuation/FHSA class;
• the
ordinary class.
320‑131 Overview of Subdivision
Working out the income tax
(1) In any income year, a
life insurance company can have:
(a) a taxable income
of the complying superannuation/FHSA class and/or a taxable income of the
ordinary class; or
(b) a tax loss of the
complying superannuation/FHSA class and/or a tax loss of the ordinary class; or
(c) a taxable income
of one class and a tax loss of the other class.
Note: The taxable incomes mentioned
in paragraph (a) are taxed at different rates: see section 23A of the
Income Tax Rates Act 1986.
(2) Taxable incomes and tax
losses of both classes are taken into account in working out the amount of
income tax that the company has to pay for the income year (see section 320‑134).
That amount is then taken to be the income tax on the company’s taxable income
for that income year.
Working out taxable income and tax
loss of each class
(3) In general, the rules in
this Act about working out a company’s taxable income or tax loss, or deducting
a company’s tax loss, apply to a life insurance company in relation to:
(a) working out a
taxable income or tax loss of a particular class; or
(b) deducting a tax
loss of a particular class.
(4) However, that general
rule is subject to the following:
(a) sections 320‑137
to 320‑143, which allocate amounts of incomes and deductions for the purposes
of working out a taxable income or tax loss of a particular class;
(b) subsections 320‑141(2)
and 320‑143(2), which provide that tax losses of a particular class can be
deducted only from incomes in respect of that class;
(c) section 320‑149,
which sets out the provisions in this Act that have effect only in relation to
a taxable income or tax loss of the ordinary class.
Table of sections
General rules
320‑133 Object of Subdivision
320‑134 Income tax of a life
insurance company
320‑135 Taxable income and tax
loss of each of the 2 classes
Taxable income and tax loss of
life insurance companies
320‑137 Taxable income—complying superannuation/FHSA
class
320‑139 Taxable income—ordinary
class
320‑141 Tax loss—complying
superannuation/FHSA class
320‑143 Tax loss—ordinary class
320‑149 Provisions that apply only
in relation to the ordinary class
General rules
320‑133 Object of Subdivision
(1) The object of this
Subdivision is to ensure that:
(a) for the purposes
of working out the amount of a *life insurance company’s
income tax for an income year:
(i) the
company’s taxable income or *tax loss of one *class is worked out separately from its taxable income or tax loss
of the other class; and
(ii) the
company’s tax losses of a particular class can be deducted only from its
incomes in respect of that class; and
(b) for the purposes
of this Act, that amount of income tax is treated as the company’s income tax
on its taxable income for that income year.
(2) In subsection (1),
a class means the *complying
superannuation/FHSA class or the *ordinary class.
320‑134 Income tax of a life
insurance company
Working out the income tax
(1) Work out a *life insurance company’s income tax for an income year under section 4‑10
as follows:
(a) apply steps 1 and 2 of the method statement in subsection 4‑10(3) to work out separately the amount
that would be the company’s basic income tax liability for its taxable income
of each *class for that year;
(b) treat the sum of
these amounts as the company’s basic income tax liability for that year and
apply step 4 of the method statement to subtract its *tax
offsets from that sum.
(2) For
the purposes of this Act:
(a) the income tax
worked out in accordance with subsection (1) is taken to be the company’s
income tax on its taxable income for the income year; and
(b) except as
provided by subsection (1) of this section and sections 320‑135 to
320‑149, the company’s taxable income for that year is taken to be equal to the
sum of the company’s taxable incomes of the 2 *classes
for that year.
Note: This means that there is only
one assessment in respect of the company’s taxable income for the income year
and that the income tax constitutes only one debt to the Commonwealth.
Working out the income tax on certain
assumptions
(3) Subsection (1) also
has effect in relation to working out an amount that would be the company’s
income tax if certain assumptions were made. It has that effect in the same way
as it has effect in relation to working out the company’s income tax under
section 4‑10 (except in regard to those assumptions).
Note: This means, for example, subsection (1)
also has effect in relation to working out the amount of a life insurance
company’s income tax on the basis of the tax offset priority rules in Division 63.
320‑135 Taxable income and tax loss
of each of the 2 classes
(1) Subject to the other
provisions in this Subdivision:
(a) this Act has
effect for a *life insurance company in relation to
working out a taxable income of a particular *class
in the same way as it has effect in relation to working out a taxable income of
any other company; and
(b) this Act has
effect for a life insurance company in relation to working out or deducting a *tax loss of a particular class in the same way as it has effect in
relation to working out or deducting a tax loss of any other company.
(2) Sections 320‑137 to
320‑143 have effect in addition to other provisions in this Act that relate to
working out a taxable income or *tax loss, or deducting a
tax loss (as appropriate).
(3) Nothing
in this Subdivision prevents a *life insurance company
from:
(a) having taxable incomes,
or *tax losses, of both *classes for the same
income year; or
(b) having a taxable
income of one class and a tax loss of the other class for the same income year.
Note: In certain circumstances, a
life insurance company can have a taxable income and a tax loss of the same
class in an income year (see Subdivision 165‑B as it has effect under this
Subdivision).
Taxable income and
tax loss of life insurance companies
320‑137 Taxable income—complying
superannuation/FHSA class
(1) A *life insurance company’s taxable income of the complying
superannuation/FHSA class is a taxable income worked out under
this Act on the basis of only:
(a) assessable income
of the company that is covered by subsection (2); and
(b) deductions of the
company that are covered by subsection (4); and
(c) *tax losses of the company that are of the *complying
superannuation/FHSA class.
Note: For the usual way of working
out a taxable income: see subsection 4‑15(1). For other ways of working
out a taxable income: see subsection 4‑15(2).
Relevant assessable income
(2) This subsection covers
the following assessable income of a *life insurance
company:
(a) assessable income
*derived by the company from the investment of its *complying superannuation/FHSA assets in relation to the period
during which those assets were complying superannuation/FHSA assets;
(b) so much of the
amount that is included in the company’s assessable income because of paragraph 320‑15(1)(a)
as is equal to the total *transfer value of assets
transferred in the income year by the company to a *complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool under subsection 320‑185(3);
(c) if an asset
(other than money) is transferred by the company from a complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool under subsection 320‑180(1) or 320‑195(2)
or (3)—amounts that are included in the company’s assessable income because of
section 320‑200;
(d) amounts that are
included in the company’s assessable income because of paragraph 320‑15(1)(db),
(i) or (j);
(e) amounts that are
included in the company’s assessable income under subsection 115‑280(4);
(f) subject to subsection (3),
so much of the company’s assessable income for the income year as is:
(i) the
total amount credited during that year to the *RSAs
provided by the company; less
(ii) the
total amount debited during that year from the RSAs.
Amounts disregarded for RSAs
(3) In working out the
amount mentioned in paragraph (2)(f), disregard the following amounts:
(a) contributions
credited to the *RSAs that would not be included in the company’s
assessable income under Subdivision 295‑C if that Subdivision applied to
the company;
(b) amounts debited
from the RSAs that are benefits paid to, or in respect of, the holders of the
RSAs;
(c) income tax
debited from the RSAs;
(d) if an *annuity was paid from an RSA in respect of the whole of the income
year, or the whole of the part of the income year in which the RSA existed, the
total amount credited to the RSA during the income year;
(e) if an annuity was
paid from an RSA in respect of a part, but not the whole, of the portion of the
income year in which the RSA existed, so much of the total amount credited to
the RSA during the income year as is equal to the amount worked out using the
following formula:

Relevant deductions
(4) This subsection covers
the following deductions of a *life insurance company:
(a) amounts that the
company can deduct under section 320‑55;
(b) amounts that the
company can deduct (other than any *tax losses) in
respect of the investment of the company’s *complying
superannuation/FHSA assets in relation to the period during which those assets
were complying superannuation/FHSA assets;
(c) amounts that the
company can deduct under section 320‑87 because of subsection (1) or paragraph (3)(a)
of that section;
(d) amounts that the
company can deduct under subsection 115‑280(1).
320‑139 Taxable income—ordinary
class
A
*life insurance company’s taxable income of the ordinary class is
a taxable income worked out under this Act on the basis of only:
(a) assessable
income of the company that is not covered by subsection 320‑137(2); and
(b) amounts
(other than *tax losses) that the company can deduct
and are not covered by subsection 320‑137(4); and
(c) tax losses of the
company that are of the *ordinary class.
Note: For the usual way of working
out a taxable income: see subsection 4‑15(1). For other ways of working
out a taxable income: see subsection 4‑15(2).
320‑141 Tax loss—complying
superannuation/FHSA class
Working out a tax loss of the
complying superannuation/FHSA class
(1) A *life insurance company’s *tax loss of the complying
superannuation/FHSA class is a tax loss worked out under this Act on
the basis of only:
(a) assessable income
of the company that is covered by subsection 320‑137(2); and
(b) deductions of the
company that are covered by subsection 320‑137(4); and
(c) *net exempt income of the company that is attributable to *exempt income *derived:
(i) from
the company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA assets; and
(ii) in
relation to the period during which those assets were complying
superannuation/FHSA assets.
Note: For the usual way of working
out a tax loss: see section 36‑10. For other ways of working out a tax
loss: see section 36‑25.
Deducting a tax loss of the complying
superannuation/FHSA class
(2) A *life insurance company’s *tax loss of the complying
superannuation/FHSA class can be deducted under this Act only from:
(a) *net exempt income of the company that is attributable to *exempt income *derived:
(i) from
the company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA assets; and
(ii) in
relation to the period during which those assets were complying
superannuation/FHSA assets; and
(b) assessable income
of the company that is covered by subsection 320‑137(2), reduced by
deductions of the company that are covered by subsection 320‑137(4).
Note: For the usual way of
deducting a tax loss: see section 36‑17. For other ways of deducting a tax
loss: see section 36‑25.
320‑143 Tax loss—ordinary class
Working out a tax loss of the ordinary
class
(1) A *life insurance company’s *tax loss of the ordinary
class is a tax loss worked out under this Act on the basis of only:
(a) assessable income
of the company that is not covered by subsection 320‑137(2); and
(b) amounts (other
than tax losses) that the company can deduct and are not covered by subsection 320‑137(4);
and
(c) *net exempt income of the company that is not attributable to *exempt income *derived:
(i) from
the company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA assets; and
(ii) in
relation to the period during which those assets were complying
superannuation/FHSA assets.
Note: For the usual way of working
out a tax loss: see section 36‑10. For other ways of working out a tax
loss: see section 36‑25.
Deducting a tax loss of the ordinary
class
(2) A *life insurance company’s *tax loss of the ordinary
class can be deducted under this Act only from:
(a) *net exempt income of the company that is not attributable to *exempt income *derived:
(i) from
the company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA assets; and
(ii) in
relation to the period during which those assets were complying
superannuation/FHSA assets; and
(b) assessable income
of the company that is not covered by subsection 320‑137(2), reduced by
amounts (other than tax losses) that the company can deduct and are not covered
by subsection 320‑137(4).
Note: For the usual way of
deducting a tax loss: see section 36‑17. For other ways of deducting a tax
loss: see section 36‑25.
320‑149 Provisions that apply only
in relation to the ordinary class
(1) The
provisions covered by subsection (2):
(a) have effect as
provided by section 320‑135 in relation to a *life
insurance company’s taxable income, or *tax
loss, of the *ordinary class; but
(b) have no effect in
relation to the company’s taxable income, or tax loss, of the *complying superannuation/FHSA class.
(2) This subsection covers
these provisions:
(a) section 36‑55;
(b) Division 165
(except Subdivision 165‑CD).
Example 1: A life insurance company that has
an amount of excess franking offsets will need to recalculate its tax loss of
the ordinary class under section 36‑55. But its tax loss of the complying
superannuation/FHSA class is unaffected by that section.
Example 2: A life insurance company that
fails to meet the relevant tests of Division 165 will need to recalculate
the ordinary class of its taxable income and tax loss under Subdivision 165‑B.
But the complying superannuation/FHSA class of its taxable income and tax loss
are unaffected by that Subdivision.
Subdivision 320‑E—No‑TFN contributions of life insurance companies that are
RSA providers
Guide to Subdivision 320‑E
320‑150 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision
makes Subdivisions 295‑I and 295‑J apply to life insurance companies that
are RSA providers.
The consequence is
that those life insurance companies are liable to pay tax on no‑TFN
contributions income under Subdivision 295‑I. They may also be entitled to
a tax offset under Subdivision 295‑J.
Table
of sections
Operative
provisions
320‑155 Subdivisions 295‑I
and 295‑J apply to companies that are RSA providers
Operative provisions
320‑155 Subdivisions 295‑I and
295‑J apply to companies that are RSA providers
(1) Despite subsection 295‑5(4),
Subdivisions 295‑I and 295‑J apply to a *life
insurance company that is an *RSA provider.
(2) For the purposes of the
application of those Subdivisions to a *life
insurance company, a contribution included in the assessable income of the
company under paragraph 320‑15(1)(l) is taken to have been included under
Subdivision 295‑C.
Subdivision 320‑F—Complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool
Guide to Subdivision 320‑F
320‑165 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision
explains how a life insurance company can segregate assets (to be known as a complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool) to be used for the sole purpose of
discharging its complying superannuation liabilities.
Table
of sections
Operative provisions
320‑170 Establishment of complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool
320‑175 Valuations of complying
superannuation/FHSA assets and complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities for
each valuation time
320‑180 Consequences of a
valuation under section 320‑175
320‑185 Transfer of assets to
complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool otherwise than as a result of a
valuation under section 320‑175
320‑190 Complying
superannuation/FHSA liabilities
320‑195 Transfer of assets and
payment of amounts from a complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool otherwise
than as a result of a valuation under section 320‑175
320‑200 Consequences of transfer
of assets to or from complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool
Operative provisions
320‑170 Establishment of complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool
(1) A *life insurance company may, on or after 1 July 2000, segregate
in accordance with subsections (2) and (3) any of its assets for the sole
purpose of discharging its *complying
superannuation/FHSA liabilities out of those assets.
(1A) Except as provided by
section 320‑170 of the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997,
an asset is taken not to be included in the *complying
superannuation/FHSA assets unless the whole of the asset is included among
those assets.
(2) The assets segregated
must, at the time of the segregation, be a representative sample of all the
company’s assets that support its *complying
superannuation/FHSA liabilities immediately before the segregation.
(3) The assets segregated
must have, as at the time of the segregation, a total *transfer
value that does not exceed the sum of:
(a) the company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities as at that time; and
(b) any reasonable
provision made by the company at that time in its accounts for liability for
income tax in respect of the assets segregated.
(4) A *life insurance company that segregates assets as mentioned in subsections (1)
to (3) at a time after 1 July 2000 but before 1 October 2000 is taken
to have segregated those assets in accordance with those subsections on 1 July
2000.
(5) If a segregation of
assets is made in accordance with the above subsections, the company must use
the segregated assets, and any other assets afterwards included among the
segregated assets, only for the purpose of discharging its *complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities.
(6) The assets from time to
time segregated are together to be known as the complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool and each asset from time to time
included among those assets is to be known as a complying
superannuation/FHSA asset.
(7) In this Subdivision:
(a) a reference to
the transfer of an asset to, or from, the *complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool:
(i) is a
reference to the inclusion of the asset among the segregated assets, or the
exclusion of an asset from the segregated assets, as the case may be; and
(ii) includes
a reference to the transfer of money to, or from, the complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool, as the case may be; and
(b) if an asset
transferred to or from the complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool is money, a
reference to the *transfer value of the asset transferred is
a reference to the amount of the money.
320‑175 Valuations of complying
superannuation/FHSA assets and complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities for
each valuation time
(1) A *life insurance company that has established a *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool must cause the following
amounts to be calculated within the period of 60 days starting immediately
after each *valuation time:
(a) the total *transfer value of the company’s *complying
superannuation/FHSA assets as at the valuation time;
(b) the company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities as at the valuation time.
Note: The time when a life
insurance company joins or leaves a consolidated group is also a valuation
time: see section 713‑525.
(2) These
are the valuation times:
(a) the end of the
income year in which the *complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool was established;
(b) the end of each
later income year.
Note 1: The time when a life insurance
company joins or leaves a consolidated group is also a valuation time: see sections 713‑525
and 713‑585.
Note 2: A life insurance company that
fails to comply with this section is liable to an administrative penalty: see
section 288‑70 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation Administration Act
1953.
320‑180 Consequences of a valuation
under section 320‑175
Transfer from the complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool
(1) If the total *transfer value of the company’s *complying
superannuation/FHSA assets as at a *valuation time
exceeds the sum of:
(a) the company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities as at that time; and
(b) any reasonable
provision made by the company at that time in its accounts for liability for
income tax in respect of those assets;
the company must transfer, from the *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool, assets of any kind having
a total transfer value equal to the excess.
(2) A transfer under subsection (1)
must be made within the period of 30 days starting immediately after:
(a) the day on which
the total *transfer value and the *complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities (as at the *valuation time) were calculated; or
(b) if those amounts
were calculated on different days—the later of those days.
The transfer, once made, is taken to have
been made at the valuation time (whether or not the transfer is made within
those 30 days).
Note: A life insurance company that
fails to comply with subsections (1) and (2) is liable to an
administrative penalty: see section 288‑70 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation
Administration Act 1953.
Transfer to the complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool
(3) If the total *transfer value of the company’s *complying
superannuation/FHSA assets as at a *valuation time is
less than the sum of:
(a) the company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities as at that time; and
(b) any reasonable
provision made by the company at that time in its accounts for liability for
income tax in respect of those assets;
the company can transfer, to the *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool, assets of any kind having
a total transfer value not exceeding the difference.
(4) A transfer under subsection (3)
is taken to have been made at the *valuation time if
it is made within the period of 30 days starting immediately after:
(a) the day on which
the total *transfer value and the *complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities (as at the valuation time)
were calculated; or
(b) if those amounts
were calculated on different days—the later of those days.
320‑185 Transfer of assets to
complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool otherwise than as a result of a
valuation under section 320‑175
(1) If a *life insurance company determines, at a time other than a *valuation time, that the total *transfer
value of the company’s *complying
superannuation/FHSA assets as at that time is less than the sum of:
(a) the company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities as at that time; and
(b) any reasonable
provision made by the company at that time in its accounts for liability for
income tax in respect of those assets;
the company can transfer, to the *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool, assets of any kind having
a total transfer value not exceeding the difference.
(2) A *life insurance company can at any time transfer an asset of any kind
to a *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool
in exchange for an amount of money equal to the *transfer
value of the asset at the time of the transfer.
(3) A *life insurance company can transfer to a *complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool in an income year assets of any kind having a
total *transfer value not exceeding the total
amount of the *life insurance premiums paid to the
company in that income year for the purchase of *complying
superannuation/FHSA life insurance policies.
(4) Except as provided by
this section and subsection 320‑180(3), a *life
insurance company cannot transfer an asset to a *complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool.
320‑190 Complying
superannuation/FHSA liabilities
(1) The amount of the *complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities of a *life insurance company is to be worked out in accordance with subsection (2)
in respect only of *life insurance policies issued by
the company:
(a) that are *complying superannuation/FHSA life insurance policies; and
(b) the liabilities
under which are to be discharged out of the company’s *complying
superannuation/FHSA assets.
(2) The amount of the complying
superannuation/FHSA liabilities of a *life
insurance company at a particular time is the sum of the following amounts at
that time, as calculated by an *actuary:
(a) for policies
providing for *participating benefits or *discretionary benefits:
(i) the
values of supporting assets, as defined in the *Valuation
Standard; and
(ii) the *policy owners’ retained profits;
(b) for other
policies—the *current termination values.
320‑195 Transfer of assets and
payment of amounts from a complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool otherwise
than as a result of a valuation under section 320‑175
(1) If:
(a) a *life insurance policy issued by a *life
insurance company becomes an *exempt life insurance
policy; and
(b) immediately
before the policy became an exempt life insurance policy, the policy was a
policy referred to in subsection 320‑190(1);
the company can transfer from a *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool, to its *segregated exempt assets, assets of any kind whose total *transfer value does not exceed the company’s liabilities in respect
of the policy.
(2) A *life insurance company can at any time transfer an asset from a *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool in exchange for an amount
of money equal to the *transfer value of the
asset at the time of the transfer.
(3) If a *life insurance company:
(a) imposes any fees
or charges in respect of *complying superannuation/FHSA
assets; or
(b) imposes any fees
or charges in respect of *complying
superannuation/FHSA life insurance policies other than policies:
(i) that
provide *superannuation death benefits, *disability superannuation benefits or temporary disability benefits
of a kind referred to in paragraph 295‑460(c), that are *participating benefits; and
(ii) the
liabilities under which are to be discharged out of the company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool; or
(c) determines, at a
time other than a *valuation time, that the total *transfer value of the company’s complying superannuation/FHSA assets
as at that time exceeds the sum of:
(i) the
company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA liabilities
at that time; and
(ii) any
reasonable provision made by the company at that time in its accounts for
liability for income tax in respect of those assets;
the company must, when the fees or
charges are imposed or the excess is determined, as the case may be, transfer,
from the *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool,
assets having a total transfer value equal to the fees, charges or excess, as
the case may be.
(4) If:
(a) any liabilities
arise for the discharge of which a *life insurance
company’s *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool
is established; or
(b) any expenses are
incurred by a life insurance company directly in respect of *complying superannuation/FHSA assets in relation to a period during
which the assets are complying superannuation/FHSA assets; or
(c) any liabilities
to pay *PAYG instalments, or income tax, that are
attributable to the company’s *complying
superannuation/FHSA assets;
the life insurance company must pay, from
the complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool, any amounts required to discharge
the liabilities, or amounts equal to the expenses (as appropriate).
320‑200 Consequences of transfer of
assets to or from complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool
(1) This section applies if:
(a) an asset (other
than money) is transferred from a *complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool under subsection 320‑180(1) or 320‑195(2)
or (3); or
(b) an asset (other
than money) is transferred to a complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool under
subsection 320‑180(3) or section 320‑185.
(2) In determining:
(a) for the purposes
of this Act (other than Parts 3‑1 and 3‑3) whether an amount is included
in, or can be deducted from, the assessable income of a *life insurance company in respect of the transfer of the asset; or
(b) for the purposes
of Parts 3‑1 and 3‑3:
(i) whether
the company made a *capital gain in respect of the
transfer of the asset; or
(ii) whether
the company made a *capital loss in respect of the
transfer of the asset;
the company is taken:
(c) to have sold,
immediately before the transfer, the asset transferred for a consideration
equal to its *market value; and
(d) to have purchased
the asset again at the time of the transfer for a consideration equal to its
market value.
(2A) Without limiting subsection (2),
where the asset transferred is a *depreciating asset,
Division 40 has effect for the company as if:
(a) in relation to
the sale of the asset that is taken to have occurred under paragraph (2)(c):
(i) the
sale were a *balancing adjustment event; and
(ii) the *termination value of the asset for that event were equal to the
consideration for the sale under that paragraph; and
(iii) the
company had stopped *holding the asset at the time of
the sale; and
(b) in relation to
the purchase of the asset that is taken to have occurred under paragraph (2)(d):
(i) the
company had only begun to hold the asset after the purchase; and
(ii) the
first element of the asset’s *cost were equal to the
consideration for the purchase under that paragraph; and
(iii) the
company had acquired the asset from an *associate
of the company.
Note: This means that, amongst
other things, as a result of the transfer:
·
the asset’s cost for the purposes of working
out a deduction under Division 40 is reset; and
·
the company’s assessable income might be
adjusted under section 40‑285.
(3) If, apart from this
subsection and section 320‑55, a *life insurance
company could deduct an amount or make a *capital
loss as a result of a transfer of an asset to or from its *complying superannuation/FHSA asset pool, the deduction or capital
loss is disregarded until:
(a) the asset ceases
to exist; or
(b) the asset, or a
greater than 50% interest in it, is *acquired by an
entity other than an entity that is an *associate
of the company immediately after the transfer.
(4) Subsection (3) does
not apply in relation to an amount that the company can deduct under a
provision in Division 40.
Subdivision 320‑H—Segregation of assets to discharge exempt life insurance
policy liabilities
Guide to Subdivision 320‑H
320‑220 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision explains
how a life insurance company can segregate assets to be used for the sole
purpose of discharging its liabilities under life insurance policies where the
income derived by the company from those policies is exempt from income tax.
Table
of sections
Operative provisions
320‑225 Segregation of assets for
purpose of discharging exempt life insurance policy liabilities
320‑230 Valuations of segregated
exempt assets and exempt life insurance policy liabilities for each valuation
time
320‑235 Consequences of a
valuation under section 320‑230
320‑240 Transfer of assets to
segregated exempt assets otherwise than as a result of a valuation under
section 320‑230
320‑245 Exempt life insurance
policy liabilities
320‑246 Exempt life insurance
policy
320‑247 Policy split into an
exempt life insurance policy and another life insurance policy
320‑250 Transfer of assets and
payment of amounts from segregated exempt assets otherwise than as a result of
a valuation under section 320‑230
320‑255 Consequences of transfer of
assets to or from segregated exempt assets
Operative provisions
320‑225 Segregation of assets for
purpose of discharging exempt life insurance policy liabilities
(1) A *life insurance company may, on or after 1 July 2000, segregate
in accordance with subsections (2) and (3) any of its assets for the sole
purpose of discharging its *exempt life insurance
policy liabilities out of those assets.
Note: Section 320‑225 of the Income
Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997 provides that a life insurance company
may transfer a part of an asset to its segregated exempt assets before 1 October
2000.
(1A) Except as provided by
section 320‑225 of the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997,
an asset is taken not to be included in the segregated assets under this
Subdivision unless the whole of the asset is included among the segregated
assets.
(2) The assets segregated
must, at the time of the segregation, be a representative sample of all the
company’s assets that support its *exempt life
insurance policy liabilities immediately before the segregation.
(3) The assets segregated
must have, as at the time of the segregation, a total *transfer
value that does not exceed the amount of the company’s *exempt
life insurance policy liabilities as at that time.
(4) A *life insurance company that segregates assets as mentioned in subsections (1)
to (3) at a time after 1 July 2000 but before 1 October 2000 is taken
to have segregated those assets in accordance with those subsections on 1 July
2000.
(5) If a segregation of
assets is made in accordance with the above subsections, the company must use
the *segregated exempt assets, and any other
assets afterwards included among the segregated assets, only for the purpose of
discharging its *exempt life insurance policy liabilities.
(6) In
this Subdivision:
(a) a
reference to the transfer of an asset to, or from, a *life
insurance company’s *segregated exempt assets:
(i) is a
reference to the inclusion of an asset among the segregated exempt assets, or
the exclusion of an asset from the segregated exempt assets, as the case may
be; and
(ii) includes
a reference to the transfer of money to, or from, those assets, as the case may
be; and
(b) if an asset
transferred to or from those assets is money, a reference to the *transfer value of the asset transferred is a reference to the amount
of the money.
320‑230 Valuations of segregated
exempt assets and exempt life insurance policy liabilities for each valuation
time
(1) A *life insurance company that has segregated any of its assets in
accordance with section 320‑225 must cause the following amounts to be
calculated within the period of 60 days starting immediately after each *valuation time:
(a) the total *transfer value of the company’s *segregated
exempt assets as at the valuation time;
(b) the amount of the
company’s *exempt life insurance policy liabilities
as at the valuation time.
Note: The time when a life
insurance company joins or leaves a consolidated group is also a valuation
time: see section 713‑525.
(2) These are the valuation
times:
(a) the end of the
income year in which the segregation occurred;
(b) the end of each
later income year.
Note 1: The time when a life insurance
company joins or leaves a consolidated group is also a valuation time: see
sections 713‑525 and 713‑585.
Note 2: A life insurance company that
fails to comply with this section is liable to an administrative penalty: see
section 288‑70 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation Administration Act
1953.
320‑235 Consequences of a valuation
under section 320‑230
Transfer from the segregated exempt
assets
(1) If:
(a) the total *transfer value of the company’s *segregated
exempt assets as at a *valuation time;
exceeds
(b) the amount of the
company’s *exempt life insurance policy liabilities
as at that time;
the company must transfer, from the
segregated exempt assets, assets of any kind having a total transfer value
equal to the excess.
(2) A transfer under subsection (1)
must be made within the period of 30 days starting immediately after:
(a) the day on which
the total *transfer value and the *exempt life insurance policy liabilities (as at the *valuation time) were calculated; or
(b) if those amounts
were calculated on different days—the later of those days.
The transfer, once made, is taken to have
been made at the valuation time (whether or not the transfer is made within
those 30 days).
Note: A life insurance company that
fails to comply with subsections (1) and (2) is liable to an
administrative penalty: see section 288‑70 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation
Administration Act 1953.
Transfer to the segregated exempt
assets
(3) If:
(a) the
total *transfer value of the company’s *segregated exempt assets as at a *valuation
time;
is less than
(b) the amount of the
company’s *exempt life insurance policy liabilities
as at that time;
the company can transfer, to the
segregated exempt assets, assets of any kind having a total transfer value not
exceeding the difference.
(4) A transfer under subsection (3)
is taken to have been made at the *valuation time if
it is made within the period of 30 days starting immediately after:
(a) the day on which
the total *transfer value and the *exempt life insurance policy liabilities (as at the valuation time)
were calculated; or
(b) if those amounts
were calculated on different days—the later of those days.
320‑240 Transfer of assets to
segregated exempt assets otherwise than as a result of a valuation under
section 320‑230
(1) If a *life insurance company determines, at a time other than a *valuation time, that:
(a) the total *transfer value of the company’s *segregated
exempt assets as at that time;
is less than
(b) the company’s *exempt life insurance policy liabilities as at that time;
the company can transfer, to the segregated
exempt assets, assets of any kind having a total transfer value not exceeding
the difference.
(2) A *life insurance company can at any time transfer an asset of any kind
to its *segregated exempt assets in exchange for
an amount of money equal to the *transfer value of the
asset at the time of the transfer.
(3) A *life insurance company can transfer, to its *segregated
exempt assets in an income year, assets of any kind having a total *transfer value not exceeding the total amount of the *life insurance premiums paid to the company in that income year for
the purchase of *exempt life insurance policies.
(4) Except as provided by
this section and subsections 320‑195(1) and 320‑235(3), a *life insurance company cannot transfer an asset to its *segregated exempt assets.
320‑245 Exempt life insurance policy
liabilities
(1) The amount of the *exempt life insurance policy liabilities of a *life insurance company is to be worked out in accordance with subsection (2)
in respect only of *life insurance policies issued by
the company:
(a) that are *exempt life insurance policies; and
(b) the liabilities
under which are to be discharged out of the company’s *segregated
exempt assets.
(2) The amount of the exempt
life insurance policy liabilities of a *life
insurance company at a particular time is the sum of the following amounts at
that time, as calculated by an *actuary:
(a) for policies
providing for allocated benefits (other than *participating
benefits or *discretionary benefits)—the *current termination values;
(b) for policies
providing for participating benefits or discretionary benefits:
(i) the
values of supporting assets, as defined in the *Valuation
Standard; and
(ii) the *policy owner’s retained profits;
(c) for other
policies—the policy liabilities, as defined in the Valuation Standard.
(3) An *exempt life insurance policy provides for allocated benefits
if:
(a) the policy:
(i) is
held by the trustee of a *complying superannuation
fund; and
(iii) provides
for an *allocated pension; or
(b) the policy:
(i) is
held by a *life insurance company other than the life
insurance company that issued the policy; and
(ii) is a *segregated exempt asset of the life insurance company that issued
the policy; and
(iii) provides
for an allocated pension; or
(c) the policy
provides for an *allocated annuity.
320‑246 Exempt life insurance policy
(1) An exempt life insurance policy is
a *life insurance policy (other than an *RSA):
(a) that is held by
the trustee of a *complying superannuation fund and provides
solely for the discharge of the fund’s liabilities (contingent or not) in
respect of *superannuation income stream benefits that
are currently payable by the fund; or
(b) that is held by
the trustee of a *pooled superannuation trust, where:
(i) the
policy provides solely for the discharge of the liabilities (contingent or not)
in respect of *superannuation income stream benefits that
are currently payable by complying superannuation funds; and
(ii) the
funds are unit holders of the trust; or
(c) that is held by
another *life insurance company and is a *segregated exempt asset of that other company; or
(d) that is held by
the trustee of a *constitutionally protected fund; or
(e) that
provides for an *immediate annuity that:
(i) was
purchased on or before 9 December 1987; or
(ii) is a *superannuation income stream; or
(iii) satisfies
whichever of the conditions in subsection (3) are applicable; or
(f) that provides
for either or both of the following:
(i) a *personal injury annuity, payments of which are exempt from income
tax under Division 54;
(ii) a
*personal injury lump sum, payment of which is exempt from income tax
under Division 54.
Note: A part of a life insurance
policy may be taken to be an exempt life insurance policy under section 320‑247.
(3) The
following table sets out the conditions mentioned in subparagraph (1)(e)(iii):
|
Annuity
conditions
|
|
Item
|
Column
1
The
condition in column 2 applies in the following circumstances ...
|
Column
2
The condition
is that ...
|
|
1
|
there is a residual capital value (within
the meaning of section 27H of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936)
in relation to the *immediate annuity.
|
the contract under which the annuity is
payable does not permit the residual capital value to exceed the annuity’s
purchase price (within the meaning of that section).
|
|
2
|
the contract under which the *immediate annuity is payable provides that the annuity is payable
until the end of a term of years certain.
|
the contract does not permit the total of
the amounts paid for the annuity’s commutation (whether in whole or in part)
to exceed the annuity’s purchase price (within the meaning of that section),
reduced by the sum of the deductible amounts excluded from assessable income
under that section.
|
|
3
|
the contract under which the *immediate annuity is payable:
(a) provides that the annuity is payable
until the later of:
(i) the death of a person (or the death of
the last of 2 or more persons to die); or
(ii) the end of a term of years certain; and
(b) permits
one or more amounts (commutation payments) to become payable
before the end of the term of years certain for the annuity’s commutation
(whether in whole or in part).
|
the contract does not permit the total of
the commutation payments that may become payable before the end of the term
of years certain to exceed the annuity’s purchase price (within the meaning
of that section), reduced by the sum of the deductible amounts excluded from
assessable income under that section.
|
|
4
|
all circumstances.
|
there is no unreasonable deferral of the
payments of the *immediate annuity, having regard to:
(a) to the extent to which the payments
depend on the returns of the investment of the assets of the *life insurance company paying the annuity—when the payments are
made and when those returns are *derived; and
(b) to the extent to which the payments do
not depend on those returns—the relative sizes of the annual totals of the
payments from year to year; and
(c) any other relevant factors.
|
320‑247 Policy split into an exempt
life insurance policy and another life insurance policy
When is a part of a policy taken to be
an exempt life insurance policy?
(1) A part of a *life insurance policy (the original policy) is taken
to be an *exempt life insurance policy for the
purposes of this Act if:
(a) the part provides
solely for the discharge of the liabilities (contingent or not) in respect of *superannuation income stream benefits that are currently payable by
a *complying superannuation fund; and
(b) the trustee of
the fund holds the original policy.
(2) A part of a *life insurance policy (the original policy) is taken
to be an *exempt life insurance policy for the
purposes of this Act if:
(a) the part provides
solely for the discharge of liabilities that are attributable to the
liabilities (contingent or not) in respect of *superannuation
income stream benefits that are currently payable by *complying
superannuation funds; and
(b) the trustee of a *pooled superannuation trust holds the original policy; and
(c) the funds are
unit holders of the trust.
What happens to the rest of the
policy?
(3) If a part of a policy
(the original policy) is taken to be an *exempt
life insurance policy under subsection (1) or (2), the rest of the
original policy is taken to be another *life
insurance policy for the purposes of this Act.
320‑250 Transfer of assets and
payment of amounts from segregated exempt assets otherwise than as a result of
a valuation under section 320‑230
(1) A *life insurance company can at any time transfer an asset from its*segregated exempt assets in exchange for an amount of money equal to
the *transfer value of the asset at the time of
the transfer.
(2) If
a *life insurance company:
(a) imposes
any fees or charges in respect of *segregated exempt
assets; or
(b) imposes any fees
or charges in respect of *exempt life insurance
policies where the liabilities under the policies are to be discharged out of
the company’s segregated exempt assets; or
(c) determines, at a
time other than a *valuation time, that the total *transfer value of the company’s segregated exempt assets as at that
time exceeds the amount of the company’s *exempt
life insurance policy liabilities as at that time;
the company must, when the fees or
charges are imposed or the excess is determined, as the case may be, transfer
from the segregated exempt assets, assets having a total transfer value equal
to the fees, charges or excess, as the case may be.
(3) If:
(a) any liabilities
arise for the discharge of which a *life insurance
company has *segregated exempt assets; or
(b) any expenses are
incurred by a life insurance company directly in respect of segregated exempt
assets in relation to a period during which the assets are segregated exempt
assets;
the life insurance company must pay from
the segregated exempt assets any amounts required to discharge the liabilities
or amounts equal to the expenses, as the case may be.
320‑255 Consequences of transfer of
assets to or from segregated exempt assets
(1) This
section applies if:
(a) an
asset (other than money) is transferred from the company’s *segregated exempt assets under subsection 320‑235(1) or 320‑250(1)
or (2); or
(b) an asset (other
than money) is transferred to the company’s *segregated
exempt assets under subsection 320‑235(3) or section 320‑240.
(2) In
determining:
(a) for
the purposes of this Act (other than Division 40 and Parts 3‑1 and 3‑3)
whether an amount is included in, or can be deducted from, the assessable
income of a *life insurance company in respect of the
transfer of the asset; or
(b) for the purposes
of Parts 3‑1 and 3‑3:
(i) whether
the company made a *capital gain in respect of the
transfer; or
(ii) whether
the company made a *capital loss in respect of the
transfer;
the company is taken:
(c) to have sold,
immediately before the transfer, the asset transferred for a consideration
equal to its *market value; and
(d) to have purchased
the asset again at the time of the transfer for a consideration equal to its
market value.
(3) If, apart from this
subsection, section 320‑60 and subsection 320‑105(1), a *life insurance company could deduct an amount or apply a *capital loss as a result of the transfer of an asset to its *segregated exempt assets, the deduction or capital loss is
disregarded until:
(a) the asset ceases
to exist; or
(b) the asset, or a
greater than 50% interest in it, is *acquired by an
entity other than an entity that is an *associate
of the company, immediately after the acquisition.
(3A) Subsection (3) does
not apply in relation to an amount that the company can deduct under a
provision in Division 40.
(4) A *life insurance company cannot deduct an amount or apply a *capital loss as a result of the transfer of an asset from its *segregated exempt assets.
(6) If a *depreciating asset is transferred to the *segregated
exempt assets of a *life insurance company, then, in
determining for the purposes of Division 40 whether an amount is included
in, or can be deducted from, the company’s assessable income as a result of the
transfer, the company is taken:
(a) to have, at the
time immediately before the transfer, sold the asset for a consideration equal
to its *market value at that time; and
(b) to have, at the
time of the transfer, purchased the asset again for a consideration equal to
its market value at that time.
(7) If a *depreciating asset that has been included in the *segregated exempt assets of a *life
insurance company since the asset was acquired by the company or the initial
segregation of those assets took place is transferred from those assets, then
the company must assume for the purposes of Division 40 that:
(a) if the asset’s *market value at the time of the transfer is greater than its *adjustable value at that time, the company:
(i) had,
at the time immediately before the transfer, sold the asset for a consideration
equal to its adjustable value at that time; and
(ii) had,
at the time of the transfer, purchased the asset again for a consideration
equal to its adjustable value at that time; or
(b) if the asset’s
market value at the time of the transfer is equal to or less than its
adjustable value at that time, the company:
(i) had,
at the time immediately before the transfer, sold the asset for a consideration
equal to its market value at that time; and
(ii) had,
at the time of the transfer, purchased the asset again for a consideration
equal to its market value at that time.
(8) If a *depreciating asset that was previously transferred to the *segregated exempt assets of a *life
insurance company is transferred from those assets, then, the company must
assume, for the purposes of Division 40 that:
(a) if the asset’s *market value at the time of its transfer from those assets is
greater than its market value at the time when it was transferred to those
assets, the company:
(i) had,
at the time immediately before the transfer from those assets, sold the asset
for a consideration equal to its market value at the time when it was
transferred to those assets; and
(ii) had,
at the time of the transfer from those assets, purchased the asset again for a
consideration equal to its market value at the time when it was transferred to
those assets; or
(b) if the asset’s
market value at the time of its transfer from those assets is equal to or less
than its market value at the time when it was transferred to those assets, the
company:
(i) had,
at the time immediately before the transfer from those assets, sold the asset
for a consideration equal to its market value at that time; and
(ii) had,
at the time of the transfer from those assets, purchased the asset again for a
consideration equal to its market value at that time.
(9) Division 40
has effect in relation to an asset covered by subsection (6), (7) or (8)
as if:
(a) in relation to
the sale of the asset that is taken to have occurred under that subsection:
(i) the
sale were a *balancing adjustment event; and
(ii) the *termination value of the asset for that event were equal to the
consideration for the sale under that subsection; and
(iii) the
company had stopped *holding the asset at the time of
the sale; and
(b) in relation to
the purchase of the asset that is taken to have occurred under that subsection:
(i) the
company had only begun to hold the asset after the purchase; and
(ii) the
first element of the asset’s *cost were equal to the
consideration for the purchase under that subsection; and
(iii) the
company had acquired the asset from an *associate
of the company.
Note: This means that, amongst
other things, as a result of the transfer:
·
the asset’s cost for the purposes of working
out a deduction under Division 40 is reset; and
·
the company’s assessable income might be
adjusted under section 40‑285 if the transfer is a transfer to the
company’s segregated exempt assets.
Subdivision 320‑I—Transfers of business
Guide to Subdivision 320‑I
320‑300 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision
contains special rules that apply when all or part of the life insurance
business of a life insurance company is transferred to another life insurance
company under the Life Insurance Act 1995 or the Financial Sector
(Business Transfer and Group Restructure) Act 1999.
Table of sections
Operative provisions
320‑305 When this Subdivision
applies
320‑310 Special deductions and
amounts of assessable income
320‑315 Complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool and segregated exempt assets
320‑320 Certain amounts treated as
life insurance premiums
320‑325 Friendly societies
320‑330 Immediate annuities
320‑335 Parts of assets treated as
separate assets
320‑340 Continuous disability
policies
320‑345 Exemption of management
fees
Operative provisions
320‑305 When this Subdivision
applies
The rules in this
Subdivision have effect if all or part of the *life
insurance business of a *life insurance company
(the originating company) is transferred to another life
insurance company (the recipient company):
(a) in accordance
with a scheme confirmed by the Federal Court of Australia under Part 9 of
the Life Insurance Act 1995; or
(b) under the Financial
Sector (Business Transfer and Group Restructure) Act 1999.
320‑310 Special deductions and
amounts of assessable income
Deduction for originating company
(1) If the originating
company pays an amount to the recipient company in respect of liabilities under
the *net risk components of *life insurance policies transferred to the recipient company, the
originating company can deduct that amount for the income year in which the
transfer took place.
Amount included in originating
company’s assessable income
(2) If the originating
company receives an amount from the recipient company in respect of liabilities
under the *net risk components of *life insurance policies transferred to the recipient company, that
amount is included in the assessable income of the originating company for the
income year in which the transfer took place.
Deduction for recipient company
(3) If the recipient company
pays an amount to the originating company in respect of liabilities under the *net risk components of *life insurance
policies transferred to the recipient company, the recipient company can deduct
that amount for the income year in which the transfer took place.
320‑315 Complying
superannuation/FHSA asset pool and segregated exempt assets
(1) Assets that were *complying superannuation/FHSA assets of the originating company just
before the transfer took place and that are transferred to the recipient
company become complying superannuation/FHSA assets of the recipient company.
(2) Assets that were *segregated exempt assets of the originating company just before the
transfer took place and that are transferred to the recipient company become
segregated exempt assets of the recipient company.
320‑320 Certain amounts treated as
life insurance premiums
(1) This Division applies to
the recipient company as if the amount or value of any consideration received
by the recipient company in respect of liabilities under *life insurance policies transferred to the company were *life insurance premiums paid to the company at the time the transfer
took place.
(2) However, subsection (1)
does not apply to consideration:
(a) that relates to liabilities
that, just before the transfer took place, were discharged out of the
originating company’s *complying
superannuation/FHSA assets or *segregated exempt
assets; or
(b) that relates to
the part of a *life insurance policy that has been
reinsured under a *contract of reinsurance (except
consideration that relates to a risk, or part of a risk, in relation to which
subsection 148(1) of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 applies).
320‑325 Friendly societies
(1) This section has effect
if the originating company and the recipient company were *friendly societies just before the transfer took place.
(2) For the purposes of
paragraph 320‑37(1)(d), an *income bond, *funeral policy, *sickness policy or *scholarship plan issued by the recipient company in substitution for
an income bond, funeral policy, sickness policy or scholarship plan (the original
policy) transferred from the originating company is taken to have been
issued at the time the original policy was issued if the terms of the
substituted policy are not materially different from those of the original
policy.
320‑330 Immediate annuities
For the purposes of
section 320‑246, a *life insurance policy
that provides for an *immediate annuity issued by the
recipient company in substitution for a policy (also the original policy)
transferred from the originating company is taken to have been issued at the
time the original policy was issued if the terms of the substituted policy are
not materially different from those of the original policy.
320‑335 Parts of assets treated as
separate assets
If:
(a) an asset is
transferred to the recipient company from the originating company; and
(b) parts of that
asset were, under section 320‑170 or 320‑225 of the Income Tax
(Transitional Provisions) Act 1997, treated as separate assets of the
originating company just before the transfer took place;
those parts of that asset are also
treated as separate assets of the recipient company.
320‑340 Continuous disability
policies
(1) This section has effect
if:
(a) the originating
company and the recipient company were members of the same *wholly‑owned group just before the transfer took place; and
(b) all of the
liabilities under the *continuous disability
policies of the originating company are transferred to the recipient company;
and
(c) the transfer took
place before the income year in which 1 July 2005 occurs; and
(d) an amount (the section 320‑30
amount) would have been included in the assessable income of the
originating company under section 320‑30 for the income year in which the
transfer took place if the transfer had not taken place.
(2) Section 320‑30 does
not apply to the originating company for the income year in which the transfer
took place or a later income year.
(3) The amount worked out
using this formula is included in the assessable income of the originating
company for the income year in which the transfer took place:

where:
continuous disability policy days means the number of days during the income year in which the
transfer took place that the originating company held *continuous
disability policies.
(4) The section 320‑30
amount, reduced by the amount included in the assessable income of the
originating company under subsection (3), is included in the assessable
income of the recipient company for the income year in which the transfer took
place.
(5) For each income year
after the year in which the transfer took place and that is a relevant income
year for the purposes of section 320‑30, the recipient company’s
assessable income includes the amount that would have been included in the
originating company’s assessable income under that section for that year if the
transfer had not taken place.
320‑345 Exemption of management fees
(1) This
section has effect if:
(a) the
originating company and the recipient company were members of the same *wholly‑owned group just before the transfer took place; and
(b) a
*life insurance policy (also the original policy):
(i) is
constituted by a contract made with the originating company before 1 July
2000; and
(ii) is
transferred to the recipient company before 1 July 2005.
(2) For the purposes of
section 320‑40, a *life insurance policy
issued by the recipient company in substitution for the original policy is
taken to have been constituted by a contract made with the recipient company
before 1 July 2000 if the terms of the substituted policy are not
materially different from those of the original policy.
(3) Subsection 320‑40(4)
applies to so much of the sum of the amounts applicable in respect of the
substituted policy under subsections 320‑40(5), (6) and (7) as does not
exceed any fees or charges made by the recipient company that the originating
company would have been entitled to make under the terms of the original policy
as applying just before 1 July 2000.
Division 321—General insurance companies and companies
that self‑insure in respect of workers’ compensation liabilities
Table of Subdivisions
321‑A Provision for, and payment of,
claims by general insurance companies
321‑B Premium income of general
insurance companies
321‑C Companies that self‑insure in
respect of workers’ compensation liabilities
Subdivision 321‑A—Provision for, and payment of, claims by general insurance
companies
Table of sections
321‑10 Assessable income to include
amount for reduction in outstanding claims liability
321‑15 Deduction for increase in
outstanding claims liability
321‑20 How value of outstanding
claims liability is worked out
321‑25 Deduction for claims paid
during current year
321‑10 Assessable income to include
amount for reduction in outstanding claims liability
A *general insurance company’s assessable income for the *current year includes an amount equal to the amount (if any) by
which:
(a) the value, at the
end of the previous income year, of the company’s liability for *outstanding claims under *general insurance
policies; exceeds
(b) the value, at the
end of the current year, of that liability.
Note: Those values are worked out
under section 321‑20.
321‑15 Deduction for increase in
outstanding claims liability
A *general insurance company can deduct for the *current year an amount equal to the amount (if any) by which:
(a) the value, at the
end of the current year, of the company’s liability for *outstanding claims under *general insurance
policies; exceeds
(b) the value, at the
end of the previous income year, of that liability.
Note: Those values are worked out
under section 321‑20.
321‑20 How value of outstanding
claims liability is worked out
Work out the value, at
the end of an income year, of a *general insurance
company’s liability for *outstanding claims under
*general insurance policies in this way:
Method statement
Step 1. Add up
the amounts that, at the end of the income year, the company determines, based
on proper and reasonable estimates, to be appropriate to set aside and invest
in order to meet:
(a) liabilities
for outstanding claims under those policies; and
(b) direct
settlement costs associated with those outstanding claims.
Step 2. Reduce
the step 1 amount by so much of it as the company expects at the end of the
income year to recover:
(a) under
a contract of reinsurance; or
(b) in
any other way;
other
than under a contract of reinsurance to which subsection 148(1) of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936 (about reinsurance with non‑residents) applies.
321‑25 Deduction for claims paid
during current year
A *general insurance company can deduct for the *current year amounts paid during that year in respect of claims under
*general insurance policies.
Subdivision 321‑B—Premium income of general insurance companies
Table of sections
321‑45 Assessable income to
include gross premiums
321‑50 Assessable income to
include amount for reduction in value of unearned premium reserve
321‑55 Deduction for increase in
value of unearned premium reserve
321‑60 How value of unearned
premium reserve is worked out
321‑45 Assessable income to include
gross premiums
A
*general insurance company’s assessable income for the *current year includes the gross premiums received or receivable by
the company during the current year in respect of *general
insurance policies.
321‑50 Assessable income to include
amount for reduction in value of unearned premium reserve
A *general insurance company’s assessable income for the *current year includes an amount equal to the amount (if any) by
which:
(a) the value, at the
end of the previous income year, of the company’s unearned premium reserve;
exceeds
(b) the value, at the
end of the current year, of that reserve.
Note: Those values are worked out
under section 321‑60.
321‑55 Deduction for increase in
value of unearned premium reserve
A *general insurance company can deduct for the *current year an amount equal to the amount (if any) by which:
(a) the value, at the
end of the current year, of the company’s unearned premium reserve; exceeds
(b) the value, at the
end of the previous income year, of that reserve.
Note: Those values are worked out
under section 321‑60.
321‑60 How value of unearned premium
reserve is worked out
Work out the value, at
the end of an income year, of a *general insurance
company’s unearned premium reserve in this way:
Method statement
Step 1. Add up
the gross premiums received or receivable by the company, in relation to *general insurance policies issued in the course of carrying on *insurance business, in that or an earlier income year.
Step 2. Reduce
the step 1 amount by so much of the costs incurred by the company in connection
with the issue of those policies as relate to the gross premiums, including,
for example, costs such as:
(a) commission
and brokerage fees; and
(b) administration
costs of processing insurance proposals and renewals; and
(c) administration
costs of collecting premiums; and
(d) selling
and underwriting costs; and
(e) fire brigade charges; and
(f) stamp duty; and
(g) other
charges, levies and contributions imposed by governments or governmental
authorities that directly relate to general insurance policies.
Step 3. Reduce
the step 2 amount by any premiums (the relevant reinsurance premiums)
paid or payable by the company, in that or an earlier income year, for the
reinsurance of risks covered by those policies, except:
(a) reinsurance
premiums that the company cannot deduct because of subsection 148(1) of
the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 (about reinsurance with non‑residents);
and
(b) reinsurance
premiums that were paid or payable in respect of a particular class of *insurance business where, under the contract of reinsurance, the
reinsurer agreed to pay, in respect of a loss incurred by the company that is
covered by the relevant policy, some or all of the excess over an agreed
amount.
Step 4. Add to
the step 3 amount any reinsurance commissions received or receivable by the
company that relate to the relevant reinsurance premiums.
Step 5. The
value, at the end of an income year, of the unearned premium reserve is so much
of the step 4 amount as the company determines, based on proper and reasonable
estimates, to relate to risks covered by the policies in respect of later
income years.
Subdivision 321‑C—Companies that self‑insure in respect of workers’
compensation liabilities
Table of sections
321‑80 Assessable income to
include amount for reduction in outstanding claims liability
321‑85 Deduction for outstanding
claims liability
321‑90 How value of outstanding
claims liability is worked out
321‑95 Deductions for claims
paid during current year
321‑80 Assessable income to include
amount for reduction in outstanding claims liability
The assessable income
for the *current year of a company that is not
required by law to insure, and does not insure, against liability for workers’
compensation claims includes an amount equal to the amount (if any) by which:
(a) the value, at the
end of the previous income year, of the company’s liability for such claims
that:
(i) arose
from events that occurred in that or an earlier income year; and
(ii) were
not paid in full before the end of the previous income year; exceeds
(b) the value, at the
end of the current year, of that liability.
Note: Those values are worked out
under section 321‑90.
321‑85 Deduction for outstanding
claims liability
A company that is not
required by law to insure, and does not insure, against liability for workers’
compensation claims can deduct for the *current
year an amount equal to the amount (if any) by which:
(a) the value, at the
end of the current year, of the company’s liability for such claims that:
(i) arose
from events that occurred in the current or an earlier income year; and
(ii) were
not paid in full before the end of the current year; exceeds
(b) the value, at the
end of the previous income year, of that liability.
Note: Those values are worked out
under section 321‑90.
321‑90 How value of outstanding claims
liability is worked out
Work out the value, at
the end of an income year, of a company’s liability for claims covered by
section 321‑80 or 321‑85 by adding up the amounts that, at the end of that
income year, the company determines, based on proper and reasonable estimates,
to be appropriate to set aside and invest in order to meet:
(a) liabilities for
those claims; and
(b) direct settlement
costs associated with those claims.
321‑95 Deductions for claims paid
during current year
A company that is not
required by law to insure, and does not insure, against liability for workers’
compensation claims can deduct for the *current
year amounts paid during that year in respect of such claims.
Division 322—Assistance for policyholders with insolvent
general insurers
Guide to Division 322
322‑1 What this Division is about
This Division sets
out special measures to assist in the rescue package provided in response to
the collapse of the HIH group and deals with the tax treatment of entitlements
under Part VC (Financial claims scheme for policyholders with insolvent
general insurers) of the Insurance Act 1973.
Table of sections
322‑5 Rescue payments treated
as insurance payments by HIH
322‑10 HIH Trust exempt from tax
322‑15 Certain capital gains and
capital losses disregarded
Subdivision 322‑A—HIH rescue package
322‑5 Rescue payments treated as
insurance payments by HIH
(1) This Act applies to you
as if a payment you receive from the Commonwealth, the *HIH
Trust or a prescribed entity for assignment of your rights under or in relation
to a *general insurance policy you held with an *HIH company:
(a) had been made by
the HIH company; and
(b) had been made
under the terms and conditions of the general insurance policy you held with
the HIH company.
(2) The HIH Trust
is the HIH Claims Support Trust (established on 6 July 2001).
(3) An HIH company
is:
(a) CIC Insurance
Limited; or
(b) FAI General
Insurance Company Limited; or
(c) FAI Reinsurances
Pty Limited; or
(d) FAI Traders
Insurance Company Pty Limited; or
(e) HIH Casualty and
General Insurance Limited; or
(f) HIH Underwriting
and Insurance (Australia) Pty Limited; or
(g) World Marine and
General Insurances Pty Limited; or
(h) another related
company specified in writing by the Commissioner.
322‑10 HIH Trust exempt from tax
The total *ordinary income and *statutory income of:
(a) the HIH Trust;
and
(b) an entity
prescribed for the purposes of this Division;
is exempt from income tax.
322‑15 Certain capital gains and
capital losses disregarded
A *capital gain or *capital loss you make
because you assign a right under or in relation to a *general
insurance policy you held with an *HIH company to the
Commonwealth, the trustee of the *HIH Trust or a
prescribed entity is disregarded.
Subdivision 322‑B—Tax treatment of entitlements under financial claims scheme
Guide to Subdivision 322‑B
322‑20 What this Subdivision is
about
This Act applies to a
payment of an entitlement under Part VC (Financial claims scheme for
policyholders with insolvent general insurers) of the Insurance Act 1973
as if the payment were made by the insurer under the insurance policy
concerned.
Disregard a capital gain or loss from:
(a) the disposal to APRA under that Part of
rights against the insurer under an insurance policy; or
(b) the
payment of an entitlement under that Part.
Table of sections
Operative provisions
322‑25 Payment of entitlement
under financial claims scheme treated as payment from insurer
322‑30 Disposal of rights
against insurer to APRA and meeting of financial claims scheme entitlement have
no CGT effects
Operative provisions
322‑25 Payment of entitlement under
financial claims scheme treated as payment from insurer
(1) This Act applies to you
as if an amount paid to you, or applied for your benefit, to meet your
entitlement under Part VC (Financial claims scheme for policyholders with
insolvent general insurers) of the Insurance Act 1973 relating to a *general insurance policy issued by a *general
insurance company had been paid to you by the company under the terms and
conditions of the policy.
(2) To avoid doubt, subsection (1)
does not affect the operation of Part 2‑5 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation
Administration Act 1953.
Note: Division 21 in Schedule 1
to the Taxation Administration Act 1953 contains special provisions
about how Part 2‑5 in that Schedule operates in relation to the meeting of
entitlements under Part VC of the Insurance Act 1973.
322‑30 Disposal of rights against
insurer to APRA and meeting of financial claims scheme entitlement have no CGT
effects
Disregard
a *capital gain or *capital loss you make
because:
(a) under section 62ZZL
of the Insurance Act 1973, you *dispose of a *CGT asset consisting of your rights against a *general insurance company to *APRA;
or
(b) your entitlement
under Division 3 of Part VC of that Act is met.
Note 1: Section 62ZZL of the Insurance
Act 1973 causes you to cease to be the owner, and APRA to become the owner,
of rights against a general insurance company relating to a general insurance
policy when your entitlement arises under Part VC of that Act in relation
to the policy.
Note 2: Division 3 of
Part VC of the Insurance Act 1973 entitles persons with valid
claims based on general insurance policies issued by certain general insurance
companies that have since become insolvent to be paid the amount of those
claims by APRA.
Part 3‑45—Rules for particular industries and occupations
Division 328—Small business entities
Table of Subdivisions
328‑B Objects of this Division
328‑C What is a small business
entity
328‑D Capital allowances for small
business entities
328‑E Trading stock for small
business entities
Guide to Division 328
328‑5 What this Division is about
This Division
explains the meaning of the terms small business entity, annual
turnover, aggregated turnover and related concepts
(Subdivision 328‑C).
If you are a small
business entity, this Division allows you to change the way the income tax law applies
to you in these ways:
(a) you
can choose to put your depreciating assets into a general pool and treat the
pool as a single asset (Subdivision 328‑D);
(b) you
can choose not to account for annual changes in trading stock value that are
not more than $5,000 (Subdivision 328‑E).
In usual
circumstances, these changes will simplify the working out of your taxable
income, and so reduce your compliance costs.
Table
of sections
328‑10 Concessions available to
small business entities
328‑10 Concessions available to
small business entities
(1) If you are a small
business entity for an income year, you can choose to take advantage of the
concessions set out in the following table. Some of the concessions have
additional, specific conditions that must also be satisfied.
|
Item
|
Concession
|
Provision
|
|
1
|
CGT 15‑year asset exemption
|
Subdivision 152‑B of this Act
|
|
2
|
CGT 50% active asset reduction
|
Subdivision 152‑C of this Act
|
|
3
|
CGT retirement exemption
|
Subdivision 152‑D of this Act
|
|
4
|
CGT roll‑over
|
Subdivision 152‑E of this Act
|
|
5
|
Simpler depreciation rules
|
Subdivision 328‑D of this Act
|
|
6
|
Simplified trading stock rules
|
Subdivision 328‑E of this Act
|
|
7
|
Deducting certain prepaid business
expenses immediately
|
Sections 82KZM and 82KZMD of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936
|
|
8
|
Accounting for GST on a cash basis
|
Section 29‑40 of the GST Act
|
|
9
|
Annual apportionment of input tax credits
for acquisitions and importations that are partly creditable
|
Section 131‑5 of the GST Act
|
|
10
|
Paying GST by quarterly instalments
|
Section 162‑5 of the GST Act
|
|
11
|
FBT car
parking exemption
|
Section 58GA
of the Fringe Benefits Tax Assessment Act 1986
|
|
12
|
PAYG instalments based on GDP‑adjusted
notional tax
|
Section 45‑130 in Schedule 1 to
the Taxation Administration Act 1953
|
(2) Also, if you are a small
business entity for an income year, the standard 2‑year period for amending
your assessment applies to you (section 170 of the Income Tax
Assessment Act 1936).
Subdivision 328‑B—Objects of this Division
328‑50 Objects of this Division
(1) The main object of this
Division is to offer eligible small businesses the choice of a new platform to
deal with their tax. The platform is designed to benefit those businesses in
one or more of these ways:
• reducing their tax;
• providing simpler rules for
determining their income and deductions;
• providing simpler capital allowances
and trading stock requirements;
• reducing their compliance costs.
(2) This Division also
provides rules that are intended to prevent other businesses from taking
advantage of those benefits.
Subdivision 328‑C—What is a small business entity
Guide to Subdivision 328‑C
328‑105 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision
explains the meaning of the terms small business entity, annual
turnover, aggregated turnover and related concepts.
Table
of sections
Operative provisions
328‑110 Meaning of small business entity
328‑115 Meaning of aggregated turnover
328‑120 Meaning of annual turnover
328‑125 Meaning of connected with an entity
328‑130 Meaning of affiliate
Operative provisions
328‑110 Meaning of small business
entity
General rule: based on aggregated
turnover worked out as at the beginning of the current income year
(1) You are a small
business entity for an income year (the current year) if:
(a) you carry on a *business in the current year; and
(b) one or both of
the following applies:
(i) you
carried on a business in the income year (the previous year)
before the current year and your *aggregated turnover for
the previous year was less than $2 million;
(ii) your
aggregated turnover for the current year is likely to be less than $2 million.
Note 1: If you are a small business
entity for an income year, you may apply to the Commissioner under section 61C
of the Excise Act 1901 for permission to deliver goods for home
consumption (without entering them for that purpose) in respect of a calendar
month.
Note 2: If you are a small business
entity for an income year, you may apply under section 69 of the Customs
Act 1901 for permission to deliver like customable goods or excise‑equivalent
goods into home consumption (without entering them for that purpose) in respect
of a calendar month.
(2) You work out your *aggregated turnover for the current year for the purposes of subparagraph (1)(b)(ii):
(a) as at the first
day of the current year; or
(b) if you start to
carry on a *business during the current year—as at the
day you start to carry on the business.
Note: Subsection 328‑120(5)
provides for how to work out your annual turnover (which is relevant to working
out your aggregated turnover) if you do not carry on a business for the whole
of an income year.
Exception: aggregated turnover for 2
previous income years was $2 million or more
(3) However, you are not a small
business entity for an income year (the current year)
because of subparagraph (1)(b)(ii) if:
(a) you carried on a *business in each of the 2 income years before the current year; and
(b) your *aggregated turnover for each of those income years was $2 million or
more.
Note: Section 328‑110 of the Income
Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997 affects the operation of this
subsection in relation to the 2007‑08 and 2008‑09 income years.
Additional rule: based on aggregated
turnover worked out as at the end of the current income year
(4) You are also a small
business entity for an income year (the current year) if:
(a) you carry on a *business in the current year; and
(b) your *aggregated turnover for the current year, worked out as at the end
of that year, is less than $2 million.
Note: If you are a small business
entity only because of subsection (4), you cannot choose any of the
following concessions:
(a) paying PAYG instalments based on GDP‑adjusted
notional tax: see section 45‑130 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation
Administration Act 1953;
(b) accounting for GST on a cash basis:
see section 29‑40 of the GST Act;
(c) making an annual apportionment of
input tax credits for acquisitions and importations that are partly creditable:
see section 131‑5 of the GST Act;
(d) paying GST by quarterly instalments:
see section 162‑5 of the GST Act;
(e) applying for permission under the Excise
Act 1901 to deliver goods for home consumption (without entering them for
that purpose) in respect of a calendar month: see section 61C of that Act;
(f) applying for permission under the Customs
Act 1901 to deliver like customable goods or excise‑equivalent goods for
home consumption (without entering them for that purpose) in respect of a
calendar month: see section 69 of that Act.
Winding up a business previously carried
on
(5) This Subdivision applies
to you as if you carried on a *business in an income
year if:
(a) in that year you
were winding up a business you previously carried on; and
(b) you were a *small business entity for the income year in which you stopped
carrying on that business.
Note 1: Subsection 328‑120(5)
provides for how to work out your annual turnover (which is relevant to working
out your aggregated turnover) if you do not carry on a business for the whole
of an income year.
Note 2: A special rule applies if you
were an STS taxpayer under this Division (as in force immediately before the
commencement of this section) in the income year in which you stopped carrying
on the business: see section 328‑111 of the Income Tax (Transitional
Provisions) Act 1997.
Partners in a partnership
(6) A person who is a
partner in a partnership in an income year is not, in his or her capacity as a
partner, a small business entity for the income year.
328‑115 Meaning of aggregated
turnover
(1) Your aggregated turnover
for an income year is the sum of the relevant annual turnovers (see subsection (2))
excluding any amounts covered by subsection (3).
Note: For small business CGT relief
purposes, additional entities may be treated as being connected with you or your
affiliate under sections 152‑48 and 152‑78.
(2) The relevant
annual turnovers are:
(a) your *annual turnover for the income year; and
(b) the annual
turnover for the income year of any entity (a relevant entity)
that is *connected with you at any time during the
income year; and
(c) the annual
turnover for the income year of any entity (a relevant entity)
that is an *affiliate of yours at any time during the
income year.
(3) Your aggregated
turnover for an income year does not include the following amounts:
(a) amounts *derived in the income year by you or a relevant entity from dealings
between you and the relevant entity while the relevant entity is *connected with you or is your *affiliate;
(b) amounts derived
in the income year by a relevant entity from dealings between the relevant
entity and another relevant entity while each relevant entity is connected with
you or is your affiliate;
(c) amounts derived
in the income year by a relevant entity while the relevant entity is not
connected with you and is not your affiliate.
328‑120 Meaning of annual
turnover
General rule
(1) An entity’s annual
turnover for an income year is the total *ordinary
income that the entity *derives in the income
year in the ordinary course of carrying on a *business.
Exclusion of amounts relating to GST
(2) In working out an
entity’s *annual turnover for an income year, do not
include any amount that is *non‑assessable non‑exempt
income under section 17‑5 (which is about GST).
Exclusion of amounts derived from
sales of retail fuel
(3) In working out an
entity’s *annual turnover for an income year, do not
include any amounts of *ordinary income the
entity *derives from sales of *retail fuel.
Amounts derived from dealings with
associates
(4) In working out an
entity’s *annual turnover for an income year, the
amount of *ordinary income the entity *derives from any dealing with an *associate
of the entity is the amount of ordinary income the entity would derive from the
dealing if it were at *arm’s length.
Note: Amounts derived in an income
year from any dealings between an entity and an associate that is a relevant
entity within the meaning of section 328‑115 are not included in the
entity’s aggregated turnover for that year: see subsection 328‑115(3).
Business carried on for part of income
year only
(5) If an entity does not
carry on a *business for the whole of an income year,
the entity’s *annual turnover for the income year must
be worked out using a reasonable estimate of what the entity’s annual turnover
for the income year would be if the entity carried on a business for the whole
of the income year.
Regulations may provide for different
calculation of annual turnover
(6) The regulations may
provide that an entity’s *annual turnover for an
income year is to be calculated in a different way, but only so that it would
be less than the amount worked out under this section.
328‑125 Meaning of connected with
an entity
(1) An
entity is connected with another entity if:
(a) either
entity controls the other entity in a way described in this section; or
(b) both entities are
controlled in a way described in this section by the same third entity.
Note 1: See Subdivision 106‑B if
a CGT asset of yours is vested in a trustee in bankruptcy or a liquidator.
Note 2: See Subdivision 106‑C if
you are absolutely entitled to a CGT asset as against the trustee of a trust.
Note 3: See Subdivision 106‑D if
you provided security over an asset to another entity.
Direct control of an entity other than
a discretionary trust
(2) An entity (the first
entity) controls another entity if the first entity, its *affiliates, or the first entity together with its affiliates:
(a) except if the
other entity is a discretionary trust—own, or have the right to acquire the
ownership of, interests in the other entity that carry between them the right
to receive a percentage (the control percentage) that is at least
40% of:
(i) any
distribution of income by the other entity; or
(ii) if
the other entity is a partnership—the net income of the partnership; or
(iii) any
distribution of capital by the other entity; or
(b) if the other
entity is a company—own, or have the right to acquire the ownership of, *equity interests in the company that carry between them the right to
exercise, or control the exercise of, a percentage (the control
percentage) that is at least 40% of the voting power in the company.
Direct control of a discretionary trust
(3) An entity (the first
entity) controls a discretionary trust if a trustee of the trust acts,
or could reasonably be expected to act, in accordance with the directions or
wishes of the first entity, its *affiliates, or the first
entity together with its affiliates.
(4) An entity (the first
entity) controls a discretionary trust for an income year if, for any
of the 4 income years before that year:
(a) the trustee of
the trust paid to, or applied for the benefit of:
(i) the
first entity; or
(ii) any
of the first entity’s *affiliates; or
(iii) the
first entity and any of its affiliates;
any of the
income or capital of the trust; and
(b) the percentage
(the control percentage) of the income or capital paid or applied
is at least 40% of the total amount of income or capital paid or applied by the
trustee for that year.
Note: Section 328‑112 of the Income
Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997 affects the operation of this
subsection in relation to the 2007‑08, 2008‑09, 2009‑10 and 2010‑11 income years.
(5) An entity does not
control a discretionary trust because of subsection (4) if the entity is:
(a) an *exempt entity; or
(b) a *deductible gift recipient.
Commissioner may determine that an
entity does not control another entity
(6) If the control
percentage referred to in subsection (2) or (4) is at least 40%, but less
than 50%, the Commissioner may determine that the first entity does not control
the other entity if the Commissioner thinks that the other entity is controlled
by an entity other than, or by entities that do not include, the first entity
or any of its *affiliates.
Indirect control of an entity
(7) This section applies to
an entity (the first entity) that directly controls another
entity (the second entity) as if the first entity also controlled
any other entity that is directly, or indirectly by any other application or
applications of this section, controlled by the second entity.
(8) However, subsection (7)
does not apply if the second entity is an entity of any of the following kinds:
(a) a company *shares in which (except shares that carry the right to a fixed rate
of *dividend) are listed for quotation in the official list of an *approved stock exchange;
(b) a *publicly traded unit trust;
(c) a *mutual insurance company;
(d) a *mutual affiliate company;
(e) a company (other
than one covered by paragraph (a)) all the shares in which are owned by
one or more of the following:
(i) a
company covered by paragraph (a);
(ii) a
publicly traded unit trust;
(iii) a
mutual insurance company;
(iv) a
mutual affiliate company.
328‑130 Meaning of affiliate
(1) An
individual or a company is an affiliate of yours if the
individual or company acts, or could reasonably be expected to act, in
accordance with your directions or wishes, or in concert with you, in relation
to the affairs of the *business of the
individual or company.
(2) However, an individual
or a company is not your affiliate merely because of the nature
of the business relationship you and the individual or company share.
Note: For small business relief
purposes, a spouse or a child under 18 years may also be an affiliate under
section 152‑47.
Example: A partner in a partnership would
not be an affiliate of another partner merely because the first partner acts,
or could reasonably be expected to act, in accordance with the directions or
wishes of the second partner, or in concert with the second partner, in
relation to the affairs of the partnership.
Directors of the same
company, or the company and a director of that company, would be in a similar
position.
Subdivision 328‑D—Capital allowances for small business entities
Guide to Subdivision 328‑D
328‑170 What this Subdivision is
about
If you are a small
business entity, you can choose to deduct amounts for most of your depreciating
assets on a diminishing value basis using a pool that is treated as a single
depreciating asset.
Broadly, the pool is
made up of the costs of the depreciating assets that are allocated to it or, in
some cases, a proportion of those costs.
The pool rate is 30%.
There is a deduction
for assets whose cost is less than $1,000 in the income year in which you start
to use the asset or have it installed ready for use.
This Subdivision sets
out how to calculate the pool deductions, and also sets out the consequences
of:
(a) disposal
of depreciating assets; and
(b) not
choosing to use this Subdivision for an income year after having chosen to do
so for an earlier income year; and
(c) changing
the business use of depreciating assets.
Table of sections
Operative provisions
328‑175 Calculations for
depreciating assets
328‑180 Assets costing less than $1,000
328‑185 Pooling
328‑190 Calculation
328‑195 Opening pool balance
328‑200 Closing pool balance
328‑205 Estimate of taxable use
328‑210 Low pool value
328‑215 Disposal etc. of
depreciating assets
328‑220 What happens if you are
not a small business entity or do not choose to use this Subdivision for an
income year
328‑225 Change in business use
328‑230 Estimate where deduction
denied
328‑235 Interaction with Divisions 85
and 86
Special rules about roll‑overs
328‑243 Roll‑over relief
328‑245 Consequences of roll‑over
328‑247 Pool deductions
328‑250 Deductions for assets
first used in BAE year
328‑253 Deductions for cost
addition amounts
328‑255 Closing pool balance etc.
below zero
328‑257 Taxable use
Operative provisions
328‑175 Calculations for
depreciating assets
(1) You can choose to
calculate your deductions and some amounts of assessable income under this
Subdivision instead of under Division 40 for an income year for all the *depreciating assets that you *hold
if:
(a) you are a *small business entity for the income year; and
(b) you started to
use the assets or have them *installed ready for use,
for a *taxable purpose during or before that income
year.
This subsection has effect subject to subsections (2)
to (10).
Note: If
you choose to use this Subdivision for an income year, you continue to use this
Subdivision for your general small business pool for a later income year even
if you are not a small business entity, or do not choose to use this
Subdivision, for the later year: see section 328‑220.
Exception: assets to which Division 40
does not apply
(2) This Subdivision does
not apply to a *depreciating asset to which Division 40
does not apply because of section 40‑45.
Exception: primary production
(3) If you are a *small business entity for the income year, for each *depreciating asset you use to carry on a *primary
production business and for which you could deduct amounts under Subdivision 40‑F
(about primary production depreciating assets) or Subdivision 40‑G (about
capital expenditure of primary producers and other landholders) apart from subsection (1),
you can choose:
(a) to deduct amounts
for it under Subdivision 40‑F or 40‑G; or
(b) to calculate your
deductions for it under this Subdivision.
Note: A choice made by a transferor
under this subsection for an asset applies also to the transferee if roll‑over
relief under subsection 40‑340(1) or (3) is chosen: see section 328‑245.
(4) You
must make the choice under subsection (3) for each *depreciating asset of the kind referred to in that subsection for
the later of:
(a) the first income
year for which you are, or last were, a *small
business entity; or
(b) the income year
in which you started to use the asset, or have it *installed
ready for use, for a *taxable purpose.
Once you have made the choice for an
asset, you cannot change it.
Exception: horticultural plants
(5) You cannot deduct
amounts for *horticultural plants (including
grapevines) under this Subdivision.
Exception: asset let on depreciating
asset lease
(6) You cannot deduct
amounts for a *depreciating asset under this Subdivision
if the asset is being or might reasonably be expected to be let predominantly
on a *depreciating asset lease.
Exception: assets in a low‑value or
software development pool
(7) You cannot deduct
amounts for a *depreciating asset under this Subdivision
if:
(a) the asset was
allocated to your low‑value pool under Subdivision 40‑E, or to your pool
under the former Subdivision 42‑L, during an income year for which you
were not a *small business entity or had not chosen to
use this Subdivision; or
(b) the asset is *in‑house software and expenditure on the asset is allocated to a
software development pool under that Subdivision.
Note: You will have to continue
deducting amounts for these assets under Division 40.
(8) A *depreciating asset referred to in subsection (7) is not
allocated to your *general small business pool under this
Subdivision and does not qualify for a deduction under section 328‑180.
Exception: assets for which previously
entitled to a tax offset under the R&D provisions
(9) You cannot deduct
amounts for a *depreciating asset for any period under
this Subdivision if you are entitled under section 355‑100 to a *tax offset for a deduction under section 355‑305 for the asset
for the same or an earlier period.
Exception: restriction on choosing to
use this Subdivision
(10) If:
(a) you choose to use
this Subdivision to deduct amounts for your *depreciating
assets for an income year; and
(b) you do not choose
to use this Subdivision for a later income year for which you satisfy the
conditions to make this choice (see subsection (1));
you cannot choose to use this Subdivision
until at least 5 years after the first later income year for which you
satisfied the conditions to make this choice but did not do so.
Note 1: Your ability to choose to use
this Subdivision may also be restricted by section 328‑440 of the Income
Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997.
Note 2: If you choose to use this
Subdivision for an income year, you continue to use it for assets that have
been allocated to your general small business pool for a later income year even
if you are not a small business entity, or do not choose to use this
Subdivision, for the later year: see section 328‑220.
328‑180 Assets costing less than
$1,000
(1) You deduct the *taxable purpose proportion of the *adjustable
value of a *depreciating asset for the income year in
which you start to use the asset, or have it *installed
ready for use, for a *taxable purpose if:
(a) you were a *small business entity for that year and the year in which you
started to *hold it; and
(ab) you chose to use
this Subdivision for each of those years; and
(b) the asset is a
depreciating asset whose *cost as at the end of
the income year in which you start to use it, or have it installed ready for
use, for a taxable purpose is less than $1,000.
(2) You can also deduct, for
an income year for which you are a *small business
entity and you choose to use this Subdivision, the *taxable
purpose proportion of an amount included in the second element of the *cost of an asset for which you have deducted an amount under subsection (1)
if:
(a) the amount so
included is less than $1,000; and
(b) you started to
use the asset, or have it *installed ready for use,
for a *taxable purpose during an earlier income
year.
(3) An asset for which you
have deducted an amount under this section is allocated to your *general small business pool if:
(a) an amount of $1,000
or more is included in the second element of the asset’s *cost; or
(b) any amount is
included in the second element of the asset’s cost and you have deducted or can
deduct an amount under subsection (2) for an amount previously included in
the second element of the asset’s cost.
(4) This Division applies to
the asset as if its *adjustable value were the amount
included in the second element of its *cost as mentioned
in subsection (3).
(5) Subsection (3)
applies even if the amount is included in the second element of the asset’s *cost during an income year for which you are not a *small business entity or do not choose to use this Subdivision.
328‑185 Pooling
(1) If you are a *small business entity for an income year and you have chosen to use
this Subdivision for that year, you deduct amounts for your *depreciating assets (except assets for which you have deducted or
can deduct an amount under section 328‑180) through a pool, which allows
you to deduct amounts for them as if they were a single asset, thereby
simplifying your calculations. You use one rate for the pool.
(2) There is a general
small business pool to which *depreciating
assets are allocated.
Allocating assets to a pool
(3) A *depreciating asset:
(a) that you *hold just before, and at the start of, the first income year for
which you are, or last were, a *small business entity;
and
(b) for which you
calculate your deductions under this Subdivision instead of under Division 40;
and
(c) that has not
previously been allocated to your *general small
business pool; and
(d) that you have
started to use, or have *installed ready for use,
for a *taxable purpose;
is automatically allocated to your
general small business pool.
(4) A *depreciating asset that you start to use, or have *installed ready for use, for a *taxable
purpose during an income year for which you are a *small
business entity and you choose to use this Subdivision is allocated to the *general small business pool at the end of that year.
Note: The allocation happens even
if you no longer hold the asset at the end of that income year.
Exception for assets used or installed
before 1 July 2001
(5) You can choose not to
have a *depreciating asset allocated to the *general small business pool if you started to use it, or have it *installed ready for use, for a *taxable
purpose before 1 July 2001.
Note: If you make this choice, you
would continue to deduct amounts for the asset under Division 40.
(6) You must make that
choice for the first income year for which you are a *small
business entity and you choose to use this Subdivision. Once you have made the
choice for an asset, you cannot change it.
No re‑allocation
(7) Once a *depreciating asset is allocated to your *general
small business pool, it is not re‑allocated, even if you are not a *small business entity for a later income year or you do not choose
to use this Subdivision for that later year.
Note: If you chose to use this
Subdivision for an income year, you continue to use it for your general small
business pool for a later income year even if you are not a small business
entity, or do not choose to use this Subdivision, for the later year: see
section 328‑220.
328‑190 Calculation
(1) You calculate your
deduction for your *general small business pool for
an income year using this formula:

Note: You use section 328‑210
instead if the pool has a low pool value.
(2) Your
deduction for each *depreciating asset that you start
to use, or have *installed ready for use, for a *taxable purpose during an income year for which you are a *small business entity and choose to use this Subdivision is 15% of
the *taxable purpose proportion of its *adjustable value.
(3) You can also deduct for
an income year for which you are a *small business
entity and choose to use this Subdivision the amount worked out under subsection (4)
for an amount (the cost addition amount) included in the second
element of the *cost of a *depreciating
asset for that year if you started to use the asset, or have it *installed ready for use, for a *taxable
purpose during an earlier income year.
Note: The second element of cost is
worked out under section 40‑190.
(4) The amount you can
deduct is 15% of the *taxable purpose proportion of the
cost addition amount.
Note: The amounts that a transferor
and transferee can deduct under this section are modified if roll‑over relief
under section 40‑340 is chosen: see sections 328‑243 and 328‑247.
328‑195 Opening pool balance
(1) For the first income
year for which you are a *small business entity
and choose to use this Subdivision, the opening pool balance of
your *general small business pool is the sum of
the *taxable purpose proportions of the *adjustable values of *depreciating assets
allocated to the pool under subsection 328‑185(3).
(2) For a later income year,
the opening pool balance of your *general
small business pool is that pool’s *closing pool
balance for the previous income year, reduced or increased by any adjustment
required under section 328‑225 (about change in the business use of an
asset).
Note: You continue to deduct
amounts using your general small business pool even if you are not a small
business entity, or do not choose to use this Subdivision, for a later income
year: see section 328‑220.
(3) However, if:
(a) you are not a *small business entity for an income year or you do not choose to use
this Subdivision for that year; but
(b) you are a small
business entity for a later income year and you choose to use this Subdivision
for the later year;
the opening pool balance of
your *general small business pool includes the
sum of the *taxable purpose proportions of the *adjustable values of *depreciating assets
allocated to the pool under subsection 328‑185(3) for that year.
328‑200 Closing pool balance
You work out the closing
pool balance of your *general small business
pool for an income year in this way:
Method statement
Step 1. Add to the *opening pool balance of
the pool for the income year:
(a) the
sum of the *taxable purpose proportions of the *adjustable values of *depreciating assets you
started to use, or have *installed ready for use,
for a *taxable purpose during the income year and
that are allocated to the pool; and
(b) the
taxable purpose proportion of any cost addition amounts (see subsection 328‑190(3))
for the income year for assets allocated to the pool.
Step 2. Subtract from the step 1 amount:
(a) the
*taxable purpose proportions of the *termination
values of *depreciating assets allocated to the pool
and for which a *balancing adjustment event occurred during
the income year; and
(b) your
deduction under subsection 328‑190(1) for the pool for the income year;
and
(c) your deductions under subsection 328‑190(2)
for *depreciating assets you started to use, or
have *installed ready for use, for a *taxable purpose during the income year and that are allocated to the
pool; and
(d) your
deductions under subsection 328‑190(3) for the income year for cost
addition amounts for assets allocated to the pool.
Step 3. The result is the closing pool balance of the pool
for the income year.
Note: A transferor does not
subtract anything for certain balancing adjustment events under paragraph (a)
of step 2 if roll‑over relief under section 40‑340 is chosen: see sections 328‑243
and 328‑245.
328‑205 Estimate of taxable use
(1) You
must, for the first income year for which you are, or last were, a *small business entity, make a reasonable estimate for that year of
the proportion you will use, or have *installed ready
for use, each *depreciating asset that you *held just before, and at the start of, that year for a *taxable purpose if:
(a) the asset has not
previously been allocated to your *general small
business pool; and
(b) you have started
to use it, or have it installed ready for use, for a taxable purpose; and
(c) you have chosen
to calculate your deductions for it under this Subdivision.
Note 1: That proportion will be 100%
for an asset that you expect to use, or have installed ready for use, solely
for a taxable purpose.
Note 2: Your estimate will be zero for
an income year if another provision of this Act denies a deduction for that
year: see section 328‑230.
Note 3: This subsection does not apply
to a transferee for certain assets if roll‑over relief under section 40‑340
is chosen: see sections 328‑243 and 328‑257.
(2) You
must also make this estimate for each *depreciating asset
that you *hold and start to use, or have *installed ready for use, for a *taxable
purpose during an income year for which you are a *small
business entity and you choose to use this Subdivision. You must make the
estimate for the income year in which you start to use it, or have it installed
ready for use, for such a purpose.
(3) The taxable
purpose proportion of a *depreciating asset’s *adjustable value, or of an amount included in the second element of
its *cost, is that part of that amount that
represents:
(a) the proportion
you estimated under subsection (1) or (2); or
(b) if you have had
to make an adjustment under section 328‑225 for the asset—the proportion
most recently applicable to the asset under that section.
Note: An amount included in the
second element of the cost of a depreciating asset is referred to in this Division
as a cost addition amount: see subsection 328‑190(3).
(4) The taxable
purpose proportion of a *depreciating asset’s *termination value is that part of that amount that represents:
(a) if you have not
had to make an adjustment under section 328‑225 for the asset—the
proportion you estimated under subsection (1) or (2); or
(b) if you have had
to make at least one such adjustment—the average of:
(i) the
proportion you estimated under subsection (1) or (2); and
(ii) the
proportion applicable to the asset for each of the 3 income years you *held the asset after the one in which the asset was allocated to the
pool.
Example: When Bria’s computer was
allocated to her general small business pool for the 2012‑13 income year, she
estimated that it would be used 50% for her florist business. Due to increasing
business, Bria estimates the computer’s use to be 70% for the 2013‑14 year, and
90% for the 2014‑15 year. She makes an adjustment under section 328‑225
for both those years.
Bria sells the computer
for $1,000 at the start of the 2016‑17 income year. She must now average the
business use estimates for the computer for the year it was allocated to the
pool and the next 3 years to work out the taxable purpose proportion of its
termination value. The average is worked out as follows:
·
50% (original estimate); plus
·
70% (2013‑14 estimate); plus
·
90% (2014‑15 estimate); plus
·
90% (no change on previous year);
=300% ÷ 4 =
75%
The taxable purpose
proportion of the computer’s termination value is, therefore:
75% of $1,000 = $750
328‑210 Low pool value
(1) Your
deduction for a *general small business pool for an income
year is the amount worked out under subsection (2) (instead of an amount
calculated under section 328‑190) if that amount is less than $1,000 but
more than zero.
Note: See
section 328‑215 for the result when the amount is less than zero.
(2) The
amount is the sum of:
(a) the pool’s *opening pool balance for the income year; and
(b) the *taxable purpose proportion of the *adjustable
value of each *depreciating asset you started to use, or
have *installed ready for use, for a *taxable purpose during the income year and that is allocated to the
pool; and
(c) the taxable
purpose proportion of any cost addition amounts (see subsection 328‑190(3))
for the income year for assets allocated to the pool;
less the sum of the taxable purpose
proportion of the *termination values of depreciating assets
allocated to the pool and for which a *balancing
adjustment event occurred during the income year.
(3) In that case, the *closing pool balance of the pool for that income year then becomes
zero.
Example: Amanda’s Graphics is a small
business entity for the 2014‑15 income year and chooses to use this Subdivision
for that year. The business has an opening pool balance of $8,500 for its
general small business pool for that year.
During that year, Amanda
acquired a new computer for $2,000. The taxable purpose proportion of its
adjustable value is:
$2,000 x 80% business use
estimate = $1,600
Amanda also sold her business
car for $9,600 during that year. The car was used 100% in the business.
To work out whether she
can deduct an amount under this section, Amanda uses this calculation:
$8,500 + $1,600 ‑ $9,600
= $500
Because the result is
less than $1,000, Amanda can deduct the $500 for the income year. The pool’s
closing balance for the year is zero.
328‑215 Disposal etc. of
depreciating assets
(1) This
section sets out adjustments you may have to make if a *balancing
adjustment event occurs for a *depreciating asset for
which you calculate your deductions under this Subdivision.
(2) If the asset is
allocated to your *general small business pool and:
(a) the *closing pool balance of the pool for the income year in which the
event occurred is less than zero; or
(b) the amount worked
out under subsection 328‑210(2) for that income year is less than zero;
the amount by which that balance or
amount is less than zero is included in your assessable income for that year.
(3) In that case, the *closing pool balance of the pool for that income year then becomes
zero.
(4) If the asset was one for
which you deducted an amount under section 328‑180 (about assets costing
less than $1,000), you include the *taxable purpose
proportion of the asset’s *termination value in your
assessable income.
328‑220 What happens if you are not
a small business entity or do not choose to use this Subdivision for an income
year
(1) If you are not a *small business entity for an income year or you do not choose to use
this Subdivision for that year, this Subdivision continues to apply to your *general small business pool for that year and later income years.
(2) However, *depreciating assets you started to use, or have *installed ready for use, for a *taxable
purpose during an income year for which you are not a *small
business entity or do not choose to use this Subdivision cannot be allocated to
your *general small business pool under this
Subdivision until an income year for which you are a small business entity and
you choose to use this Subdivision.
(3) This section applies to
a transferee referred to in subsection 328‑243(1) or (1A) who:
(a) was not a *small business entity for the income year in which the relevant *balancing adjustment events occurred; or
(b) did not choose to
use this Subdivision for that year;
as if the transferee had been a small
business entity for an earlier income year and had chosen to use this
Subdivision for the earlier year. This rule applies even if roll‑over relief is
not chosen.
328‑225 Change in business use
(1) You must, for each
income year (the present year) after the year in which a *depreciating asset is allocated to a pool, make a reasonable
estimate of the proportion you use the asset, or have it *installed ready for use, for a *taxable
purpose in that year.
Note: This section is modified in
its application to a transferee for certain assets if roll‑over relief under
section 40‑340 is chosen: see sections 328‑243 and 328‑257.
(1A) You must make an
adjustment for the present year if your estimate for that year under subsection (1)
is different by more than 10 percentage points from:
(a) your original
estimate (see section 328‑205); or
(b) if you have made
an adjustment under this section—the most recent estimate you made under subsection (1)
that resulted in an adjustment under this section.
(2) The adjustment is made
to the *opening pool balance of the *general small business pool to which the asset was allocated, and it
must be made before you calculate your deduction under this Subdivision for the
present year.
Note: The opening pool balance will
be reduced if the adjustment worked out under subsection (3) is a negative
amount. It will be increased if the adjustment is positive.
(3) The adjustment is:

where:
asset
value is:
(a) for a *depreciating asset you started to use, or have *installed ready for use, for a *taxable
purpose during an income year for which you were a *small
business entity and chose to use this Subdivision—the asset’s *adjustable value at that time; or
(b) for an asset you
started to use, or have installed ready for use, for a taxable purpose during
an income year for which you were not a *small
business entity or did not choose to use this Subdivision—its adjustable value
at the start of the income year for which it was allocated to a *general small business pool;
increased by any amounts included in the
second element of the asset’s *cost from the time
mentioned in paragraph (a) or (b) until the beginning of the income year
for which you are making the adjustment.
last
estimate is:
(a) your original
estimate of the proportion you use, or have *installed
ready for use, a *depreciating asset for a *taxable purpose (see section 328‑205); or
(b) if you have made
an adjustment under this section—the latest estimate taken into account under
this section.
present year estimate is your reasonable estimate of the proportion you use the asset, or
have it *installed ready for use, for a *taxable purpose during the present year.
reduction factor is the number worked out under subsection (4).
(4) The
reduction factor in the formula in subsection (3) is:
(a) for
a *depreciating asset you started to use, or have *installed ready for use, for a *taxable
purpose during an income year for which you were a *small
business entity and chose to use this Subdivision:

(b) for an asset you
started to use, or have *installed ready for use,
for a taxable purpose during an income year for which you were not a *small business entity or did not choose to use this Subdivision:

where:
n is
the number of income years (counting part of an income year as a whole year)
before the present year for which you have deducted or can deduct an amount for
the *depreciating asset under this Subdivision.
rate
is the rate applicable to the pool to which the asset is allocated.
Note: The reduction factor for a
depreciating asset in your general small business pool which you started to
use, or have installed ready for use, for a taxable purpose during an income
year for which you were not a small business entity or did not choose to use
this Subdivision is:
·
0.7 for the income year after it is allocated to
the pool; and
·
0.49 for the income year after that; and
·
0.343 for the income year after that.
The reduction factor for
a depreciating asset in your general small business pool which you started to
use, or have installed ready for use, for a taxable purpose during an income
year for which you were a small business entity and chose to use this
Subdivision is:
·
0.85 for the income year after it is allocated
to the pool; and
·
0.595 for the income year after that; and
·
0.417 for the income year after that.
Exceptions
(5) However:
(a) you do not need
to make an estimate or an adjustment under this section for a *depreciating asset for an income year that is at least 3 income
years after the income year in which the asset was allocated; and
(b) you cannot make
an adjustment for a depreciating asset if your reasonable estimate of the
proportion you use a depreciating asset, or have it *installed
ready for use, for a *taxable purpose changes in a
later income year by the 10 percentage points mentioned in subsection (1)
or less.
328‑230 Estimate where deduction
denied
This Subdivision
applies to you as if you had estimated that you will not use, or have *installed ready for use, a *depreciating asset
at all for a *taxable purpose during an income year if a
provision of this Act outside this Division denies a deduction for the asset
for that year.
328‑235 Interaction with Divisions 85
and 86
(1) Despite sections 85‑10
and 86‑60, if you are a *small business entity
for an income year you can deduct amounts for *depreciating
assets under this Subdivision.
(2) However, you cannot
deduct an amount for a *car under this
Subdivision if, had you not been a *small business entity
and chosen to use this Subdivision, sections 86‑60 and 86‑70 would have
prevented you deducting an amount for it.
Special rules about
roll‑overs
328‑243 Roll‑over relief
(1A) There is roll‑over relief
under subsection 40‑340(1) (as affected by subsection 40‑340(2)) if:
(a) *balancing adjustment events occur for *depreciating
assets on a day (the BAE day) because an entity
(the transferor) disposes of the assets in an income year to
another entity (the transferee); and
(b) the disposal
involves a *CGT event; and
(c) the conditions in
item 1, 2 or 3 of the table in subsection 40‑340(1) are satisfied;
and
(d) deductions for
the assets are calculated under this Subdivision; and
(e) the transferor
and the transferee jointly choose the roll‑over relief; and
(f) the condition in
subsection (2) is met.
(1) Roll‑over relief can be
chosen under subsection 40‑340(3) if:
(a) *balancing adjustment events occur for *depreciating
assets on a day (the BAE day) because of subsection 40‑295(2);
and
(b) deductions for
the assets are calculated under this Subdivision; and
(c) the entity or
entities that had an interest in the assets just before the balancing
adjustment events occurred (the transferor) and the entity or
entities that have an interest in the assets just after the events occurred
(the transferee) jointly choose the roll‑over relief; and
(d) the condition in subsection (2)
is met.
(2) All of the *depreciating assets that, just before the *balancing
adjustment events occurred, were:
(a) *held by the transferor; and
(b) allocated to the
transferor’s *general small business pool;
must be held by the transferee just after
those events occurred.
328‑245 Consequences of roll‑over
(1) The transferor does not
subtract anything for the *balancing adjustment
events under:
(a) paragraph (a)
of step 2 in the method statement in section 328‑200; or
(b) subsection 328‑210(2).
(2) Subsection 328‑215(4)
does not apply to the *balancing adjustment
events for the transferor.
(3) A choice made by the
transferor for a *depreciating asset under subsection 328‑175(3)
(about primary production assets) applies to the transferee as if it had been
made by the transferee.
(4) Sections 328‑247 to
328‑257 have effect.
328‑247 Pool deductions
(1) The amount that can be
deducted for the transferor’s *general small business
pool for the income year (the BAE year) in which the *balancing adjustment events occurred under subsection 328‑190(1)
or section 328‑210 for the BAE year is split equally between:
(a) the transferor
and the transferee; or
(b) if there are 2 or
more occurrences of balancing adjustment events for relevant entities for the
BAE year and a roll‑over is chosen for each occurrence—the entities concerned.
Example: John and Dave operate a dry
cleaning business in partnership (the transferor). The transferor is a small
business entity for the relevant income year and has chosen to use this
Subdivision for that year. On the 90th day of an income year, Jonathan joins
the partnership. The new partnership (the transferee) is a small business
entity for the income year and chooses to use this Subdivision for that year.
Had there been no partnership change, a deduction of $6,600 would have been
available for the transferor’s general small business pool. The transferor and
transferee jointly choose the roll‑over.
The deduction available
to the transferor and the transferee for the pool under section 328‑210 is
$3,300 each.
(2) The transferor cannot
deduct any amount for the transferor’s *general
small business pool for an income year after the BAE year.
328‑250 Deductions for assets first
used in BAE year
(1) This section applies in
working out the amount that the transferor or transferee can deduct for the BAE
year under subsection 328‑180(1) (assets costing less than $1,000) or
subsection 328‑190(2) (assets that will be pooled) for a *depreciating asset that the transferor or transferee started to use,
or have *installed ready for use, for a *taxable purpose during the BAE year.
Asset first used by transferor
(2) If the asset was first
used or *installed ready for use by the transferor,
the amount that can be deducted under subsection 328‑180(1) or 328‑190(2)
for the asset for the BAE year is split equally between:
(a) the transferor and
the transferee; or
(b) if there are 2 or
more occurrences of *balancing adjustment events for
relevant entities for the BAE year and a roll‑over is chosen for each
occurrence—the entities concerned.
Asset first used by transferee
(3) If the asset was first
used or *installed ready for use by the transferee:
(a) the transferor
cannot deduct anything for the asset for the BAE year; and
(b) the amount that
can be deducted under subsection 328‑180(1) or 328‑190(2) for the asset
for the BAE year is:
(i) deductible
by the transferee; or
(ii) if
there are 2 or more occurrences of *balancing
adjustment events for relevant entities for the BAE year and a roll‑over is
chosen for each occurrence—split equally between the entities concerned (except
ones that did not use the asset or have it installed ready for use).
Example: To
continue the example from section 328‑247, the transferee buys an asset on
the 150th day of the BAE year for $800.
On the 250th day of the
year, Evan joins the transferee partnership. The new transferee partnership is
a small business entity for the BAE year, and chooses to use this Subdivision
for that year, and a further roll‑over is chosen.
The original transferor
cannot deduct anything for the asset. The original transferee (now a transferor)
and the new transferee can deduct $400 each.
Special rule for assets costing less
than $1,000
(4) Subsection (5)
applies if:
(a) the transferor
started to use, or have *installed ready for use,
an asset of a kind mentioned in paragraph 328‑180(1)(b) during the BAE
year; and
(b) a *balancing adjustment event occurs for that asset before the BAE day.
(5) The transferee cannot
deduct anything for the asset for the BAE year, and subsection 328‑215(4)
does not apply to the transferee in relation to the asset.
328‑253 Deductions for cost addition
amounts
(1) This section applies in
working out the amount that the transferor or transferee can deduct for the BAE
year under subsection 328‑180(2) or 328‑190(3) for expenditure incurred by
the transferor or transferee during the BAE year that is included in the second
element of the *cost of a depreciating asset.
Expenditure incurred by transferor
(2) If the expenditure was
incurred by the transferor, the amount that can be deducted under subsection 328‑180(2)
or 328‑190(3) for the BAE year is split equally between:
(a) the transferor
and the transferee; or
(b) if there are 2 or
more occurrences of *balancing adjustment events for
relevant entities for the BAE year and a roll‑over is chosen for each occurrence—the
entities concerned.
Expenditure incurred by transferee
(3) If the expenditure was
incurred by the transferee:
(a) the transferor
cannot deduct anything for the expenditure for the BAE year; and
(b) the amount that
can be deducted under subsection 328‑180(2) or 328‑190(3) for the
expenditure for the BAE year is:
(i) deductible
by the transferee; or
(ii) if
there are 2 or more occurrences of *balancing
adjustment events for relevant entities for the BAE year and a roll‑over is
chosen for each occurrence—split equally between the entities concerned.
Special rule for expenditure on assets
costing less than $1,000
(4) Subsection (5)
applies if:
(a) the transferor
incurred the expenditure in relation to an asset of a kind mentioned in paragraph 328‑180(1)(b);
and
(b) a *balancing adjustment event occurs for that asset before the BAE day.
(5) The transferee cannot
deduct anything for the expenditure for the BAE year, and subsection 328‑215(4)
does not apply to the transferee in relation to the asset.
328‑255 Closing pool balance etc.
below zero
(1) This section applies if:
(a) the *closing pool balance of the transferor’s *general
small business pool for the BAE year is less than zero; or
(b) the amount worked
out under subsection 328‑210(2) for the pool for the BAE year is less than
zero;
because a *balancing
adjustment event occurred for an asset allocated to that pool during that year.
(2) The amount included in
assessable income under subsection 328‑215(2) is split equally between:
(a) the transferor
and transferee; or
(b) if there are 2 or
more occurrences of *balancing adjustment events for
relevant entities for the BAE year and a roll‑over is chosen for each
occurrence—the entities concerned.
328‑257 Taxable use
(1) This section applies to *depreciating assets (the previously held assets) that
were *held by the transferor just before the *balancing adjustment events occurred.
(2) Subsection 328‑205(1)
(about estimates of taxable use) does not apply to previously held assets in the
hands of the transferee for the BAE year. Instead, the transferee uses for the
BAE year:
(a) the estimate made
by the transferor under that subsection for the asset; or
(b) if the transferor
had made one or more estimates for the asset under subsection 328‑225(1)
that resulted in an adjustment under section 328‑225 (about change in
business use)—that estimate or the most recent of those estimates.
(3) Section 328‑225
applies to the transferee for each previously held asset for income years after
the BAE year as if:
(a) the
transferee had *held the asset during the period that the
transferor held it; and
(b) estimates
applicable to the transferor for the asset under that section were also
applicable to the transferee.
Subdivision 328‑E—Trading stock for small business entities
Guide to Subdivision 328‑E
328‑280 What this Subdivision is
about
Small business
entities can choose not to account for their trading stock in some
circumstances. This Subdivision modifies the rules in Division 70 about
trading stock for small business entities.
Table
of sections
Operative provisions
328‑285 Trading stock for small
business entities
328‑295 Value of trading stock on
hand
Operative provisions
328‑285 Trading stock for small
business entities
You can choose not to
account for changes in the *value of your *trading stock for an income year if:
(a) you are a *small business entity for that year; and
(b) the difference
between the value of all your trading stock on hand at the start of that year
and the value you reasonably estimate of all your trading stock on hand at the
end of that year is not more than $5,000.
Note 1: As a result, sections 70‑35
and 70‑45 (about comparing the value of each item of trading stock on hand at
the start and end of an income year) will not apply to you for the income year.
Note 2: When making a reasonable
estimate of the value of trading stock on hand:
·
special valuation rules may be used, for
example, obsolete stock, natural increase of livestock, horse breeding stock;
and
·
the estimated value disregards an amount equal
to the amount of input tax credits (if any) to which you would be entitled for
an item if the acquisition of the item had been solely for a creditable
purpose: see subsection 70‑45(1A).
Note 3: If you choose to account for
changes in the value of your trading stock for an income year, you will have to
do a stocktake and account for the change in the value of all your trading
stock: see Subdivision 70‑C.
328‑295 Value of trading stock on
hand
(1) If you make a choice
under section 328‑285 for an income year, the *value
of all your *trading stock on hand at the start of the
income year is:
(a) the same amount
as was taken into account under this Act at the end of the previous income
year; or
(b) zero if no item
of trading stock was taken into account under this Act at the end of the
previous income year.
Note: The amount taken into account
at the end of the previous income year is worked out under either section 70‑45
or subsection (2) of this section.
(2) If you make a choice
under section 328‑285 for an income year, this Act applies to you as if
the *value of all your *trading
stock on hand at the end of the year were equal to the value of all your
trading stock on hand at the start of the year.
Note: If you do not make a choice
under section 328‑285, the value of trading stock on hand at the end of
the year is worked out using section 70‑45.
Example: Angela operates a riding school,
and also sells riding gear. Her business is a small business entity for the
2008‑09 income year and makes a choice under section 328‑285 for that
year.
At the start of the 2008‑09
income year, the opening value of Angela’s trading stock is $30,000. Using her
reliable inventory system, she estimates the closing value to be $34,000.
The closing value for the
2008‑09 income year, and the opening value for the 2009‑10 income year, will be
$30,000.
Division 345—FHSAs
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 345
345‑A Treatment of FHSA providers
345‑B Treatment of FHSA holders
345‑C FHSA misuse tax
Guide to Division 345
345‑1 What this Division is about
FHSAs (short for
first home saver accounts) are accounts, life policies and interests in trusts
that comply with requirements in the First Home Saver Accounts Act 2008.
This Division sets
out the income tax treatment of the financial institutions that provide FHSAs
(Subdivision 345‑A) and of individuals that hold FHSAs (Subdivision 345‑B).
Certain payments from
FHSAs are subject to FHSA misuse tax (Subdivision 345‑C).
Subdivision 345‑A—Treatment of FHSA providers
Table
of sections
345‑5 FHSA provider that is
trustee of FHSA trust—tax payable
345‑10 FHSA provider that is
trustee of FHSA trust—CGT to be primary code for calculating gains or losses
345‑15 FHSA provider that is an ADI
(other than RSA provider)—taxable income and standard component of taxable
income
345‑20 FHSA provider that is an
ADI—FHSA component of taxable income
345‑25 FHSA provider that is an
ADI (other than an RSA provider)—amounts that cannot be deducted
345‑30 Amounts of tax paid by
FHSA providers that are ADIs
345‑5 FHSA provider that is trustee
of FHSA trust—tax payable
(1) The trustee of an *FHSA trust is liable to pay income tax for the *financial year on the taxable income of the trust.
(2) The amount of the tax is
the amount of income tax that would be payable by the trust under section 4‑10
if the trust were an *Australian resident liable (in
accordance with section 4‑1) to pay income tax for the *financial year.
(3) For the purposes of subsection (2):
(a) apply the special
rules in this Subdivision in working out the taxable income of the trust; and
(b) apply the
applicable rate of tax specified in section 30 of the Income Tax Rates
Act 1986 to the taxable income of the trust.
345‑10 FHSA provider that is trustee
of FHSA trust—CGT to be primary code for calculating gains or losses
(1) The modifications in subsection (2)
apply if a *CGT event happens involving a *CGT asset that was owned by an *FHSA
trust.
(2) These provisions do not
apply to the *CGT event:
(a) sections 6‑5
(about *ordinary income);
(b) section 8‑1
(about amounts you can deduct);
(c) sections 15‑15
and 25‑40 (about profit‑making undertakings or plans).
Exceptions
(3) The provisions referred
to in subsection (2) can apply to the *CGT
event if:
(a) any *capital gain or *capital loss from the
event is attributable to currency exchange rate fluctuations; or
(b) the *CGT asset is one of the following:
(i) debenture
stock, a bond, *debenture, certificate of entitlement,
bill of exchange, promissory note or other security;
(ii) a
deposit with a bank, building society or other financial institution;
(iii) a
loan (secured or not);
(iv) some
other contract under which an entity is liable to pay an amount (whether the
liability is secured or not).
(4) The provisions referred
to in subsection (2) can also apply to the *CGT
event if a *capital gain or *capital
loss from the event is disregarded because of one of the provisions in this
table:
|
Where
gain or loss disregarded because of CGT provision
|
|
Item
|
Provision
|
Brief
description
|
|
1
|
Paragraph 104‑15(4)(a)
|
Title in a CGT asset does not pass when a
hire purchase or similar agreement ends
|
|
2
|
Section 118‑5
|
Cars, motor cycles and valour decorations
|
|
3
|
Section 118‑10
|
Collectables and personal use assets
|
|
4
|
Section 118‑13
|
Shares in a PDF
|
|
5
|
Section 118‑25
|
Trading stock
|
|
6
|
Section 118‑30
|
Film copyright
|
|
7
|
Section 118‑35
|
R&D
|
|
8
|
Section 118‑55
|
Foreign currency hedging gains and losses
|
|
9
|
Section 118‑60
|
Certain gifts
|
|
10
|
Section 118‑300
|
Insurance policies
|
|
11
|
Section 118‑305
|
Superannuation
|
345‑15 FHSA provider that is an ADI
(other than RSA provider)—taxable income and standard component of taxable
income
(1) The
taxable income of an *FHSA provider that is an *ADI (other than an *RSA provider) is split
into an *FHSA component and a *standard component.
Note: The
taxable income of an FHSA provider that is an ADI and an RSA provider is split
into an RSA component, an FHSA component and a standard component (see section 295‑555).
(2) If
the *FHSA component exceeds the *FHSA provider’s taxable income:
(a) the
provider’s taxable income is equal to the FHSA component; and
(b) this Act applies
to the provider as if it had a *tax loss for the income
year of an amount that would have been that loss if the FHSA component were not
*ordinary income or *statutory income.
(3) The standard
component is the remaining part (if any) of the *FHSA provider’s taxable income for the income year after subtracting
the *FHSA component.
345‑20 FHSA provider that is an
ADI—FHSA component of taxable income
The FHSA component for an
income year of an *FHSA provider that is an *ADI is the total earnings or other return for the year credited
to *FHSAs provided by the FHSA provider, reduced by the total amount of
fees (however described) paid from those FHSAs to the FHSA provider for
providing them.
345‑25 FHSA provider that is an ADI
(other than an RSA provider)—amounts that cannot be deducted
An *FHSA provider that is an *ADI (other than an
*RSA provider) cannot deduct anything for amounts credited to *FHSAs.
345‑30 Amounts of tax paid by FHSA
providers that are ADIs
An amount is not
assessable income and is not *exempt income of an *FHSA provider if:
(a) the amount is
paid from an *FHSA to the FHSA provider to enable the
provider to make a payment of a kind mentioned in paragraph 31(1)(h) of
the First Home Saver Accounts Act 2008; and
(b) the provider is
an ADI.
Subdivision 345‑B—Treatment of FHSA holders
Table
of sections
345‑50 Credits to and payments
from FHSAs etc.
345‑50 Credits to and payments from
FHSAs etc.
(1) An amount of earnings or
other return credited to an *FHSA you hold is not
your assessable income and is not your *exempt
income.
(2) A payment made from an *FHSA you hold is not your assessable income and is not your *exempt income.
(3) A *Government FHSA contribution payable for you in accordance with the First
Home Saver Accounts Act 2008, and paid in accordance with Part 4 of
that Act, is not your assessable income and is not your *exempt income.
(4) A *capital gain or *capital loss that you
make from a *CGT event happening in relation to a right
to, or any part of, an *FHSA that you hold is
disregarded.
Subdivision 345‑C—FHSA misuse tax
Table
of sections
345‑100 Liability for FHSA misuse
tax
345‑110 Due date for payment of
FHSA misuse tax
345‑115 General interest charge
345‑100 Liability for FHSA misuse
tax
Payments to acquire a home
(1) A person is liable to
pay tax imposed by the Income Tax (First Home Saver Accounts Misuse Tax) Act
2008 in respect of a *FHSA home acquisition
payment from an *FHSA held by the person if:
(a) the payment fails
to satisfy the *FHSA payment conditions; or
(b) the
payment satisfies the FHSA payment conditions, but is an *FHSA ineligibility payment.
Note: The
Commissioner may make an assessment of the amount of the tax under section 169
of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936.
Payments for repaying a mortgage
(2) A person is liable to
pay tax imposed by the Income Tax (First Home Saver Accounts Misuse Tax) Act
2008 in respect of an *FHSA mortgage payment
from an *FHSA held by the person if:
(a) the payment fails
to satisfy the *FHSA payment conditions; or
(b) the payment
satisfies the FHSA payment conditions, but is an *FHSA
ineligibility payment.
Note: The Commissioner may make an
assessment of the amount of the tax under section 169 of the Income Tax
Assessment Act 1936.
345‑110 Due date for payment of FHSA
misuse tax
*FHSA misuse tax assessed for a person is due and payable 21 days
after the Commissioner gives the person notice of the assessment.
345‑115 General interest charge
If *FHSA misuse tax payable by a person remains unpaid after the time by
which it is due and payable, the person is liable to pay the *general interest charge on the unpaid amount for each day in the
period that:
(a) starts at the
beginning of the day on which the FHSA misuse tax was due to be paid; and
(b) ends at the end
of the last day on which, at the end of the day, any of the following remains
unpaid:
(i) the
FHSA misuse tax;
(ii) general
interest charge on any of the FHSA misuse tax.
Note: The general interest charge
is worked out under Part IIA of the Taxation Administration Act 1953.
Division 355—Research and Development
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 355
355‑A Object
355‑B Meaning of R&D activities
and other terms
355‑C Entitlement to tax offset
355‑D Notional deductions for
R&D expenditure
355‑E Notional deductions for
decline in value of depreciating assets used for R&D activities
355‑F Integrity Rules
355‑G Clawback of R&D
recoupments
355‑H Feedstock adjustments
355‑I Application to earlier
income year R&D expenditure incurred to associates
355‑J Application to R&D
partnerships
355‑K Application to Cooperative
Research Centres
355‑W Other matters
Guide to Division 355
355‑1 What this Division is about
An R&D entity may
be entitled to a tax offset for R&D activities. The tax offset may be a
refundable tax offset if the R&D entity’s aggregated turnover is less than
$20 million.
To be entitled to the
tax offset, the R&D entity needs one or more notional deductions under this
Division.
There are 2 main
kinds of notional deductions. One is for expenditure on R&D activities. The
other is for the decline in value of tangible depreciating assets used for
R&D activities.
Note: All of these notional
deductions require the R&D entity to be registered for the R&D
activities under Part III of the Industry Research and Development Act
1986.
Subdivision 355‑A—Object
Table of sections
355‑5 Object
355‑5 Object
(1) The object of this
Division is to encourage industry to conduct research and development
activities that might otherwise not be conducted because of an uncertain return
from the activities, in cases where the knowledge gained is likely to benefit
the wider Australian economy.
(2) This object is to be
achieved by providing a tax incentive for industry to conduct, in a scientific
way, experimental activities for the purpose of generating new knowledge or
information in either a general or applied form (including
new knowledge in the form of new or improved materials, products,
devices, processes or services).
Subdivision 355‑B—Meaning of R&D activities and other terms
Table of sections
355‑20 R&D activities
355‑25 Core R&D activities
355‑30 Supporting R&D
activities
355‑35 R&D entities
355‑20 R&D activities
R&D
activities are *core R&D activities
or *supporting R&D activities.
355‑25 Core R&D activities
(1) Core
R&D activities are experimental activities:
(a) whose outcome cannot
be known or determined in advance on the basis of current knowledge,
information or experience, but can only be determined by applying a systematic
progression of work that:
(i) is
based on principles of established science; and
(ii) proceeds
from hypothesis to experiment, observation and evaluation, and leads to logical
conclusions; and
(b) that are
conducted for the purpose of generating new knowledge (including new knowledge
in the form of new or improved materials, products, devices, processes or
services).
(2) However, none of the
following activities are core R&D activities:
(a) market research,
market testing or market development, or sales promotion (including consumer
surveys);
(b) prospecting,
exploring or drilling for minerals or *petroleum for the
purposes of one or more of the following:
(i) discovering
deposits;
(ii) determining
more precisely the location of deposits;
(iii) determining
the size or quality of deposits;
(c) management
studies or efficiency surveys;
(d) research in
social sciences, arts or humanities;
(e) commercial, legal
and administrative aspects of patenting, licensing or other activities;
(f) activities
associated with complying with statutory requirements or standards, including
one or more of the following:
(i) maintaining
national standards;
(ii) calibrating
secondary standards;
(iii) routine
testing and analysis of materials, components, products, processes, soils,
atmospheres and other things;
(g) any activity
related to the reproduction of a commercial product or process:
(i) by a
physical examination of an existing system; or
(ii) from
plans, blueprints, detailed specifications or publically available information;
(h) developing,
modifying or customising computer software for the dominant purpose of use by
any of the following entities for their internal administration (including the
internal administration of their business functions):
(i) the
entity (the developer) for which the software is developed,
modified or customised;
(ii) an
entity *connected with the developer;
(iii) an *affiliate of the developer, or an entity of which the developer is
an affiliate.
355‑30 Supporting R&D
activities
(1) Supporting
R&D activities are activities directly related to *core R&D activities.
(2) However, if an activity:
(a) is an activity
referred to in subsection 355‑25(2); or
(b) produces goods or
services; or
(c) is directly
related to producing goods or services;
the activity is a supporting
R&D activity only if it is undertaken for the dominant purpose of
supporting *core R&D activities.
355‑35 R&D entities
(1) Each of the following is
an R&D entity:
(a) a body corporate
incorporated under an *Australian law;
(b) a body corporate
incorporated under a *foreign law that is an Australian
resident.
Note: Each of the above paragraphs
extends to a body corporate acting in its capacity as trustee of a public
trading trust (see subsection 102T(9) of the Income Tax Assessment Act
1936).
(2) A body corporate
incorporated under a *foreign law that:
(a) is a resident of
a foreign country for the purposes of an agreement in force between that
country and Australia that:
(i) is a
double tax agreement (as defined in Part X of the Income Tax Assessment
Act 1936); and
(ii) includes
a definition of permanent establishment; and
(b) carries on
business in Australia through a permanent establishment (within the meaning of
that definition) of the body corporate in Australia;
is an R&D entity to the
extent that it carries on business through that permanent establishment.
(3) However, an *exempt entity cannot be an R&D entity.
Subdivision 355‑C—Entitlement to tax offset
Table of sections
355‑100 Entitlement to tax offset
355‑105 Deductions under this
Division are notional only
355‑110 Notional deductions
include prepaid expenditure
355‑100 Entitlement to tax offset
If notional deductions are between
$20,000 and $100 million
(1) An *R&D entity is entitled to a *tax
offset for an income year equal to the percentage, set out in the table, of the
total of the amounts (if any) that the entity can deduct for the income year
under any or all of the following provisions:
(a) section 355‑205
(R&D expenditure);
(b) section 355‑305
(decline in value of R&D assets);
(c) section 355‑315
(balancing adjustment for R&D assets);
(d) section 355‑480
(earlier year associate R&D expenditure);
(e) section 355‑520
(decline in value of R&D partnership assets);
(f) section 355‑525
(balancing adjustment for R&D partnership assets);
(g) section 355‑580
(CRC contributions).
|
Rate
of R&D tax offset
|
|
Item
|
In
this case:
|
The
percentage is:
|
|
1
|
the *R&D entity’s *aggregated turnover
for the income year is less than $20 million (and item 2 of this table
does not apply)
|
45%
|
|
2
|
at any time during the income year an *exempt entity, or combination of exempt entities, would control
the *R&D entity in a way described in
section 328‑125 (connected entities) if:
(a) references in section 328‑125 to
40% were references to 50%; and
(b) subsection 328‑125(6) were
ignored
|
40%
|
|
3
|
any other case
|
40%
|
Note: The tax offset will be a
refundable tax offset if the percentage applicable to the entity is 45% (see
section 67‑30).
If notional deductions are less than
$20,000
(2) However, if the total of
those amounts is less than $20,000, the *R&D
entity is instead entitled to a *tax offset for the
income year equal to that percentage of the total of the following kinds of
expenditure (if any):
|
Expenditure
not subject to $20,000 threshold
|
|
Item
|
Kind
of expenditure
|
|
1
|
Expenditure:
(a) that the *R&D entity can deduct under section 355‑205 (R&D
expenditure) for the income year; and
(b) that was incurred to a research service
provider (within the meaning of the Industry Research and Development Act
1986) that is not an *associate of the
R&D entity or of the relevant *R&D
partnership (as appropriate); and
(c) that was for the provider to provide
services, within a research field for which the provider is registered under
Division 4 of Part III of that Act, applicable to one or more of
the *R&D activities to which the
deduction relates
|
|
2
|
Expenditure that the *R&D entity can deduct under section 355‑580 (CRC
contributions) for the income year
|
If notional deductions exceed $100
million
(3) Despite subsection (1),
if the total of those amounts exceeds $100 million, the *R&D entity is instead entitled to a *tax
offset for the income year equal to the sum of:
(a) that percentage
of $100 million; and
(b) the product of
the excess and the *corporate tax rate.
Note: The R&D entity may be
able to reduce related amounts that would otherwise be:
(a) included in its assessable income
because of a balancing, or feedstock, adjustment; or
(b) payable as extra income tax because
of an R&D recoupment;
(see section 355‑720).
355‑105 Deductions under this
Division are notional only
An amount (the notional
amount) that an *R&D entity can
deduct under this Division is disregarded except for the purposes of:
(a) working out
whether the R&D entity is entitled under section 355‑100 to a *tax offset; and
(b) a provision (of
this Act or any other Act) that refers to an entitlement of the R&D entity
under section 355‑100 to a tax offset; and
(c) a provision (of
this Act or any other Act) that:
(i) prevents
some or all of the notional amount from being deducted; or
(ii) changes
the income year for which some or all of the notional amount can be deducted;
and
Note: Examples are Divisions 26
and 27 of this Act, Subdivision H of Division 3 of Part III of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936 and Part IVA of that Act.
(d) a provision (of
this Act or any other Act) that includes an amount in assessable income wholly
or partly because of the notional amount; and
Note: An example is Subdivision 20‑A,
which may include in assessable income a recoupment of a loss or outgoing if
the entity can deduct an amount for the loss or outgoing.
(e) a provision (of
this Act or any other Act) that excludes expenditure from:
(i) the *cost base or *reduced cost base of a *CGT asset; or
(ii) an
element of that cost base or reduced cost base.
Note: An example is section 110‑45,
which may exclude deductible expenditure from elements of the cost base of an
asset.
355‑110 Notional deductions include
prepaid expenditure
For
the purposes of this Division, if:
(a) apart from
Subdivision H (prepaid expenditure) of Division 3 of Part III of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936, an *R&D entity can
deduct an amount under section 355‑205 or 355‑480 for an income year (the present
year) or an earlier income year; and
(b) that Subdivision
applies to the calculation of that amount; and
(c) the entity can
deduct an amount, as a result of that application of that Subdivision, for the
present year;
the entity is taken to be able to deduct
under section 355‑205 or 355‑480 (as appropriate) the amount referred to
in paragraph (c) for the present year.
Note: Section 355‑205 is about
deductions for R&D expenditure. Section 355‑480 is about deductions
for earlier year associate R&D expenditure.
Subdivision 355‑D—Notional deductions for R&D expenditure
Table of sections
355‑200 What this Subdivision is
about
355‑205 When notional deductions
for R&D expenditure arise
355‑210 Conditions for R&D
activities
355‑215 R&D activities
conducted by a permanent establishment for other parts of the body corporate
355‑220 R&D activities
conducted for a foreign entity
355‑225 Expenditure that cannot be
notionally deducted
355‑200 What this Subdivision is
about
An R&D entity can
notionally deduct its expenditure on registered R&D activities for which
certain conditions are met.
There are special
conditions for R&D activities conducted for foreign residents.
355‑205 When notional deductions for
R&D expenditure arise
(1) An *R&D entity can deduct for an income year (the present year)
expenditure it incurs during that year to the extent that the expenditure:
(a) is incurred on
one or more *R&D activities:
(i) for
which the R&D entity is registered under section 27A of the Industry
Research and Development Act 1986 for an income year; and
(ii) that
are activities to which section 355‑210 (conditions for R&D
activities) applies; and
(b) if the
expenditure is incurred to the R&D entity’s *associate—is
paid to that associate during the present year.
Note 1: If the matters in subparagraphs (a)(i)
and (ii) are not satisfied until a later income year, the R&D entity will
need to wait until then before it can deduct the expenditure for the present
year.
Note 2: The R&D activities will
need to be conducted during the income year the R&D entity is registered
for those activities (see sections 27A and 27J of the Industry Research
and Development Act 1986).
Note 3: The entity may also be able to
deduct expenditure incurred to an associate in an earlier income year (see section 355‑480).
Note 4: Expenditure incurred in income
years starting on or after 1 July 2011 may
be deductible for activities registered for income years starting before 1 July 2011 (see section 355‑200 of the Income
Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997).
(2) This section has effect
subject to section 355‑225 (excluded expenditure), Subdivision 355‑F
(integrity rules) and subsection 355‑580(3) (CRC contributions).
355‑210 Conditions for R&D
activities
(1) An *R&D activity covered by one or more of the following paragraphs
is an activity to which this section applies:
(a) the R&D
activity is conducted for the *R&D entity solely
within Australia or an external Territory;
(b) if the R&D
entity is a body corporate carrying on business through a permanent
establishment (as described in subsection 355‑35(2))—the R&D activity
is conducted:
(i) for
the body corporate; but
(ii) not
for the purposes of that permanent establishment;
and the
conditions in section 355‑215 (activities conducted for a body corporate
by its permanent establishment) are met for the R&D activity;
(c) the R&D
activity is conducted for one or more foreign residents who are each:
(i) incorporated
under a *foreign law; and
(ii) a
resident of a foreign country for the purposes of an agreement of a kind
described in subsection 355‑35(2);
and the
conditions in section 355‑220 (activities conducted for a foreign entity)
are met for the R&D activity;
(d) the R&D
activity is:
(i) conducted
for the R&D entity solely outside Australia and the external Territories;
and
(ii) covered
by a finding in force under paragraph 28C(1)(a) of the Industry
Research and Development Act 1986;
(e) the R&D
activity consists of several parts, with:
(i) some
parts being conducted for the R&D entity solely within Australia or an
external Territory; and
(ii) the
other parts being conducted for the R&D entity outside Australia and the
external Territories while covered by a finding in force under paragraph 28C(1)(a)
of the Industry Research and Development Act 1986.
Note: An activity can be covered by
a finding under paragraph 28C(1)(a) of the Industry Research and
Development Act 1986 if the activity cannot be conducted in Australia or
the external Territories.
(2) However, an *R&D activity is not an activity to which this section applies if
the activity is conducted, to a significant extent, for one or more other
entities not covered by any paragraph of subsection (1).
Note: An entity would not be
covered by, for example, paragraph (1)(c) if the conditions in section 355‑220
were not met for the R&D activity in relation to that entity.
355‑215 R&D activities conducted
by a permanent establishment for other parts of the body corporate
For
the purposes of paragraph 355‑210(1)(b), the conditions for an *R&D activity are as follows:
(a) the R&D
activity is conducted solely within Australia or an external Territory;
(b) if
the R&D activity is a *supporting R&D
activity, each corresponding *core R&D activity
must be:
(i) an
activity conducted, or to be conducted, solely within Australia or an external
Territory; and
(ii) an
activity for which the *R&D entity is or has
been registered under section 27A of the Industry Research and
Development Act 1986, or could be registered for an income year if that core
R&D activity were conducted during the income year;
(c) there is written
evidence that the R&D activity is conducted for the body corporate but not
for the purposes of that permanent establishment.
Note: The body corporate is the
R&D entity to the extent that it carries on business through that permanent
establishment (see subsection 355‑35(2)).
355‑220 R&D activities conducted
for a foreign entity
(1) For the purposes of
paragraph 355‑210(1)(c), the conditions for an *R&D
activity conducted for one or more foreign residents are as follows:
(a) the R&D
activity is conducted solely within Australia or an external Territory;
(b) if the R&D
activity is a *supporting R&D activity, each
corresponding *core R&D activity must be:
(i) an
activity conducted, or to be conducted, solely within Australia or an external
Territory; and
(ii) an
activity for which the *R&D entity is or has
been registered under section 27A of the Industry Research and
Development Act 1986, or could be registered for an income year if that
core R&D activity were conducted during the income year;
(c) when the R&D
activity is conducted:
(i) each
foreign resident is *connected with the R&D
entity; or
(ii) for
each foreign resident—either the foreign resident is an *affiliate of the R&D entity or the R&D entity is an
affiliate of the foreign resident;
(d) the R&D
activity is conducted:
(i) in
accordance with a written agreement binding on only the R&D entity and each
foreign resident; and
(ii) either
directly by the R&D entity, or indirectly by another entity under an
agreement binding on the R&D entity;
(e) the R&D
activity is not conducted in connection with an agreement covered by subsection (2).
Note: An example of conducting an
R&D activity indirectly under a contract is conducting the R&D activity
under a subcontract, or one of a chain of subcontracts, under the contract.
(2) An agreement is covered
by this subsection if:
(a) the agreement is
binding on the R&D entity (the first entity) and an R&D
entity that:
(i) is *connected with the first entity; or
(ii) has
the first entity as an *affiliate, or is an
affiliate of the first entity;
while the *R&D activity is conducted; and
(b) the R&D
activity is to be conducted under the agreement by the first entity or by an
entity:
(i) who
is not bound by the agreement; and
(ii) who
is to conduct the R&D activity directly or indirectly under another
agreement to which the first entity is, or will become, bound.
Note: One effect of this subsection
is that, even if the R&D entity has an agreement with the foreign resident
for conducting the R&D activity, the R&D entity cannot deduct
expenditure incurred:
(a) for conducting the R&D activity
as a subcontractor under a subcontract with an affiliated R&D entity; or
(b) if the R&D entity is a
subcontractor to an affiliated R&D entity—for further subcontracting the
conducting of the R&D activity.
355‑225 Expenditure that cannot be
notionally deducted
Expenditure on buildings, certain
assets and interest
(1) Sections 355‑205
(deductions for R&D expenditure) and 355‑480 (deductions for earlier year
associate R&D expenditure) do not apply to the following expenditure:
(a) expenditure
incurred to acquire or construct:
(i) a
building or a part of a building; or
(ii) an
extension, alteration or improvement to a building;
(b) expenditure
included in the *cost of a tangible *depreciating asset for the purposes of Division 40 (as that
Division applies as described in section 355‑310 or otherwise);
(c) expenditure
incurred for interest (within the meaning of Division 11A of Part III
of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936) payable to an entity.
Note 1: Expenditure covered by paragraph (a)
may be deductible under Division 43 (capital works).
Note 2: The decline in value of an
asset covered by paragraph (b) may be notionally deductible under section 355‑305.
Note 3: Expenditure covered by paragraph (c)
may be deductible under section 8‑1.
Expenditure on core technology
(2) Sections 355‑205
(deductions for R&D expenditure) and 355‑480 (deductions for earlier year
associate R&D expenditure) do not apply to expenditure incurred in
acquiring, or in acquiring the right to use, technology wholly or partly for
the purposes of one or more *R&D activities if:
(a) a purpose of the
R&D activities was or is:
(i) to
obtain new knowledge based on that technology; or
(ii) to
create new or improved materials, products, devices, processes, techniques or
services to be based on that technology; or
(b) the R&D
activities were or are an extension, continuation, development or completion of
the activities that produced that technology.
Subdivision 355‑E—Notional deductions for decline in value of depreciating
assets used for R&D activities
Table of sections
355‑300 What this Subdivision is
about
355‑305 When notional deductions
for decline in value arise
355‑310 Notional application of
Division 40
355‑315 Balancing
adjustments—assets only used for R&D activities
355‑300 What this Subdivision is
about
An R&D entity can
notionally deduct the decline in value of a tangible depreciating asset used
for R&D activities.
If a balancing
adjustment event later happens for the asset, the R&D entity may be able to
notionally deduct a further amount. Alternatively, an amount may be included in
the R&D entity’s assessable income.
355‑305 When notional deductions for
decline in value arise
(1) If:
(a) an *R&D entity is registered under section 27A of the Industry
Research and Development Act 1986 for an income year (the present
year) for one or more *R&D activities that
are activities to which section 355‑210 (conditions for R&D
activities) applies; and
(b) while a tangible *depreciating asset is *held by the R&D
entity during the present year, the asset is used for the purpose of conducting
one or more of those R&D activities; and
(c) the R&D
entity could deduct an amount under section 40‑25 for the asset for the
present year if Division 40 applied with the changes described in section 355‑310;
and
(d) the R&D
entity cannot deduct an amount for the asset for:
(i) an
earlier income year under Subdivision 328‑D (capital allowances for small
business entities); or
(ii) an
earlier income year under Division 40 (as that Division applies apart from
this Division), in a case where section 40‑440 (low‑value pools) applied;
the R&D entity can deduct the amount
referred to in paragraph (c) for the present year.
(2) This section has effect
subject to subsection 355‑580(4) (CRC contributions).
355‑310 Notional application of
Division 40
(1) In addition to its
application apart from this section, Division 40 also applies with the
changes set out in this section for the purposes of:
(a) paragraph 355‑225(1)(b)
(excluded expenditure); and
(b) paragraph 355‑305(1)(c);
and
(c) section 355‑315
(balancing adjustments).
(2) Firstly, substitute the
following for references to a *taxable purpose in
Subdivisions 40‑A to 40‑D (other than for the purposes of sections 40‑100,
40‑105 and 40‑110):
|
Replacing
references to a taxable purpose
|
|
Item
|
If
this application of Division 40 is for the purposes of:
|
Substitute
a reference to:
|
|
1
|
paragraph 355‑225(1)(b) or 355‑305(1)(c)
|
the purpose of conducting one or more of
the *R&D activities covered by paragraph 355‑305(1)(b)
|
|
2
|
section 355‑315
|
the purpose of conducting one or more of
the *R&D activities to which the R&D
deductions (within the meaning of that section) relate
|
Note: Sections 40‑100, 40‑105
and 40‑110 are about working out an asset’s effective life. Those sections
already refer to the use of the asset for R&D activities.
(3) Secondly,
assume that Division 40 does not apply to a building, nor to an extension,
alteration or improvement to a building, (the building works) for
which the *R&D entity:
(a) can deduct
amounts under Division 43 (capital works); or
(b) could deduct amounts
under Division 43:
(i) apart
from expenditure being incurred, or the building works being started, before a
particular day; or
(ii) had
the R&D entity used the building works for a purpose relevant to those
building works under section 43‑140 (using an area in a deductible way).
(4) Finally, assume that the
following provisions had not been enacted:
(a) subsection 40‑25(7)
(meaning of taxable purpose);
(b) subsection 40‑45(2)
(assets to which Division 40 does not apply);
(c) section 40‑425
(low‑value pools);
(d) Subdivision 328‑D
(capital allowances for small business entities).
Note: Subsection (3) and paragraph (4)(b)
mean that deductions under section 355‑305 may be available for capital
works other than building works.
355‑315 Balancing adjustments—assets
only used for R&D activities
(1) This section applies to
an *R&D entity if:
(a) a *balancing adjustment event happens in an income year (the event
year) for an asset *held by the R&D
entity; and
(b) the R&D
entity cannot deduct an amount under section 40‑25, as that section
applies apart from:
(i) this
Division; and
(ii) former
section 73BC of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936;
for the asset
for an income year; and
(c) the R&D
entity is entitled under section 355‑100 to *tax
offsets for one or more income years for deductions (the R&D
deductions) under section 355‑305 for the asset; and
(d) the entity is
registered under section 27A of the Industry Research and Development
Act 1986 for one or more *R&D activities for
the event year; and
(e) if Division 40
applied with the changes described in section 355‑310:
(i) the
entity could deduct for the event year an amount under subsection 40‑285(2)
for the asset and the balancing adjustment event; or
(ii) an
amount would be included in the entity’s assessable income for the event year
under subsection 40‑285(1) for the asset and the balancing adjustment
event.
Note 1: This section applies in a
modified way if the entity also has deductions for the asset under former
section 73BA or 73BH of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 (see
section 355‑320 of the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997).
Note 2: Section 40‑292 applies if
the entity can deduct an amount under section 40‑25, as that section
applies apart from this Division and former section 73BC of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936.
Notional deduction
(2) If the *R&D entity could deduct for the event year an amount under
subsection 40‑285(2) for the asset and the event if Division 40
applied as described in paragraph (1)(e), the R&D entity can deduct
that amount for the event year.
Amount to be included in assessable
income
(3) If an amount (the section 40‑285
amount) would be included in the *R&D
entity’s assessable income for the event year under subsection 40‑285(1)
for the asset and the event if Division 40 applied as described in paragraph (1)(e),
the sum of that amount and the following amount is included in the R&D
entity’s assessable income for the event year:

where:
adjusted section 40‑285 amount means so much of the section 40‑285 amount as does not exceed
the total decline in value.
total decline in value means the asset’s *cost, less its *adjustable value, worked out under Division 40 as it applies as
described in paragraph (1)(e).
Subdivision 355‑F—Integrity Rules
Table of sections
355‑400 Expenditure incurred while
not at arm’s length
355‑405 Expenditure not at risk
355‑410 Disposal of R&D
results
355‑415 Reducing deductions to
reflect mark‑ups within groups
355‑400 Expenditure incurred while
not at arm’s length
If:
(a) an *R&D entity incurs expenditure to another entity on all or part
of an *R&D activity; and
(b) either:
(i) when
the R&D entity incurs the expenditure, the R&D entity and the other
entity do not deal with each other at *arm’s length; or
(ii) the
other entity is the R&D entity’s *associate; and
(c) the expenditure
exceeds the *market value of the relevant R&D
activity or part (as appropriate);
for the purposes of this Division, the
R&D entity is treated as if the amount of expenditure it incurred on the
relevant R&D activity or part (as appropriate) were equal to that market
value.
Note: For the purposes of a
deduction under section 355‑305 or 355‑520 for an asset’s decline in
value, the arm’s length rules in Division 40 apply as part of the notional
application of that Division under that section.
355‑405 Expenditure not at risk
(1) An *R&D entity cannot deduct expenditure under section 355‑205
or 355‑480 if:
(a) when it incurs
the expenditure, the R&D entity or its *associate
had received, or could reasonably be expected to receive, consideration:
(i) as a
direct or indirect result of the expenditure being incurred; and
(ii) regardless
of the results of the activities on which the expenditure is incurred; and
(b) that
consideration is equal to or greater than the expenditure.
Note: Section 355‑205 is about
deductions for R&D expenditure. Section 355‑480 is about deductions
for earlier year associate R&D expenditure.
(2) If:
(a) when an *R&D entity incurs expenditure, the R&D entity or its *associate had received, or could reasonably be expected to receive,
consideration:
(i) as a
direct or indirect result of the expenditure being incurred; and
(ii) regardless
of the results of the activities on which the expenditure is incurred; and
(b) that
consideration is less than the expenditure;
the R&D entity cannot deduct under
section 355‑205 or 355‑480 so much of the expenditure as is equal to the
consideration.
(3) For the purposes of paragraphs (1)(a)
and (2)(a), have regard to:
(a) anything that
happened or existed before or at the time the expenditure is incurred; and
(b) anything that is
likely to happen or exist after that time.
(4) This section does not
apply to expenditure incurred on *R&D activities
covered by paragraph 355‑210(1)(b) or (c).
Note: Those paragraphs cover
R&D activities conducted for foreign residents.
355‑410 Disposal of R&D results
(1) This section applies to
an *R&D entity if:
(a) the R&D
entity is entitled under section 355‑100 to a *tax
offset because it can:
(i) deduct
under section 355‑205 or 355‑480 expenditure incurred on *R&D activities; or
(ii) deduct
under section 355‑305 or 355‑520 an amount for an asset (the R&D
asset) used for the purpose of conducting one or more R&D activities;
and
(b) the R&D
entity receives or becomes entitled to receive one or more of the following
amounts (the results amounts) in an income year (the results
year):
(i) an
amount for the results of any of the R&D activities;
(ii) an
amount from granting access to, or the right to use, any of those results;
(iii) an
amount attributable to the R&D entity having incurred the expenditure,
including an amount it is entitled to receive regardless of the results of the
R&D activities;
(iv) an
amount attributable to the R&D asset being used for the purpose mentioned
in subparagraph (a)(ii), including an amount the R&D entity is
entitled to receive regardless of the results of the R&D activities;
(v) an
amount from *disposing of a *CGT
asset, or from granting a right to occupy or use a CGT asset, where the
disposal or grant resulted in another person acquiring a right to access or use
any of those results.
Note: This section also applies
with changes to the partners of an R&D partnership (see section 355‑535).
(2) For each results amount,
the following amount is included in the *R&D
entity’s assessable income for the results year:
(a) if the results
amount is only a results amount because of subparagraph (1)(b)(v), and the
asset referred to in that subparagraph is a *depreciating
asset—an amount equal to the extent (if any) that the results amount exceeds
the asset’s *cost just before the disposal or grant;
(b) if the results
amount is only a results amount because of subparagraph (1)(b)(v), and the
asset referred to in that subparagraph is not a depreciating asset—an amount
equal to the extent (if any) that the results amount exceeds the asset’s *cost base just before the disposal or grant;
(c) otherwise—the
results amount.
(3) For the purposes of paragraph (2)(a),
assume that subsection 40‑45(2) did not, except in the case of buildings
and extensions, alterations and improvements to buildings, prevent Division 40
from applying to certain capital works.
355‑415 Reducing deductions to
reflect mark‑ups within groups
(1) This section applies to
an *R&D entity if:
(a) the R&D
entity can deduct an amount under section 355‑205 or 355‑480 for an income
year for one or more *R&D activities; and
(b) one or more other
entities (the grouped entities) incurred expenditure during the
income year, or an earlier income year, on one or more of those *R&D activities; and
(c) when each grouped
entity incurred the expenditure:
(i) the
grouped entity was *connected with the R&D
entity; or
(ii) the
grouped entity was an *affiliate of the R&D
entity or the R&D entity was an affiliate of the grouped entity.
Note: Section 355‑205 is about
deductions for R&D expenditure. Section 355‑480 is about deductions
for earlier year associate R&D expenditure.
Reducing deductions by group mark‑ups
(2) The amount the *R&D entity can deduct, apart from this section, under section 355‑205
or 355‑480 for the income year is reduced by the amount (the reduction
amount) worked out as follows:
Method statement
Step 1. For each grouped entity, work out the sum of the amounts
derived during the income year, or an earlier income year, by the grouped
entity for goods or services relating to one or more of the *R&D activities while:
(a) the
grouped entity was *connected with the *R&D entity; or
(b) the
grouped entity was an *affiliate of the R&D
entity or the R&D entity was an affiliate of the grouped entity.
Step 2. From the
sum of those amounts, subtract the actual cost to each grouped entity of
providing the goods or services that correspond to those amounts.
If R&D entity has deductions for
both R&D expenditure and earlier year associate R&D expenditure
(3) However, if the *R&D entity can deduct amounts under both sections 355‑205
and 355‑480 for the income year, those amounts are reduced as follows:
(a) apply the
reduction amount to reduce the amount otherwise deductible under section 355‑205
(but not below zero); and
(b) then apply any
remainder of the reduction amount to reduce the amount otherwise deductible
under section 355‑480 (but not below zero).
Disregard mark‑ups already taken into
account
(4) For the purposes of step
1 of the method statement in subsection (2), disregard any of the amounts
from that step that have already been taken into account under this section for
the *R&D entity and the *R&D activities for an earlier income year.
Subdivision 355‑G—Clawback of R&D recoupments
Table
of sections
355‑430 What this Subdivision is
about
355‑435 When extra income tax is
payable
355‑440 Entity receives government
recoupment
355‑445 Recoupment could relate to
R&D activities
355‑450 Amount on which extra
income tax is payable
355‑430 What this Subdivision is
about
An entity must pay
extra income tax on its recoupments from government of expenditure on R&D
activities for which it has obtained tax offsets under this Division.
355‑435 When extra income tax is
payable
An entity must pay
extra income tax on a *recoupment if the
conditions in sections 355‑440 and 355‑445 are met for the recoupment.
Note 1: Section 355‑450 sets out
how much of the recoupment is subject to extra income tax.
Note 2: A recoupment includes a grant
(see subsection 20‑25(1)).
355‑440 Entity receives government
recoupment
The condition in this
section is met if the entity receives or becomes entitled to receive the *recoupment from:
(a) an *Australian government agency; or
(b) an STB (within
the meaning of Division 1AB of Part III of the Income Tax
Assessment Act 1936);
otherwise than under the *CRC program.
355‑445 Recoupment could relate to
R&D activities
The
condition in this section is met if:
(a) the *recoupment is received, or the entitlement to receive the recoupment
arises, during an income year (the trigger year); and
(b) either:
(i) the
recoupment is of expenditure incurred on or in relation to certain activities;
or
(ii) the
recoupment requires expenditure (the project expenditure) to have
been incurred, or to be incurred, on certain activities.
Note: Paragraph (b) includes
expenditure incurred in purchasing a tangible depreciating asset to be used when
conducting R&D activities.
355‑450 Amount on which extra income
tax is payable
Amount on which extra income tax is
payable
(1) The extra income tax is
payable for the trigger year on an amount (the R&D expenditure)
equal to the sum of:
(a) so much of the
expenditure referred to in section 355‑445 that is deducted under this
Division; and
(b) for each asset
(if any) for which expenditure referred to in section 355‑445 is included
in the asset’s *cost—each amount (if any) equal to the
asset’s decline in value that is deducted under this Division;
in working out *tax
offsets under section 355‑100 obtained by the entity (the recipient),
or an entity mentioned in subsection (4), for one or more income years.
Note 1: Section 12B or 31 of the Income
Tax Rates Act 1986 sets the rate at which the entity must pay extra income
tax on this amount.
Note 2: Paragraphs (a) and (b) of
this subsection refer to amounts notionally deducted under this Division (see
section 355‑105).
Amount is reduced by any repayments of
the recoupment
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1),
reduce the expenditure referred to in subparagraph 355‑445(b)(i) by any
repayments of the *recoupment during an income year.
Cap on extra income tax if recoupment
relates to a project
(3) Despite subsection (1),
if the *recoupment is covered by subparagraph 355‑445(b)(ii),
the amount of extra income tax payable for the trigger year on the recoupment
cannot exceed the following amount:

where:
net amount of the recoupment means the total amount of the *recoupment,
less any repayments of the recoupment during an income year.
Related entities
(4) The other entities for
the purposes of subsection (1) are as follows:
(a) an entity *connected with the recipient;
(b) an *affiliate of the recipient or an entity of which the recipient is an
affiliate.
Subdivision 355‑H—Feedstock adjustments
Table of sections
355‑460 What this Subdivision is
about
355‑465 Feedstock adjustment to
assessable income
355‑470 Feedstock revenue
355‑475 Application to connected
entities and affiliates
355‑460 What this Subdivision is
about
An amount is included in an R&D entity’s assessable income if it
can deduct under this Division expenditure on goods, materials or energy used
during R&D activities to produce:
(a) marketable products; or
(b) products applied to the R&D entity’s own
use.
355‑465 Feedstock adjustment to
assessable income
(1) This section applies to
an *R&D entity for an income year (the present year)
if:
(a) it incurs
expenditure in one or more income years in acquiring or producing goods, or
materials, (the feedstock inputs) transformed or processed during
*R&D activities in producing one or more tangible products (the feedstock
outputs); and
(b) it obtains under
section 355‑100 *tax offsets for one or more
income years for deductions under this Division:
(i) for
the expenditure; or
(ii) for
expenditure it incurs on any energy input directly into the transformation or
processing; or
(iii) for
the decline in value of assets used in acquiring or producing the feedstock
inputs; and
(c) during the
present year, a feedstock output, or a transformed feedstock output, (the marketable
product) is:
(i) *supplied by the R&D entity to another entity; or
(ii) applied
by the R&D entity to the R&D entity’s own use, other than use for the
purpose of transforming that product for supply.
(2) The
*R&D entity’s assessable income for the present year includes an
amount equal to 1/3 of the lesser of:
(a) the
*feedstock revenue for the feedstock output; and
(b) so much of the
total of the amounts deducted as described in paragraph (1)(b) that is
reasonably attributable to the production of the feedstock output.
Note: This subsection applies
separately for each of the feedstock outputs.
(3) Subsection (2) does
not apply to the feedstock output if:
(a) it becomes, or is
transformed into, a feedstock input; or
(b) that subsection
already applies to the feedstock output because of the application of paragraph (1)(c)
to:
(i) an
earlier time during the present year; or
(ii) an
earlier income year.
355‑470 Feedstock revenue
The feedstock
revenue, for the feedstock output, is worked out as follows:

where:
market value of the marketable
product means the marketable product’s *market value at the time it is:
(a) *supplied by the *R&D entity to the
other entity; or
(b) first applied by
the R&D entity to the R&D entity’s own use, other than use for the
purpose of transforming that product for supply.
355‑475 Application to connected
entities and affiliates
This Subdivision
applies to a *supply or use of the marketable product
by:
(a) an entity *connected with the *R&D entity; or
(b) an
*affiliate of the R&D entity or an entity of which the R&D
entity is an affiliate;
as if it were by the R&D entity.
Subdivision 355‑I—Application to earlier income year R&D expenditure
incurred to associates
Table of sections
355‑480 Notional deductions for
expenditure incurred to associate in earlier income years
355‑480 Notional deductions for
expenditure incurred to associate in earlier income years
Notional deductions for earlier year
associate expenditure
(1) An *R&D entity can deduct for an income year (the present year)
expenditure it incurred to its *associate during an
earlier income year to the extent that:
(a) the expenditure
was incurred on one or more *R&D activities:
(i) for
which the R&D entity is registered under section 27A of the Industry
Research and Development Act 1986 for an income year; and
(ii) that
are activities to which section 355‑210 (conditions for R&D
activities) applies; and
(b) the expenditure
is paid to that associate during the present year; and
(c) subsection (2)
applies to the expenditure.
Note 1: This section applies in a
modified way to R&D partnership expenditure (see sections 355‑510 and
355‑515).
Note 2: Expenditure paid in income
years starting on or after 1 July 2011 may
be deductible for activities registered for income years starting before 1 July 2011 (see section 355‑200 of the Income
Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997).
Expenditure cannot have been otherwise
deducted etc.
(2) This
subsection applies to the expenditure if:
(a) the *R&D entity can deduct the expenditure, or is entitled to a *tax offset for the expenditure, under any other Division of this Act
for an earlier income year; and
(b) by the time of
lodging its *income tax return for the most recent
income year before the present year, the R&D entity had neither:
(i) deducted
the expenditure; nor
(ii) obtained
a tax offset for the expenditure;
as described in
paragraph (a).
(3) The entitlement to the
deduction, or *tax offset, described in paragraph (2)(a)
ceases to the extent that subsection (2) applies to the expenditure.
Example: If, by the time mentioned in paragraph (2)(b),
an R&D entity chose to deduct only a third of the expenditure it could have
deducted under another Division, then the remaining 2 thirds of that
expenditure:
(a) can be deducted under this section;
but
(b) can no longer be deducted under the
other Division.
Notional deduction is subject to
integrity rules etc.
(4) This section has effect
subject to section 355‑225 (excluded expenditure), Subdivision 355‑F
(integrity rules) and subsection 355‑580(3) (CRC contributions).
Subdivision 355‑J—Application to R&D partnerships
Table of sections
355‑500 What this Subdivision is
about
355‑505 Meaning of R&D
partnership and partner’s proportion
355‑510 R&D partnership
expenditure on R&D activities
355‑515 R&D activities
conducted by or for an R&D partnership
355‑520 When notional deductions
arise for decline in value of depreciating assets of R&D partnerships
355‑525 Balancing adjustments for
R&D partnership assets only used for R&D activities
355‑530 Implications for partner’s
aggregated turnover
355‑535 Disposal of R&D
results—assets of R&D partnerships
355‑540 Application of recoupment
rules
355‑545 Relevance for net income,
and losses, of the R&D partnership
355‑500 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision
modifies the rules in this Division for partners of R&D partnerships.
In particular, the
rules about deducting R&D expenditure are modified to allow a partner to
deduct the partner’s proportion of the R&D partnership’s expenditure on
R&D activities.
A partner of an
R&D partnership may also be able to deduct under this Subdivision the
decline in value of partnership assets used for R&D activities.
355‑505 Meaning of R&D
partnership and partner’s proportion
(1) A partnership is an R&D
partnership at a particular time if, at that time, each of the partners
is an *R&D entity.
(2) For an amount
attributable to an *R&D partnership for an income
year, each partner of the R&D partnership is taken to bear or be entitled
to (as appropriate) this proportion (the partner’s proportion) of
the amount:
(a) the proportion
the partners agreed the partner should bear or be entitled to (as appropriate);
or
(b) if there is no
such agreement—the proportion of the partner’s interest in the *net income or *partnership loss of the
R&D partnership for the income year.
355‑510 R&D partnership
expenditure on R&D activities
If an *R&D partnership incurs expenditure on one or more R&D
activities during an income year, this Division applies in relation to each *R&D entity that is a partner of the R&D partnership at some
time during the income year as if:
(a) the partner
incurred the partner’s proportion of that expenditure when the R&D
partnership incurred that expenditure; and
(b) neither the
R&D partnership, nor any other partner of the R&D partnership, incurred
expenditure during the income year on the R&D activities; and
(c) such other
changes were made to this Division as are appropriate having regard to that
partner’s proportion of amounts attributable to the R&D partnership.
Note: This section and section 355‑515
may result in:
(a) the partner being able to deduct the
partner’s proportion of the partnership expenditure under section 355‑205
(R&D expenditure) or 355‑480 (earlier year associate R&D expenditure)
for the R&D activities; and
(b) the partner being affected by the
integrity rules in Subdivisions 355‑F, 355‑G and 355‑H.
355‑515 R&D activities conducted
by or for an R&D partnership
If one or more *R&D activities are conducted by or for an *R&D partnership during an income year, this Division applies in
relation to each *R&D entity that is a partner of the
R&D partnership at some time during the income year as if:
(a) the R&D
activities were conducted by or for the partner in a corresponding way to the
way the R&D activities were conducted by or for the R&D partnership;
and
(b) the partner had
relationships with other entities in relation to the R&D activities that
corresponded to the relationships the R&D partnership had with those other
entities in relation to the R&D activities; and
(c) a thing done by,
or in relation to, the R&D partnership in relation to the R&D
activities were a thing done by, or in relation to, the partner; and
(d) the R&D
activities were neither:
(i) conducted
by or for the R&D partnership; nor
(ii) conducted
by or for any other partner of the R&D partnership; and
(e) such other
changes were made to this Division as are appropriate having regard to that
partner’s proportion of amounts attributable to the R&D partnership.
Note 1: For the purposes of this
Division, entities that are associates or affiliates of, or connected with, the
R&D partnership are taken to be associates or affiliates of, or connected
with, the partner (see paragraph (b)).
Note 2: For the purposes of this Division,
payments and agreements made by the R&D partnership for the R&D
activities are taken to be made by the partner (see paragraph (c)).
355‑520 When notional deductions
arise for decline in value of depreciating assets of R&D partnerships
When notional deductions arise
(1) If:
(a) an *R&D entity is a partner of an *R&D
partnership at some time during an income year (the present year);
and
(b) the partner is
registered under section 27A of the Industry Research and Development
Act 1986 for the present year for one or more *R&D
activities that are activities to which section 355‑210 (conditions for
R&D activities) applies; and
Note: Section 355‑210 applies
with changes for this paragraph (see section 355‑515).
(c) while a tangible *depreciating asset is *held by the R&D
partnership during the present year, the asset is used for the purpose of
conducting one or more of those R&D activities; and
(d) the R&D
partnership could deduct an amount under section 40‑25 for the asset for
the present year if Division 40 applied with the changes described in
section 355‑310; and
Note: Section 355‑310 applies
with changes for this paragraph (see subsection (2) of this section).
(e) the R&D
partnership cannot deduct an amount for the asset for:
(i) an
earlier income year under Subdivision 328‑D (capital allowances for small
business entities); or
(ii) an
earlier income year under Division 40 (as that Division applies apart from
this Division), in a case where section 40‑440 (low‑value pools) applied;
the partner can deduct the partner’s
proportion of the amount referred to in paragraph (d) for the present
year.
Changed application of Division 40
for this Subdivision
(2) For the purposes of this
Subdivision, section 355‑310 applies as if the following changes were made:
|
Changes
to be made
|
|
Item
|
For a
reference in section 355‑310 to...
|
substitute
a reference to...
|
|
1
|
paragraph 355‑305(1)(c)
|
paragraph 355‑520(1)(d)
|
|
2
|
section 355‑315
|
section 355‑525
|
|
3
|
paragraph 355‑305(1)(b)
|
paragraph 355‑520(1)(c)
|
|
4
|
*R&D entity
|
*R&D partnership
|
Disregard certain assets held because
of CRC contributions
(3) This section has effect
subject to subsection 355‑580(4) (CRC contributions).
355‑525 Balancing adjustments for
R&D partnership assets only used for R&D activities
(1) This section applies to
an *R&D entity (the partner) if:
(a) a *balancing adjustment event happens in an income year (the event
year) for an asset *held by an *R&D partnership; and
(b) the R&D
partnership cannot deduct an amount under section 40‑25, as that section
applies apart from:
(i) this
Division; and
(ii) former
section 73BC of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936;
for the asset
for an income year; and
(c) the partner is
entitled under section 355‑100 to *tax
offsets for one or more income years for deductions (the R&D
deductions) under section 355‑520 for the asset; and
(d) the partner is
registered under section 27A of the Industry Research and Development
Act 1986 for one or more *R&D activities for
the event year; and
(e) if Division 40
applied with the changes described in section 355‑310 (as affected by
subsection 355‑520(2)):
(i) the
R&D partnership could deduct for the event year an amount under subsection 40‑285(2)
for the asset and the balancing adjustment event; or
(ii) an
amount would be included in the R&D partnership’s assessable income for the
event year under subsection 40‑285(1) for the asset and the balancing
adjustment event.
Note 1: This section applies in a
modified way if the partner has deductions for the asset under former section 73BA
or 73BH of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 (see section 355‑325
of the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997).
Note 2: Section 40‑293 applies if
the R&D partnership can deduct an amount under section 40‑25, as that
section applies apart from this Division and former section 73BC of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936.
Notional deduction
(2) If the *R&D partnership could deduct for the event year an amount under
subsection 40‑285(2) for the asset and the event if Division 40
applied as described in paragraph (1)(e), the partner can deduct the
partner’s proportion of that amount for the event year.
Amount to be included in assessable
income
(3) If an amount (the section 40‑285
amount) would be included in the *R&D
partnership’s assessable income for the event year under subsection 40‑285(1)
for the asset and the event if Division 40 applied as described in paragraph (1)(e),
the partner’s proportion of the sum of:
(a) that amount; and
(b) the following
amount;
is included in the partner’s assessable
income for the event year:

where:
adjusted section 40‑285 amount means so much of the section 40‑285 amount as does not exceed
the total decline in value.
total decline in value means the asset’s *cost, less its *adjustable value, worked out under Division 40 as it applies as
described in paragraph (1)(e).
Amount to be included in assessable
income may be reduced if notional deductions exceeded $100 million
(4) For the purposes of subsection (3),
the partner may choose to reduce the adjusted section 40‑285 amount in
that subsection if:
(a) subsection 355‑100(3)
applied to the partner for an earlier income year or the event year (the excess
year); and
(b) the partner’s
deductions for the excess year included deductions covered by paragraph (1)(c)
of this section for the asset.
(5) Subsection 355‑720(3)
applies to the partner as if a reduction under subsection (2) of that
section for the present year included a reduction under subsection (4) of
this section for the event year.
(6) The way the partner
prepares its income tax returns is sufficient evidence of the making of a
choice under subsection (4).
(7) A choice under subsection (4)
is irrevocable.
355‑530 Implications for partner’s
aggregated turnover
For the purposes of sections 40‑292
(balancing adjustments for decline in value) and 355‑100 (tax offsets for
R&D), if:
(a) an *R&D entity is a partner of an *R&D
partnership at some time during an income year; and
(b) the partner’s *aggregated turnover for the income year does not include the R&D
partnership’s *annual turnover for the income year;
the partner’s aggregated turnover for the
income year includes the *partner’s proportion of
the R&D partnership’s annual turnover for the income year.
355‑535 Disposal of R&D results
for R&D partnerships
In addition to its
application apart from this section, section 355‑410 (disposal of R&D
results) also applies to each partner of an *R&D
partnership with such changes as are appropriate having regard to:
(a) amounts (the results
amounts) of a kind set out in subparagraphs 355‑410(1)(b)(i) to
(v) that the R&D partnership receives or becomes entitled to receive in an
income year; and
(b) the principle
that any amount to be included in the partner’s assessable income for the
income year for a results amount should be the partner’s proportion of the
amount arising under subsection 355‑410(2) for the results amount.
Note: The ordinary application of
section 355‑410 will apply to any of the partner’s deductions under this
Division that do not relate to the R&D partnership.
355‑540 Application of recoupment
rules
(1) If:
(a) an *R&D partnership incurs expenditure (the partnership
expenditure) on *R&D activities; and
(b) an *R&D entity (the partner) is entitled under section 355‑100
to a *tax offset because it can, under section 355‑205
or 355‑480, deduct some or all of that expenditure; and
(c) the R&D
partnership receives an amount as a *recoupment of any
or all of the partnership expenditure;
the partner is taken, for the purposes of
Subdivisions 20‑A and 355‑G:
(d) to have incurred
the partner’s proportion of the partnership expenditure when the R&D
partnership incurred that expenditure; and
(e) to have received
the partner’s proportion of the recoupment when the R&D partnership
received the recoupment.
(2) If:
(a) an *R&D entity (the partner) is entitled under section 355‑100
to a *tax offset because it can, under section 355‑520,
deduct an amount for an income year for an asset; and
(b) the applicable *R&D partnership receives an amount as a *recoupment
of any or all of the R&D partnership’s expenditure included in the *cost of the asset for the purposes of the application of Division 40
as described in paragraph 355‑520(1)(d);
the partner is taken, for the purposes of
Subdivisions 20‑A and 355‑G:
(c) to have incurred
the partner’s proportion of that expenditure when the R&D partnership
incurred that expenditure; and
(d) to have received
the partner’s proportion of the recoupment when the R&D partnership
received the recoupment.
355‑545 Relevance for net income,
and losses, of the R&D partnership
For an *R&D entity that is a partner of an *R&D
partnership, none of the following:
(a) any expenditure
the R&D entity is taken to have incurred because of this Subdivision;
(b) any amount the
R&D entity can deduct under this Subdivision;
(c) any *recoupment the R&D entity is taken to have received because of
this Subdivision;
are to be taken into account in
determining the *net income of the R&D partnership, or
any *partnership loss of the R&D
partnership, for an income year.
Subdivision 355‑K—Application to Cooperative Research Centres
Table of sections
355‑580 When notional deductions
for CRC contributions arise
355‑580 When notional deductions for
CRC contributions arise
Monetary contributions are deductible
(1) An *R&D entity can deduct for an income year expenditure it incurs
during that year to the extent that:
(a) the expenditure
is in the form of monetary contributions under the *CRC
program; and
(b) the
contributions have been or will be spent under the CRC program on one or more *R&D activities for which the R&D entity is registered under
section 27A of the Industry Research and Development Act 1986 for
an income year.
Note 1: The R&D activities will
need to be conducted during the income year the R&D entity is registered
for those activities (see sections 27A and 27J of the Industry Research
and Development Act 1986).
Note 2: Expenditure
incurred in income years starting on or after 1 July
2011 may be deductible for activities registered for income years
starting before 1 July 2011 (see section 355‑200
of the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997).
(2) Subsection (1)
does not apply to expenditure to the extent that it is incurred out of
Commonwealth funding.
No other deductions arise for monetary
contributions etc.
(3) Neither:
(a) a contribution an
*R&D entity can deduct under subsection (1); nor
(b) expenditure incurred
under the *CRC program, to the extent that the
expenditure is incurred out of:
(i) a
contribution an R&D entity can deduct under subsection (1); or
(ii) Commonwealth
funding;
can be deducted by any R&D entity
under any other provision of this Division for any income year.
(4) If an asset’s *cost includes expenditure incurred under the *CRC program out of:
(a) a contribution an
*R&D entity can deduct under subsection (1); or
(b) Commonwealth
funding;
an amount equal to the asset’s decline in
value cannot be deducted under this Division by any R&D entity for any
income year.
Subdivision 355‑W—Other matters
Table
of sections
355‑705 Effect of findings by
Innovation Australia
355‑710 Amendment of assessments
355‑715 Implications for other
deductions and tax offsets
355‑720 Certain related amounts
may be reduced if notional deductions exceeded $100 million
355‑750 Review of rate when notional
deductions exceed $100 million
355‑705 Effect of findings by
Innovation Australia
Findings about registration or core
technology
(1) If:
(a) a
certificate given to the Commissioner under the Industry Research and
Development Act 1986 sets out:
(i) a
finding under section 27B of that Act about an *R&D
entity’s application for registration under section 27A of that Act for an
income year; or
(ii) a
finding under section 27J of that Act about an R&D entity’s
registration under section 27A of that Act for an income year; or
(iii) a
finding under section 28E of that Act about an R&D entity and one or
more *R&D activities conducted or to be
conducted during one or more income years; and
(b) the finding was
made within 4 years after the end of the income year or the last of the income
years (as appropriate);
the finding binds the Commissioner for
the purposes of assessments of the R&D entity for the income year or years
(as appropriate).
Note: Section 28E
of the Industry Research and Development Act 1986 deals with findings
that technology is core technology for particular R&D activities.
Expenditure incurred in acquiring such technology is not deductible under this
Division (see subsection 355‑225(2)).
Advance findings about activities yet
to be completed
(2) If:
(a) an activity is
being conducted, or is yet to be conducted, in an income year; and
(b) an *R&D entity applies in the income year for a finding under
section 28A of the Industry Research and Development Act 1986 about
the activity; and
(c) Innovation
Australia makes the finding and gives the Commissioner a certificate under that
Act setting out the finding;
the finding binds the Commissioner for
the purposes of assessments of the R&D entity for the income year and the
next 2 income years.
Advance findings about completed
activities
(3) However, if:
(a) an activity is
completed during an income year; and
(b) an *R&D entity applies in the income year for a finding under
section 28A of the Industry Research and Development Act 1986 about
the activity; and
(c) Innovation
Australia makes the finding and gives the Commissioner a certificate under that
Act setting out the finding;
the finding binds the Commissioner for
the purposes of assessments of the R&D entity for the income year.
355‑710 Amendment of assessments
Dealing with findings of Innovation
Australia
(1) If:
(a) a
certificate given to the Commissioner under the Industry Research and
Development Act 1986 sets out:
(i) a
finding under section 27B of that Act about an *R&D
entity’s application for registration under section 27A of that Act for an
income year; or
(ii) a
finding under section 27J of that Act about an R&D entity’s
registration under section 27A of that Act for an income year; or
(iii) a
finding under section 28A or 28C of that Act made on application by an
R&D entity during an income year; or
(iv) a
finding under section 28E of that Act about an R&D entity and one or
more R&D activities conducted or to be conducted during one or more income
years; and
(b) the finding was
made within 4 years after the end of the income year or the last of the income
years (as appropriate);
despite section 170 of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936, the Commissioner may amend the R&D entity’s
assessment for an income year affected by the finding at any time for the
purposes of giving effect to the finding.
(2) However, the
Commissioner may only do so within 2 years after the Commissioner is given the
certificate if giving effect to the finding would increase the R&D entity’s
liability.
Dealing with key decisions of
Innovation Australia and others
(3) If:
(a) an internal
review decision (the key decision) under subsection 30D(2)
of the Industry Research and Development Act 1986 relates to an *R&D entity; or
(b) a decision (also
the key decision) under the Administrative Appeals Tribunal
Act 1975:
(i) varies
a decision covered by paragraph (a); or
(ii) sets
aside a decision covered by paragraph (a), whether or not that key
decision also includes a decision made in substitution for the decision covered
by paragraph (a); or
(c) a decision (also
the key decision) of a court is about:
(i) a
decision under Part III of the Industry Research and Development Act
1986 relating to an R&D entity; or
(ii) a
decision covered by paragraph (b);
despite section 170 of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936, the Commissioner may amend the R&D entity’s
assessment for an income year affected by the key decision at any time for the
purposes of giving effect to that decision.
355‑715 Implications for other
deductions and tax offsets
(1) If an *R&D entity is entitled under section 355‑100 to a *tax offset for an income year for expenditure it can deduct under
section 355‑205, 355‑480 or 355‑580, that expenditure:
(a) cannot be taken
into account by any entity in working out a deduction under any other Division
of this Act for any income year; and
(b) cannot be taken
into account by any entity in working out a tax offset under any other Division
of this Act for any income year.
Note: Section 355‑205 is about
R&D expenditure, section 355‑480 is about earlier year associate
R&D expenditure, and section 355‑580 is about CRC contributions.
(2) If
an *R&D entity is entitled under section 355‑100 to a *tax offset for an income year for a deduction under section 355‑305,
355‑315, 355‑520 or 355‑525 of an amount equal to the decline in value of an
asset, that decline in value:
(a) cannot be taken
into account by any entity in working out a deduction under any other Division
of this Act (other than section 40‑292 or 40‑293) for any income year; and
(b) cannot be taken
into account by any entity in working out a tax offset under any other Division
of this Act for any income year;
to the extent that the decline in value
is attributable to the use of the asset for the purpose of conducting one or
more of the *R&D activities to which the deduction
relates.
Note 1: A deduction may be available
under section 40‑25 to the extent that the asset’s decline in value is
attributable to another purpose. If so, that deduction under section 40‑25
will not take into account the asset’s decline in value to the extent that it
is attributable to the R&D activities (see also subsection 40‑25(2)).
Note 2: Section 355‑305 is about
the decline in value of R&D assets, section 355‑315 is about balancing
adjustments for R&D assets, section 355‑520 is about the decline in
value of R&D partnership assets, and section 355‑525 is about
balancing adjustments for R&D partnership assets.
Note 3: Sections 40‑292 and 40‑293
deal with balancing adjustments when deductions have been available for the
asset’s decline in value both under this Division and section 40‑25.
355‑720 Certain related amounts may
be reduced if notional deductions exceeded $100 million
(1) The object of this
section is to prevent the portion of a *tax
offset worked out using the *corporate tax rate being
clawed back in later income years.
Note: This applies when the R&D
entity’s notional deductions exceed $100 million (see subsection 355‑100(3)).
(2) For the purposes of
working out a matter referred to in column 1 of an item of this table for an
income year (the present year), the *R&D
entity may choose to reduce the amount referred to in column 3 of that item if:
(a) subsection 355‑100(3)
applied to the R&D entity for an earlier income year or the present year
(the excess year); and
(b) the R&D entity’s
deductions for the excess year included deductions covered by a provision
referred to in column 2 of that item.
|
Reducing extra income tax or amounts
included in assessable income
|
|
Item
|
Column 1
For the purposes of working out this
matter:
|
Column 2
If its excess year deductions
included those covered by:
|
Column 3
This can be reduced:
|
|
1
|
any amount to include in the *R&D entity’s assessable income for the present year because of
a *balancing adjustment event happening for
an asset it *held
|
(a) paragraph 40‑292(1)(b); or
(b) paragraph 355‑315(1)(c);
for the asset
|
its adjusted section 40‑285 amount
(see subsection 40‑292(5) or 355‑315(3)) for the present year, the asset
and the *balancing adjustment event
|
|
2
|
any amount of extra income tax payable by
the *R&D entity under section 355‑435
for the present year
|
subsection 355‑450(1)
|
those excess year deductions
|
|
3
|
any amount to include in the *R&D entity’s assessable income for the present year under
section 355‑465
|
paragraph 355‑465(1)(b)
|
those excess year deductions
|
Note 1: Item 2 is about R&D
recoupments and item 3 is about feedstock adjustments.
Note 2: Reducing the amount in column
3 will reduce the amount in column 1.
(3) The *R&D entity’s circumstances may allow it to choose multiple
reductions under subsection (2) for the present year. The total of any
reductions cannot be more than the amount of its excess under subsection 355‑100(3)
for the excess year.
(4) The way an *R&D entity prepares its income tax returns is sufficient
evidence of the making of a choice under this section.
(5) A choice under this
section is irrevocable.
355‑750 Review of rate when notional
deductions exceed $100 million
(1) The Minister must cause
a review of the operation of subsection 355‑100(3) (about the rate of tax
offset when notional deductions exceed $100 million) to be undertaken as soon
as possible after the fifth anniversary of the commencement of that subsection.
(2) The Minister must cause
a copy of the report of the review to be tabled in each House of the Parliament
within 15 sitting days of receiving it.
Division 376—Films generally (tax offsets for Australian
production expenditure)
Table of Subdivisions
376‑A Guide to Division 376
376‑B Tax offsets for Australian
expenditure in making a film
376‑C Production expenditure and
qualifying Australian production expenditure
376‑D Certificates for films and
other matters
Subdivision 376‑A—Guide to Division 376
376‑1 What this Division is about
Companies may be
entitled to 1 of 3 refundable tax offsets in relation to Australian expenditure
incurred in making films. The offsets are designed to support and develop the
Australian screen media industry by providing concessional tax treatment for
Australian expenditure.
Table of sections
376‑2 Key features of the tax
offsets for Australian production expenditure on films
376‑5 Structure of this
Division
376‑2 Key features of the tax
offsets for Australian production expenditure on films
(1) The 3 tax offsets are:
(a) a refundable tax
offset for Australian expenditure in making an Australian film (the producer
offset); and
(b) a refundable tax
offset for Australian expenditure in making any film (the location offset); and
(c) a refundable tax
offset for Australian expenditure on post, digital and visual effects
production for any film (the PDV offset).
(2) A company is only
entitled to one of these offsets in relation to a film.
(3) The amount of the offset
is determined as a percentage of certain Australian expenditure incurred by a
company in producing the film:
(a) the amount of the
producer offset is 40% of the company’s qualifying Australian production
expenditure on the film if the film is a feature film, and 20% of such
expenditure if the film is not a feature film; and
(b) the amount of the
location offset is 16.5% of the company’s qualifying Australian production
expenditure on the film; and
(c) the amount of the
PDV offset is 30% of the company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure
on the film that relates to post, digital and visual effects production for the
film.
(4) One of the requirements
for entitlement to these offsets is that a company must be issued with a
certificate for the film. The certificate will state the amount of Australian
expenditure on which the offset will be determined.
(5) The offset is claimed by
a company in its income tax return.
376‑5 Structure of this Division
(1) Subdivision 376‑B
tells you about the different tax offsets available for films, who can get each
offset and what conditions must be met to get each offset. It also tells you
how to work out the amount of each offset.
(2) Subdivision 376‑C
explains what is meant by:
(a) production
expenditure on a film; and
(b) qualifying
Australian production expenditure on a film.
It also contains some rules for
quantifying expenditure.
(3) Subdivision 376‑D
deals with a number of administrative matters:
(a) applying for a
certificate for a film; and
(b) the issue and revocation
of a certificate for a film; and
(c) the making of
rules by the Arts Minister (including rules for the establishment of the Film
Certification Advisory Board) and the film authority; and
(d) review of
decisions of the Arts Minister and the film authority; and
(e) amendment of
assessments following the revocation of a certificate for a film.
Subdivision 376‑B—Tax offsets for Australian expenditure in making a film
Table of sections
Refundable tax offset for
Australian expenditure in making a film (location offset)
376‑10 Film production company
entitled to refundable tax offset for Australian expenditure in making a film
(location offset)
376‑15 Amount of the location
offset
376‑20 Minister must issue
certificate for a film for the location offset
376‑25 Meaning of documentary
376‑30 Minister to determine a
company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure for the location offset
Refundable tax offset for post,
digital and visual effects production for a film (PDV offset)
376‑35 Film production company
entitled to refundable tax offset for post, digital and visual effects
production for a film (PDV offset)
376‑40 Amount of the PDV offset
376‑45 Minister must issue
certificate for a film for the PDV offset
376‑50 Minister to determine a
company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure for the PDV offset
Refundable
tax offset for Australian expenditure in making an Australian film (producer
offset)
376‑55 Film production company
entitled to refundable tax offset for Australian expenditure in making an
Australian film (producer offset)
376‑60 Amount of the producer
offset
376‑65 Film authority must issue
certificate for an Australian film for the producer offset
376‑70 Determination of content
of film
376‑75 Film authority to
determine a company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure for the
producer offset
Refundable tax
offset for Australian expenditure in making a film (location offset)
376‑10 Film production company
entitled to refundable tax offset for Australian expenditure in making a film
(location offset)
(1) A company is entitled to
a *tax offset under this section (the location offset)
for an income year in respect of a *film if:
(b) the company’s *qualifying Australian production expenditure on the film ceased
being incurred in the income year; and
(c) the Arts Minister
has issued a certificate to the company for the film under section 376‑20
(certificate for the location offset); and
(d) the company
claims the offset in its *income tax return for
the income year; and
(e) the company:
(i) is an
Australian resident; or
(ii) is a
foreign resident but does have a *permanent establishment
in Australia and does have an *ABN;
when the
company lodges the income tax return and when the tax offset is due to be
credited to the company.
The claim referred to in paragraph (d)
is irrevocable.
Note: The location offset is a
refundable tax offset: see section 67‑23.
(2) The company is not
entitled to the location offset if:
(a) the company or
someone else claims a deduction in relation to a unit of industrial property
that relates to copyright in the *film under former
Division 10B of Part III of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936;
or
(b) a final
certificate for the film has been issued at any time under former Division 10BA
of Part III of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 (whether or not
the certificate is still in force); or
(c) a certificate for
the film has been issued at any time under section 376‑45 (certificate for
the PDV offset) (whether or not the certificate is still in force); or
(d) a certificate for
the film has been issued at any time under section376‑65 (certificate for the
producer offset) (whether or not the certificate is still in force).
376‑15 Amount of the location offset
The amount of the
location offset is 16.5% of the total of the company’s *qualifying
Australian production expenditure on the *film
(as determined by the *Arts Minister under
section 376‑30).
376‑20 Minister must issue
certificate for a film for the location offset
(1) The *Arts Minister must issue a certificate to a company for a *film in relation to the location offset if the Minister is satisfied
that the conditions in subsections (2), (3) and (5) are met.
Type of film
(2) The conditions in this
subsection are that:
(a) the *film was produced for:
(i) exhibition
to the public in cinemas or by way of television broadcasting (including
broadcasting by way of the delivery of a television program by a broadcasting
service within the meaning of the Broadcasting Services Act 1992); or
(ii) distribution
to the public as a video recording (whether on video tapes, digital video disks
or otherwise); and
(b) the film is:
(i) a *feature film or a film of a like nature; or
(ii) a
mini‑series of television drama; or
(iii) a
television series that is not covered by subparagraph (i) or (ii); and
(c) the film is not,
or is not to a substantial extent:
(i) if
the film is covered by subparagraph (b)(i) or (ii)—a *documentary; or
(ii) a
film for exhibition as an advertising program or a commercial; or
(iii) a
film for exhibition as a discussion program, a quiz program, game show, a panel
program, a variety program or a program of a like nature; or
(iv) a film
of a public event; or
(v) if the
film is covered by subparagraph (b)(i) or (ii)—a film forming part of a
drama program series that is, or is intended to be, of a continuing nature; or
(vi) a
training film; or
(vii) a
computer game (within the meaning of the Classification (Publications, Films
and Computer Games) Act 1995).
Television series
(3) The conditions in this
subsection are that:
(a) if the *film is a television series that is not covered by subparagraph (2)(b)(i)
or (ii), it is made up of 2 or more episodes that:
(i) are
produced wholly or principally for exhibition to the public on television under
a single title; and
(ii) contain
a common theme or themes; and
(iii) contain
dramatic elements that form a narrative structure; and
(iv) are
produced wholly or principally for exhibition together, for a national
market or national markets; and
Note: A documentary can be a
television series.
(b) if the film is a
television series that is not covered by subparagraph (2)(b)(i) or (ii):
(i) for a
television series that is predominantly a digital animation or other
animation—the *making of the television series (other
than a pilot episode, if any, or activities mentioned in paragraph 376‑125(3)(a))
takes place within a period of not longer than 36 months; or
(ii) otherwise—all
principal photography for the television series (other than a pilot episode, if
any) takes place within a period of not longer than 12 months; and
(c) if the film is a
television series that is not covered by subparagraph (2)(b)(i) or
(ii)—the amount worked out for the film under subsection (6) is at least
$1 million.
(4) To avoid doubt, and
without limiting subparagraph (3)(a)(iii), a *film
satisfies the requirement in that subparagraph if:
(a) the sole or
dominant purpose of the film is to depict actual events, people or situations;
and
(b) the film depicts
those events, people or situations in a dramatic or entertaining way, with a
heavy emphasis on dramatic impact or entertainment value.
Conditions relating to expenditure
thresholds
(5) The conditions in this
subsection are that:
(a) the total of the
company’s *qualifying Australian production
expenditure on the *film (as determined by the *Arts Minister under section 376‑30) is at least $15 million;
and
(c) the company
either carried out, or made the arrangements for the carrying out of, all the
activities in Australia that were necessary for the making of the film.
Note: The operation of paragraph (c)
is affected by paragraph 376‑180(1)(d) (which deals with the situation
where one company takes over the making of a film from another company).
(6) For the purposes of paragraph (3)(c),
the amount for a *film is worked out by using the formula:

where:
duration of film in hours means the total length of the *film,
measured in hours.
total QAPE means the total of the company’s *qualifying
Australian production expenditure on the *film
(as determined by the *Arts Minister under
section 376‑30).
376‑25 Meaning of documentary
Meaning of documentary
(1) A *film is a documentary if the film is a creative
treatment of actuality, having regard to:
(a) the extent and
purpose of any contrived situation featured in the film; and
(b) the extent to
which the film explores an idea or a theme; and
(c) the extent to
which the film has an overall narrative structure; and
(d) any other
relevant matters.
Exclusion of infotainment or lifestyle
programs and magazine programs
(2) However, a *film is not a documentary if it is:
(a) an infotainment
or lifestyle program (within the meaning of Schedule 6 to the Broadcasting
Services Act 1992); or
(b) a film that:
(i) presents
factual information; and
(ii) has 2
or more discrete parts, each dealing with a different subject or a different
aspect of the same subject; and
(iii) does
not contain an over‑arching narrative structure or thesis.
376‑30 Minister to determine a
company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure for the location offset
(1) If a company applies to
the *Arts Minister for the issue of a
certificate to the company for a *film under section 376‑20
(certificate for the location offset), the Arts Minister must, as soon as
practicable after receiving the application, determine in writing the total of
the company’s *qualifying Australian production
expenditure on the film for the purposes of the location offset.
(2) In making a
determination under subsection (1), the *Arts
Minister must have regard to the matters in Subdivision 376‑C.
(3) The *Arts Minister must give the company written notice of the
determination.
(4) A determination made
under subsection (1) is not a legislative instrument.
Refundable tax
offset for post, digital and visual effects production for a film (PDV offset)
376‑35 Film production company
entitled to refundable tax offset for post, digital and visual effects
production for a film (PDV offset)
(1) A company is entitled to
a *tax offset under this section (the PDV offset) for an
income year in respect of a *film if:
(a) the company’s *qualifying Australian production expenditure on the film, to the
extent that it relates to *post, digital and visual
effects production for the film, ceased being incurred in the income year; and
(b) the *Arts Minister has issued a certificate to the company for the post,
digital and visual effects production for the film under section 376‑45
(certificate for the PDV offset); and
(c) the company
claims the offset in its *income tax return for
the income year; and
(d) the company:
(i) is an
Australian resident; or
(ii) is a
foreign resident but does have a *permanent establishment
in Australia and does have an *ABN;
when the
company lodges the income tax return and when the tax offset is due to be
credited to the company.
The claim referred to in paragraph (c)
is irrevocable.
Note: The PDV offset is a
refundable tax offset: see section 67‑23.
(2) Post, digital and
visual effects production for a *film
means:
(a) the creation of
audio or visual elements (other than principal photography, pick ups or the
creation of physical elements such as sets, props or costumes) for the film;
and
(b) the manipulation
of audio or visual elements (other than pick ups or physical elements such as
sets, props or costumes) for the film; and
(c) activities that
are necessarily related to the activities mentioned in paragraph (a) or
(b).
Note: 3D animation, digital
compositing and music composition and recording are examples of post, digital
and visual effects production.
(3) The company is not
entitled to the PDV offset if:
(a) the company or
someone else claims a deduction in relation to a unit of industrial property
that relates to copyright in the *film under former
Division 10B of Part III of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936;
or
(b) a final
certificate for the film has been issued at any time under former Division 10BA
of Part III of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 (whether or not
the certificate is still in force); or
(c) a certificate for
the film has been issued at any time under section 376‑20 (certificate for
the location offset) (whether or not the certificate is still in force); or
(d) a certificate for
the film has been issued at any time under section 376‑65 (certificate for
the producer offset) (whether or not the certificate is still in force).
376‑40 Amount of the PDV offset
The amount of the PDV
offset is 30% of the total of the company’s *qualifying
Australian production expenditure (as determined by the *Arts Minister under section 376‑50) on a *film, to the extent that it relates to *post,
digital and visual effects production for the film.
376‑45 Minister must issue
certificate for a film for the PDV offset
(1) The *Arts Minister must issue a certificate to a company for the *post, digital and visual effects production for a *film in relation to the PDV offset if the Minister is satisfied that
the conditions in subsections (2), (3) and (5) are met.
Type of film
(2) The conditions in this
subsection are that:
(a) the *film was produced for:
(i) exhibition
to the public in cinemas or by way of television broadcasting (including
broadcasting by way of the delivery of a television program by a broadcasting
service within the meaning of the Broadcasting Services Act 1992); or
(ii) distribution
to the public as a video recording (whether on video tapes, digital video disks
or otherwise); and
(b) the film is:
(i) a *feature film or a film of a like nature; or
(ii) a
mini‑series of television drama; or
(iii) a
television series that is not covered by subparagraph (i) or (ii); and
(c) the
film is not, or is not to a substantial extent:
(i) if
the film is covered by subparagraph (b)(i) or (ii)—a *documentary; or
(ii) a
film for exhibition as an advertising program or a commercial; or
(iii) a
film for exhibition as a discussion program, a quiz program, game show, a panel
program, a variety program or a program of a like nature; or
(iv) a film
of a public event; or
(v) if the
film is covered by subparagraph (b)(i) or (ii)—a film forming part of a
drama program series that is, or is intended to be, of a continuing nature; or
(vi) a
training film; or
(vii) a
computer game (within the meaning of the Classification (Publications, Films
and Computer Games) Act 1995).
Television series
(3) The condition in this
subsection is that, if the *film is a television
series that is not covered by subparagraph (2)(b)(i) or (ii), it is made
up of 2 or more episodes that:
(a) are produced wholly or principally for exhibition to the public
on television under a single title; and
(b) contain a common
theme or themes; and
(c) contain dramatic
elements that form a narrative structure; and
(d) are produced
wholly or principally for exhibition together, for a
national market or national markets.
Note: A documentary can be a
television series.
(4) To avoid doubt, and
without limiting paragraph (3)(c), a *film
satisfies the requirement in that paragraph if:
(a) the sole or
dominant purpose of the film is to depict actual events, people or situations;
and
(b) the film depicts
those events, people or situations in a dramatic or entertaining way, with a
heavy emphasis on dramatic impact or entertainment value.
Conditions
relating to expenditure thresholds
(5) The conditions of this
subsection are that:
(a) the total of the
company’s *qualifying Australian production
expenditure on the *film (as determined by the *Arts Minister under section 376‑50), to the extent that it
relates to *post, digital and visual effects
production for the film, is at least $500,000; and
(b) the company
either carried out, or made the arrangements for the carrying out of, all the
activities in Australia that were necessary for the post, digital and visual
effects production for the film.
Note: The operation of paragraph (b)
is affected by paragraph 376‑180(1)(d) (which deals with the situation
where one company takes over the making of a film from another company).
376‑50 Minister to determine a
company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure for the PDV offset
(1) If a company applies to
the *Arts Minister for the issue of a
certificate to the company for the *post, digital and
visual effects production for a *film under section 376‑45
(certificate for the PDV offset), the Arts Minister must, as soon as
practicable after receiving the application, determine in writing the total of
the company’s *qualifying Australian production
expenditure, to the extent that it relates to post, digital and visual effects
production for the film, for the purposes of the PDV offset.
(2) In making a
determination under subsection (1), the *Arts
Minister must have regard to the matters in Subdivision 376‑C.
(3) The *Arts Minister must give the company written notice of the determination.
(4) A determination made
under subsection (1) is not a legislative instrument.
Refundable tax
offset for Australian expenditure in making an Australian film (producer
offset)
376‑55 Film production company
entitled to refundable tax offset for Australian expenditure in making an
Australian film (producer offset)
(1) A company is entitled to
a *tax offset under this section (the producer offset)
for an income year in respect of a *film if:
(a) the film was *completed in the income year; and
(b) the *film authority has issued a certificate to the company under section 376‑65
(certificate for the producer offset) for the film; and
(c) the company
claims the offset in its *income tax return for
the income year; and
(d) the company:
(i) is an
Australian resident; or
(ii) is a
foreign resident but does have a *permanent establishment
in Australia and does have an *ABN;
when the
company lodges the income tax return and when the tax offset is due to be
credited to the company.
The claim referred to in paragraph (c)
is irrevocable.
Note: The producer offset is a
refundable tax offset: see section 67‑23.
(2) A *film is completed:
(a) for a film that
is not a series or a season of a series—when it is first in a state where it
could reasonably be regarded as ready to be distributed, broadcast or exhibited
to the general public; or
(b) for a series—at
the earlier of:
(i) the
time when the episode in which the 65th commercial hour is reached is first in
a state where it could reasonably be regarded as ready to be distributed,
broadcast or exhibited to the general public; and
(ii) the
time when the series is first in such a state; and
(c) for
a season of a series—at the earlier of:
(i) the
time when the episode in which the 65th commercial hour is reached is first in
a state where it could reasonably be regarded as ready to be distributed,
broadcast or exhibited to the general public; and
(ii) the
time when the season is first in such a state.
(3) Film authority
means Screen Australia.
(4) The company is not
entitled to the producer offset if:
(a) the company or
someone else claims a deduction in relation to a unit of industrial property
that relates to copyright in the *film under former
Division 10B of Part III of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936;
or
(b) a final
certificate for the film has been issued at any time under former Division 10BA
of Part III of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 (whether or not
the certificate is still in force); or
(c) a certificate for
the film has been issued at any time under section 376‑20 (certificate for
the location offset) (whether or not the certificate is still in force); or
(d) a certificate for
the film has been issued at any time under section 376‑45 (certificate for
the PDV offset) (whether or not the certificate is still in force); or
(f) production
assistance (other than *development assistance)
for the film has been received by the company or anyone else before 1 July
2007 from any of the following bodies:
(i) the
Film Finance Corporation Australia Limited;
(ii) Film
Australia Limited;
(iii) the
Australian Film Commission;
(iv) the
Australian Film, Television and Radio School; or
(g) the *film authority’s Producer Equity Program has provided financial
assistance to the company or anyone else for the making of the film.
(5) Development
assistance for a *film means financial
assistance provided to assist with meeting the development costs for the film,
and includes assistance to the extent to which it is provided in relation to
any of the following:
(a) location surveys
and other activities undertaken to assess locations for possible use in the
film;
(b) storyboarding for
the film;
(c) scriptwriting for
the film;
(d) research for the
film;
(e) casting
actors for the film;
(f) developing
a budget for the film;
(g) developing a
shooting schedule for the film.
376‑60 Amount of the producer offset
The
amount of the producer offset is:
(a) if the *film is a *feature film—40%; or
(b) if the film is
not a feature film—20%;
of the total of the company’s *qualifying Australian production expenditure on the film (as
determined by the *film authority under section 376‑75).
376‑65 Film authority must issue
certificate for an Australian film for the producer offset
(1) The *film authority must issue a certificate to a company for a *film in relation to the producer offset if the film authority is
satisfied that:
(a) the company
either carried out, or made the arrangements for the carrying out of, all the
activities that were necessary for the *making
of the film; and
(b) the conditions in
subsections (2) to (6) are met.
Note: The operation of paragraph (a)
is affected by paragraph 376‑180(1)(d) (which deals with the situation
where one company takes over the making of a film from another company).
Type of film
(2) The
conditions in this subsection are that:
(a) the
*film:
(i) has a
significant Australian content (see section 376‑70); or
(ii) has
been made under an *arrangement entered into between
the Commonwealth or an authority of the Commonwealth and a foreign country or
an authority of the foreign country; and
(b) the
film was produced for:
(i) exhibition
to the public in cinemas or by way of television broadcasting (including
broadcasting by way of the delivery of a television program by a broadcasting
service within the meaning of the Broadcasting Services Act 1992); or
(ii) distribution
to the public as a video recording (whether on video tapes, digital video disks
or otherwise); and
(c) the film is:
(i) a *feature film; or
(ii) a
single episode program; or
(iii) a
series; or
(iv) a
season of a series; or
(v) a
short form animated film that is not covered by subparagraph (i), (ii),
(iii) or (iv); and
(d) the film is not,
or is not to a substantial extent:
(i) a
film for exhibition as an advertising program or a commercial; or
(ii) a
film for exhibition as a discussion program, a quiz program, game show, a panel
program, a variety program or a program of a like nature; or
(iii) a
film of a public event (other than a *documentary); or
(iv) a
training film; or
(v) a
computer game (within the meaning of the Classification (Publications, Films
and Computer Games) Act 1995); or
(vi) a news
or current affairs program; or
(vii) a
reality program (other than a documentary).
Single episode programs
(3) The conditions in this
subsection are that, if the *film is a single episode
program, it:
(a) is of a like
nature to a *feature film; and
(b) is
produced for:
(i) exhibition
to the public by way of television broadcasting (including broadcasting by way
of the delivery of a television program by a broadcasting service within the
meaning of the Broadcasting Services Act 1992); or
(ii) distribution
to the public as a video recording (whether on video tapes, digital video disks
or otherwise); and
(c) if the program is
a *documentary—is of at least one half of a commercial hour in
duration; and
(d) if the program is
not a documentary—is of at least one commercial hour in duration.
Short form animated film
(4) The conditions in this
subsection are that, if the *film is a short form
animated film, it:
(a) is a program
comprising one or more episodes which are produced wholly or principally for
exhibition together, for a national market or national markets under a single
title; and
(b) is predominantly
made using cell, stop motion, digital or other animation; and
(c) contains a common
theme or themes; and
(d) is of at least
one quarter of a commercial hour in duration.
Series and seasons of series
(5) The conditions in this
subsection are that:
(a) if the
application for the certificate is for a *film
that is a series and not for a film that is a season of that series:
(i) the
series is made up of at least 2 episodes; and
(ii) each
episode of the series is at least one half of a commercial hour in duration,
except where the film is predominantly made using cell, stop motion, digital or
other animation, in which case each episode is at least one quarter of a
commercial hour in duration; and
(iii) the
series has a new creative concept (see section 376‑70); and
(b) if the
application for the certificate is for a film that is a season of a series:
(i) the
season is made up of at least 2 episodes; and
(ii) each
episode of the series is at least one half of a commercial hour in duration,
except where the film is predominantly made using cell, stop motion, digital or
other animation, in which case each episode is at least one quarter of a
commercial hour in duration; and
(iii) the
series has a new creative concept (see section 376‑70).
Expenditure thresholds
(6) The conditions in this
subsection are as set out in the table.
|
Expenditure
thresholds
|
|
Item
|
For
this type of film ...
|
The
total of the company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure on the
film (as determined by the film authority under section 376‑75) is at
least ...
|
and
the amount for the film worked out under subsection (7) is at least ...
|
|
1
|
A *feature film
|
$500,000
|
not applicable
|
|
2
|
A single episode program other than a *documentary
|
$500,000
|
not applicable
|
|
3
|
A single episode program that is a *documentary
|
$500,000
|
$250,000
|
|
4
|
A short form animated film that is not a *feature film, a single episode program, a series or a season of a series
|
$250,000
|
$1,000,000
|
|
5
|
A *film where the application for the certificate is for a series and
not for a season of that series, and the series is not a *documentary
|
$1 million
|
$500,000
|
|
6
|
A *film where the application for the certificate is for a series and
not for a season of that series, and the series is a *documentary
|
$500,000
|
$250,000
|
|
7
|
A* film where the application for the certificate is for a season of
a series, and the series is not a *documentary
|
$1 million
|
$500,000
|
|
8
|
A *film where the application for the certificate is for a season of
a series, and the series is a *documentary
|
$500,000
|
$250,000
|
(7) The
amount worked out for a *film under this
subsection is the amount worked out using the formula:

where:
duration of film in hours means the total length of the *film,
measured in hours.
total QAPE means the total of the company’s *qualifying
Australian production expenditure on the *film
(as determined by the *film authority under
section 376‑75).
376‑70 Determination of content of
film
(1) In
determining for the purposes of section 376‑65 (certificate for the
producer offset) whether a *film has a significant
Australian content, the *film authority must have
regard to the following:
(a) the
subject matter of the film;
(b) the
place where the film was made;
(c) the nationalities
and places of residence of the persons who took part in the *making of the film;
(d) the details of
the *production expenditure incurred in respect
of the film;
(e) any other matters
that the film authority considers to be relevant.
(2) In determining for the
purposes of section 376‑65 (certificate for the producer offset) whether a
*film that is a series has a new creative concept, the *film authority must have regard to the following:
(a) the title of the
series;
(b) whether the
series has substantially different characters, settings, production locations
and individuals involved in the *making of the series
than any other series;
(c) any other matters
that the film authority considers to be relevant.
376‑75 Film authority to determine a
company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure for the producer offset
(1) If a company applies to
the *film authority for the issue of a
certificate to the company for a *film under section 376‑65
(certificate for the producer offset), the film authority must, as soon as
practicable after receiving the application, determine in writing the total of
the company’s *qualifying Australian production expenditure
on the film for the purposes of the producer offset.
(2) In making a
determination under subsection (1), the *film
authority must have regard to the matters in Subdivision 376‑C.
(3) The *film authority must give the company written notice of the determination.
(4) A determination made
under subsection (1) is not a legislative instrument.
Subdivision 376‑C—Production expenditure and qualifying
Australian production expenditure
Table of sections
Production expenditure—common
rules
376‑125 Production expenditure—general
test
376‑130 Production
expenditure—special qualifying Australian production expenditure
376‑135 Production
expenditure—specific exclusions
Production expenditure—special
rules for the location offset
376‑140 Production
expenditure—special rules for the location offset
Qualifying Australian production
expenditure—common rules
376‑145 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—general test
376‑150 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—specific inclusions
376‑155 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—specific exclusions
376‑160 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—treatment of services embodied in goods
Qualifying Australian production
expenditure—special rules for the location offset and the PDV offset
376‑165 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—special rules for the location offset and the PDV offset
Qualifying Australian production
expenditure—special rules for the producer offset
376‑170 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—special rules for the producer offset
Expenditure
generally—common rules
376‑175 Expenditure to be worked
out on an arm’s length basis
376‑180 Expenditure incurred by
prior production companies
376‑185 Expenditure to be worked
out excluding GST
Production
expenditure—common rules
376‑125 Production
expenditure—general test
(1) A company’s production
expenditure on a *film is expenditure that
the company incurs to the extent to which it:
(a) is incurred in,
or in relation to, the *making of the film; or
(b) is reasonably
attributable to:
(i) the
use of equipment or other facilities for; or
(ii) activities
undertaken in;
the making of
the film.
(2) The making
of a *film means the doing of the things
necessary for the production of the first copy of the film.
(3) The making
of a *film includes:
(a) pre‑production
activities in relation to the film; and
(b) post‑production
activities in relation to the film; and
(c) any other
activities undertaken to bring the film up to the state where it could
reasonably be regarded as ready to be distributed, broadcast or exhibited to
the general public.
(4) The making
of a *film does not include:
(a) developing the
proposal for the *making of the film; or
(b) arranging or
obtaining finance for the film; or
(c) distributing the
film (other than the activities listed in paragraphs (a) to (e) of item 7
of the table in subsection 376‑170(2)); or
(d) promoting the
film.
(5) Without limiting subsection (1),
a company’s production expenditure on a *film:
(a) may be
expenditure that is incurred in the income year for which the *tax offset is sought or in an earlier income year; and
(b) may be
expenditure of either a capital or a revenue nature; and
(c) may
be expenditure that gives rise to a deduction.
Paragraph (c) has effect subject to
item 10 of the table in section 376‑135 (which deals with capital
allowances).
(6) If:
(a) a company:
(i) *holds a *depreciating asset; and
(ii) uses
the asset, while held, in the *making of a *film; and
(b) deductions in
relation to the asset are available under Division 40 (which deals with
capital allowances);
the production expenditure
of the company on the film includes an amount equal to the decline in the value
of the asset to the extent to which that decline is reasonably attributable to
the use of the asset in the making of the film (the film proportion).
The decline in value of the asset is to be worked out using Division 40.
Note: Under item 10 of the
table in section 376‑135, expenditure that sets or increases the cost of
the asset does not count as production expenditure.
(7) If a *balancing adjustment event occurs for the asset before the
film is *completed:
(a) if the asset’s *termination value is more than its *adjustable
value just before the event occurred—the production expenditure
of the company on the film is reduced by the film proportion of the difference;
or
(b) if the asset’s
termination value is less than its adjustable value just before the event
occurred—the production expenditure of the company on the film
includes the film proportion of the difference.
376‑130 Production
expenditure—special qualifying Australian production expenditure
Expenditure
of a company is also production expenditure of the company on a *film if it is *qualifying Australian
production expenditure of the company on the film under section 376‑150 or
376‑165.
Note: This
means that the special qualifying Australian production expenditure in sections 376‑150
and 376‑165 is taken into account both in working out the total amount of the
company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure and in working out the
total amount of all the company’s production expenditure on the film.
376‑135 Production
expenditure—specific exclusions
Despite sections 376‑125
and 376‑130, the following expenditure of a company is not production
expenditure of the company on a *film,
except to the extent, if any, as mentioned in column 3 of the table:
|
Expenditure
that does not count as production expenditure on a film
|
|
Item
|
This
kind of expenditure by the company is not production expenditure ...
|
except
to the extent to which the expenditure is ...
|
|
1
|
Financing expenditure
expenditure incurred by way of, or in
relation to, the financing of the *film (including
returns payable on amounts invested in the film and expenditure in relation
to raising and servicing finance for the film)
|
*qualifying Australian production
expenditure under item 6 of the table in subsection 376‑150(1) and paragraph (a)
of item 5 of the table in subsection 376‑170(2)
|
|
2
|
Development expenditure
*development expenditure on the *film
|
*qualifying Australian production
expenditure under item 1 of the table in subsection 376‑150(1)
|
|
3
|
Copyright acquisition expenditure
expenditure incurred in acquiring
copyright, or a licence in relation to copyright, in a pre‑existing work for
use in the *film
|
*qualifying Australian production
expenditure under item 2 of the table in subsection 376‑150(1)
|
|
4
|
General business overheads
expenditure incurred to meet the general business
overheads of the company that:
(a) are not incurred in, or in relation to,
the *making of the *film; and
(b) are not reasonably attributable to:
(i) the use of equipment or other facilities
for; or
(ii) activities undertaken in;
the making of the film
|
*qualifying Australian production
expenditure under item 1 of the table in subsection 376‑165(1) or
item 1 of the table in subsection 376‑170(2)
|
|
5
|
Publicity and promotion expenditure
expenditure incurred in publicising or
otherwise promoting the *film (including press
expenses, still photography, videotapes, public relations and other similar
expenses)
|
*qualifying Australian production
expenditure under item 3 or 4 of the table in subsection 376‑150(1)
or item 6 of the table in subsection 376‑170(2)
|
|
6
|
Deferments
amounts that are payable only out of the
receipts, earnings or profits from the *film
|
|
|
7
|
Profit participation
amounts that:
(a) depend on the receipts, earnings or
profits from the *film; or
(b) are otherwise dependent on the
commercial performance of the film
|
|
|
8
|
Residuals
amounts payable in satisfaction of the
residual rights of a person who is a member of the cast
|
paid out by the company before the *film is *completed
|
|
9
|
Advances
amounts paid by way of advance on a
payment to which item 6, 7 or 8 applies to the extent to which it may
become repayable by the person to whom it is paid
|
|
|
10
|
Acquisition of depreciating asset
expenditure to the extent to which it
sets, or increases, the *cost of a *depreciating asset
This item has effect subject to
subsections 376‑125(6) and (7).
|
*qualifying Australian production
expenditure under item 2 of the table in subsection 376‑150(1)
|
|
11
|
Regulations
expenditure specified in regulations
|
|
Production
expenditure—special rules for the location offset
376‑140 Production
expenditure—special rules for the location offset
Despite
sections 376‑125 and 376‑130, the expenditure of a company is not production
expenditure of the company on a *film
in relation to the location offset if:
(a) the film is a television
series that is not a *feature film or a mini‑series of
television drama; and
(b) the expenditure
is reasonably attributable to the production of a pilot episode to the
television series; and
(c) the expenditure,
apart from this subsection, would be production expenditure that was not *qualifying Australian production expenditure.
Qualifying
Australian production expenditure—common rules
376‑145 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—general test
A company’s qualifying
Australian production expenditure on a *film
is the company’s *production expenditure on the film to the
extent to which it is incurred for, or is reasonably attributable to:
(a) goods and
services provided in Australia; or
(b) the use of land
located in Australia; or
(c) the use of goods
that are located in Australia at the time they are used in the *making of the film.
376‑150 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—specific inclusions
(1) The following
expenditure of a company is also qualifying Australian production
expenditure of the company on a *film:
|
Special
Australian expenditure
|
|
Item
|
Type
of expenditure
|
|
1
|
Australian development expenditure
*development expenditure on the *film to the extent to which it is incurred for, or is reasonably attributable
to:
(a) goods and services provided in Australia; or
(b) the use of land located in Australia; or
(c) the use of goods that are located in Australia at the time they are used in the *making of the film
[see subsection (2)]
|
|
2
|
Expenditure
incurred in acquiring Australian copyright
expenditure
incurred to acquire copyright, or a licence in relation to copyright, in a
pre‑existing work for use in the *film if the
copyright is held by an individual or a company that is an Australian
resident
|
|
3
|
Expenditure
incurred in producing Australian copyrighted promotional material
expenditure
incurred in producing material for use in publicising or otherwise promoting
the *film if the copyright in the material is
held by an individual or a company that is an Australian resident
|
|
4
|
Expenditure incurred in producing
additional content
expenditure incurred in producing audio
or visual content for the *film otherwise than
for use in the first copy of the film, to the extent that the expenditure is
incurred in Australia prior to the *completion of
the film
|
|
5
|
Regulations
expenditure prescribed by the regulations
|
|
6
|
Certain financing expenditure
expenditure incurred in Australia prior
to the end of the income year in which *completion of the *film occurs in respect
of any of the following:
(a) insurance related to making the film;
(b) fees for audit services and legal
services provided in Australia in relation to raising and servicing the
financing of the film which are incurred by the company that makes, or is responsible
for making, the film;
(c) fees for incorporation and liquidation
of the company that makes or is responsible for making the film.
|
(2) Legal costs are covered
by item 1 of the table in subsection (1) only if they relate to:
(a) writers’ contracts;
or
(b) chain of title
and other copyright issues.
376‑155 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—specific exclusions
Despite
sections 376‑145, 376‑150, 376‑165 and 376‑170, the following expenditure
of a company is not qualifying Australian production expenditure
of a company on a *film:
(a) expenditure that
is incurred when:
(i) the
company is a foreign resident; and
(ii) the
company does not have both a *permanent establishment
in Australia and an *ABN;
(b) expenditure in
relation to:
(i) remuneration
and other benefits provided to an individual for the individual’s services in
relation to the *making of the film; or
(ii) travel
and other costs associated with the services an individual provides in relation
to the making of the film;
if the
individual:
(iii) is
not a member of the cast; and
(iv) enters
Australia to work on the film for less than 2 consecutive calendar weeks;
(c) expenditure
prescribed by the regulations.
376‑160 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—treatment of services embodied in goods
If:
(a) a company incurs
expenditure for the provision of what is essentially a service; and
(b) the results of
the service are provided to the company by being embodied in goods that are
delivered to the company; and
(c) the service that
is embodied in the goods was predominantly performed outside Australia;
the service is not provided to the
company in Australia merely because the goods are delivered to the company in Australia.
Note: Paragraph (b)—a
document, for example, might set out legal or other professional advice or a
computer disk might contain a program that has been made or data that has been
compiled.
Qualifying
Australian production expenditure—special rules for the location offset and the
PDV offset
376‑165 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—special rules for the location offset and the PDV offset
(1) For the purposes of the
location offset and the PDV offset, the following expenditure of a company is
also qualifying Australian production expenditure of the company
on a *film:
|
Special
Australian expenditure—location offset and PDV offset
|
|
Item
|
Type
of expenditure
|
|
1
|
Australian business overheads
general business overheads of the company
that:
(a) are not incurred in, or in relation to,
the *making of the *film; and
(b) are not reasonably attributable to:
(i) the use of equipment or other facilities
for; or
(ii) activities undertaken in;
the making of the film;
to the extent to which they:
(c) are incurred for, or are reasonably
attributable to:
(i) goods and services provided in Australia; or
(ii) the use of land located in Australia; or
(iii) the use of goods that are located in Australia at the time they are used in the making of the film; and
(d) represent a reasonable apportionment of
those overheads between the making of the film and the other activities
undertaken by the company
This item has effect subject to subsection (2).
|
|
2
|
Travel to Australia
expenditure of the company in relation to
an individual’s travel to Australia to undertake activities in Australia in relation to the *making of the *film, if the remuneration paid to the individual for those
activities is *qualifying Australian production
expenditure of the company
|
|
3
|
Expenditure incurred in freighting
goods to Australia
expenditure incurred in freighting goods
to Australia, to the extent that the goods will be used in the *making of the *film
|
(2) General business
overheads of the company are covered by item 1 of the table in subsection (1)
only to the extent to which they do not exceed the lesser of:
(a) 2% of the total
of all the company’s *production expenditure on the *film; and
(b) $500,000.
Qualifying
Australian production expenditure—special rules for the producer offset
376‑170 Qualifying Australian
production expenditure—special rules for the producer offset
Expenditure that is qualifying
Australian production expenditure
(1) For the purposes of
subsections 376‑65(6) and (7), expenditure on a *film
incurred in a foreign country is qualifying Australian production
expenditure of a company on the film if:
(a) the expenditure
is incurred by the company claiming the offset, or by another entity that is
involved in the *making of the film; and
(b) the expenditure
would be qualifying Australian production expenditure if it had been incurred
for, or reasonably attributable to:
(i) goods
and services provided in Australia; or
(ii) the
use of land located in Australia; or
(iii) the
use of goods that are located in Australia at the time they are used in the *making of the film; and
(c) the film is made
under an *arrangement entered into between the
Commonwealth or an authority of the Commonwealth and the foreign country or an
authority of the foreign country.
Note: This means that such
expenditure is taken into account for the purposes of determining whether to
issue a certificate for the producer offset to the company under section 376‑65.
It is not taken into account in working out the amount of the producer offset
to which the company is entitled.
(2) For the purposes of the
producer offset, the following expenditure of a company is also qualifying
Australian production expenditure of the company on a *film:
|
Special
Australian expenditure—producer offset
|
|
Item
|
Type
of expenditure
|
|
1
|
Australian
business overheads
general
business overheads of the company that:
(a) are not
incurred in, or in relation to, the *making of the *film; and
(b) are not
reasonably attributable to:
(i) the use
of equipment or other facilities for; or
(ii)
activities undertaken in;
the
making of the film;
to the
extent to which they:
(c) are
incurred for, or are reasonably attributable to:
(i) goods and
services provided in Australia; or
(ii) the use
of land located in Australia; or
(iii) the use
of goods that are located in Australia at the time they are used in the
making of the film; and
(d) represent
a reasonable apportionment of those overheads between the making of the film
and the other activities undertaken by the company
This item
has effect subject to subsection (3).
|
|
2
|
Travel
to Australia and other countries
expenditure
of the company in relation to an individual’s travel:
(a) to Australia, to undertake activities in relation to the *making of the *film; and
(b) to or
within any other country, to undertake activities in relation to the making
of the film, if the remuneration paid to the individual for those activities
would be *qualifying Australian production
expenditure of the company under item 4 of this table.
|
|
3
|
Expenditure incurred in freighting
goods within and between countries
expenditure incurred in freighting goods
within and between countries, to the extent that the goods will be used in
the *making of the *film.
|
|
4
|
Expenditure
incurred in other countries
expenditure
incurred outside Australia:
(a) for the
remuneration of an Australian resident, or the purchase of goods or services
from companies or *permanent establishments that
have an *ABN; and
(b) during
the period in which principal photography for the film takes place outside Australia
if the
subject matter of the film reasonably requires the location in which the
expenditure is incurred to be used for principal photography.
|
|
5
|
Other expenditure
expenditure incurred in Australia in
respect of any of the following:
(a) obtaining an independent opinion of the
amount of a film’s *qualifying Australian
production expenditure required for use in relation to the financing of the
film;
(b) offset carbon emissions created during
the making of the film.
|
|
6
|
Expenditure incurred in producing
Australian copyright promotional material
expenditure incurred in Australia in the
income year of the *completion of the *film or an earlier year in respect of any of the following:
(a) producing material for publicising or
otherwise promoting the film where the copyright in the material is held or
partially held by a company that is an Australian resident;
(b) unit publicist fees.
|
|
7
|
Expenditure incurred in delivering or
distributing the film
expenditure incurred by the applicant
company in delivering or distributing the film prior to the end of the income
year in which the *film is complete to the extent
to which it is incurred for, or reasonably attributable to, any of the
following:
(a) acquiring Australian classification
certificates;
(b) sound mix mastering licenses;
(c) re‑versioning the film in Australia;
(d) freight services provided by a company
in Australia for delivery of contracted deliverables in relation to the film;
(e) storing the film in a film vault in
Australia.
|
(3) General business
overheads of the company are covered by item 1 of the table in subsection (2)
only to the extent to which they do not exceed the lesser of:
(a) 5% of the total
of all the company’s *total film expenditure on the *film; and
(b) $500,000.
Expenditure that is not qualifying
Australian production expenditure
(4) For the purposes of the
producer offset, the following expenditure of a company is not qualifying
Australian production expenditure of a company on a *film:
(a) expenditure on
the film that is paid for with *development assistance
received from any of the following bodies:
(ii) Film
Australia Limited;
(iii) the
Australian Film Commission;
(iv) the
Australian Film, Television and Radio School;
(v) Screen
Australia;
unless the
amount or value of the assistance has been repaid;
(b) subject to subsection (4A),
the following expenditure:
(i) *development expenditure on the film;
(ii) remuneration
provided to the principal director, producers and principal cast associated
with the film;
to the extent
that such expenditure comprises greater than 20% of the company’s *total film expenditure on the film;
(c) for a series or a
season of a series—expenditure on an episode beyond the episode in which the
65th commercial hour of the series is reached.
(4A) Paragraph (4)(b) does
not apply to a *film that is a *documentary.
(5) In applying paragraph (4)(c),
episodes completed before 1 July 2011 count towards the limit in that
paragraph.
(6) Total film
expenditure on a film means:
(a) expenditure
covered by sections 376‑125, 376‑130, 376‑150 and 376‑170; and
(b) expenditure
mentioned in column 2 of the table in section 376‑135, to the extent that
it is not covered by paragraph (a).
Expenditure
generally—common rules
376‑175 Expenditure to be worked out
on an arm’s length basis
For the purposes of
this Division, if any 2 or more parties to:
(a) an *arrangement under which a company incurs expenditure in relation to
a *film; or
(b) any act or
transaction directly or indirectly connected with expenditure that a company
incurs in relation to a film;
do not deal with each other at *arm’s length in relation to the arrangement, or in relation to the
act or transaction, the expenditure is taken to be only so much (if any) of the
expenditure as would have been incurred if they had been dealing with each
other at arm’s length in relation to the arrangement, or in relation to the act
or transaction.
376‑180 Expenditure incurred by
prior production companies
(1) For the purposes of this
Division, if a company (the incoming company) takes over the *making of a *film from another
company (the outgoing company):
(a) expenditure
incurred in relation to the film by the outgoing company is taken to have been
incurred in relation to the film by the incoming company; and
(b) for the purposes
of determining the extent to which that expenditure is *qualifying
Australian production expenditure of the incoming company, the incoming company
is taken:
(i) to
have been an Australian resident at any time when the outgoing company was an
Australian resident; and
(ii) to
have had a *permanent establishment in Australia at any time when the outgoing company had a permanent establishment in Australia; and
(iii) to
have had an *ABN at any time when the outgoing company
had an ABN; and
(c) expenditure that
the incoming company incurs in order to be able to take over the making of the
film is to be disregarded for the purposes of this Division; and
(d) any activities
carried out, and arrangements made, by the outgoing company in relation to the
film are taken, for the purposes of paragraphs 376‑20(5)(c), 376‑45(5)(b) and
376‑65(1)(a), to have been carried out or made by the incoming company in
relation to the film.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1):
(a) expenditure
incurred on the *film by the outgoing company includes
expenditure that the outgoing company is itself taken to have incurred on the
film because of the operation of subsection (1); and
(b) the outgoing
company is taken:
(i) to
have been an Australian resident at any time when the outgoing company is taken
to have been an Australian resident because of the operation of subsection (1);
and
(ii) to
have had a *permanent establishment in Australia at any time when the outgoing company is taken to have had a permanent
establishment in Australia because of the operation of subsection (1); and
(iii) to
have had an *ABN at any time when the outgoing company
is taken to have had an ABN because of the operation of subsection (1);
and
(c) activities
carried out by the outgoing company in relation to the film include activities
that the outgoing company is taken to have carried out in relation to the film
because of the operation of subsection (1); and
(d) arrangements made
by the outgoing company for the carrying out of activities in relation to the
film include arrangements that the outgoing company is taken to have made
because of the operation of subsection (1).
Example: If Uncle Carty Ltd starts out
making a film and then Mr Grouble Ltd takes over the making of the film, Mr
Grouble Ltd is taken to have incurred the expenditure that Uncle Carty Ltd
incurred on the film. If Lousie Ltd subsequently takes over the making of the
film from Mr Grouble Ltd, Lousie Ltd is taken to have incurred the expenditure
that Mr Grouble Ltd incurred on the film (including the expenditure of Uncle
Carty Ltd that is attributed to Mr Grouble Ltd).
376‑185 Expenditure to be worked out
excluding GST
In determining an
amount of expenditure for the purpose of this Division, the expenditure is
taken to exclude *GST.
Subdivision 376‑D—Certificates for films and other matters
Table of sections
376‑230 Production company may
apply for certificate
376‑235 Notice of refusal to issue
certificate
376‑240 Issue of certificate
376‑245 Revocation of certificate
376‑250 Notice of decision or
determination
376‑255 Review of decisions by the
Administrative Appeals Tribunal
376‑260 Minister may make rules
about the location offset and the PDV offset
376‑265 Film authority may make
rules about the producer offset
376‑270 Amendment of assessments
376‑275 Review in relation to
certain production levels
376‑230 Production company may apply
for certificate
(1) A company may apply to
the *Arts Minister for the issue of a
certificate to the company for a *film under section 376‑20
(certificate for the location offset) when all of the company’s *qualifying Australian production expenditure for the film has been
incurred.
Application for PDV offset certificate
(2) Once all of a company’s *qualifying Australian production expenditure on a *film, to the extent that it relates to *post,
digital and visual effects production for the film, has been incurred, the
company may apply to the *Arts Minister for the
issue of a certificate to the company for the film under section 376‑45
(certificate for the PDV offset).
Application for producer offset
certificate
(3) Once a *film is *completed, a company may apply to
the *film authority for the issue of a
certificate to the company for the film under section 376‑65 (certificate
for the producer offset).
Form of application
(4) An application under subsection (1)
or (2) must be made in accordance with the rules determined by the *Arts Minister under section 376‑260 so far as they relate to
the requirements for applications.
(5) An application under subsection (3)
must be made in accordance with the rules determined by the *film authority under section 376‑265 so far as they relate to
the requirements for applications.
376‑235 Notice of refusal to issue
certificate
(1) If the *Arts Minister decides not to issue a certificate under section 376‑20
(certificate for the location offset) or 376‑45 (certificate for the PDV
offset) for a *film, the Minister must give the applicant
written notice of the decision (including reasons for the decision).
(2) If the *film authority decides not to issue a certificate under section 376‑65
(certificate for the producer offset) for a *film,
the authority must give the applicant written notice of the decision (including
reasons for the decision).
376‑240 Issue of certificate
(1) A certificate issued to
a company under section 376‑20 (certificate for the location offset), 376‑45
(certificate for the PDV offset) or 376‑65 (certificate for the producer
offset) must:
(a) be in writing;
and
(b) specify the
company’s *ABN; and
(c) specify the date
of issue of the certificate; and
(d) if the
certificate is issued under section 376‑20—specify the total of the
company’s *qualifying Australian production
expenditure on the *film, as determined by the *Arts Minister under section 376‑30; and
(e) if the
certificate is issued under section 376‑45—specify the total of the
company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure on the film, to the
extent that it relates to *post, digital and visual
effects production for the film, as determined by the Arts Minister under
section 376‑50; and
(f) if the
certificate is issued under section 376‑65—specify the total of the
company’s qualifying Australian production expenditure on the film, as
determined by the *film authority under section 376‑75.
(2) If the certificate is
issued under section 376‑20 (certificate for the location offset) or 376‑45
(certificate for the PDV offset), the *Arts Minister must
give the Commissioner notice of the issue of a certificate for a *film within 30 days after issuing the certificate.
(3) The notice under subsection (2)
must specify:
(a) the company’s
name; and
(b) the company’s
address; and
(c) the total of the
company’s *qualifying Australian production
expenditure on the *film, as determined by the *Arts Minister under section 376‑30 or 376‑50, as the case may
be; and
(d) other matters
agreed to between the Arts Minister and the Commissioner.
The notice must be accompanied by a copy
of the certificate.
(4) If the certificate is
issued under section 376‑65 (certificate for the producer offset), the *film authority must give the Commissioner notice of the issue of a
certificate for a *film within 30 days after issuing the
certificate.
(5) The notice under subsection (4)
must specify:
(a) the company’s
name; and
(b) the company’s
address; and
(c) the total of the
company’s *qualifying Australian production
expenditure on the *film, as determined by the *film authority under section 376‑75; and
(d) other matters
agreed to between the film authority and the Commissioner.
The notice must be accompanied by a copy
of the certificate.
376‑245 Revocation of certificate
(1) The *Arts Minister may revoke a certificate issued to a company for a *film under section 376‑20 (certificate for the location offset)
or 376‑45 (certificate for the PDV offset) if:
(a) the Minister is
satisfied that the issue of the certificate was obtained by fraud or serious
misrepresentation; or
(b) the company does
not provide a copy of the film to the Minister within 30 days of when the film
is *completed.
(2) If the *Arts Minister revokes a certificate under subsection (1), the
Minister must give the company to whom the certificate was issued written
notice of the revocation (including reasons for the decision to revoke the
certificate).
(3) The *film authority may revoke a certificate issued to a company for a *film under section 376‑65 (certificate for the producer offset)
if the authority is satisfied that the issue of the certificate was obtained by
fraud or serious misrepresentation.
(4) If the *film authority revokes a certificate under subsection (3), the
authority must give the company to whom the certificate was issued written
notice of the revocation (including reasons for the decision to revoke the
certificate).
(5) If a certificate is
revoked under subsection (1) or (3), it is taken, for the purposes of this
Division, never to have been issued.
Note: This means that if an
assessment of a company’s income tax is issued on the basis that the company is
entitled to a tax offset for a film and the certificate for the film is then
revoked, the assessment will be amended to take account of the fact that the
company was never entitled to the tax offset: see section 376‑270.
(6) Subsection (5)
does not apply for the purposes of:
(a) the operation of
this section or section 376‑250; or
(b) a review by a
court or the *AAT of the decision to revoke the
certificate.
376‑250 Notice of decision or
determination
(1) This section applies to
a notice of a decision given under section 376‑235 (refusal to issue a
certificate) or 376‑245 (revocation of a certificate), and to a notice of a
determination given under section 376‑30 (determination of qualifying
Australian production expenditure for location offset), 376‑50 (determination
of qualifying Australian production expenditure for PDV offset) or 376‑75
(determination of qualifying Australian production expenditure for producer
offset).
(2) The notice of the
decision or determination is to include the statements set out in subsections (3)
and (4).
(3) There must be a
statement to the effect that, subject to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal
Act 1975, an application may be made to the *AAT,
by (or on behalf of) any entity whose interests are affected by the decision or
determination, for review of the decision or determination.
(4) There must also be a
statement to the effect that a request may be made under section 28 of the
Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975 by (or on behalf of) such an
entity for a statement:
(a) setting out the
findings on material questions of fact; and
(b) referring to the
evidence or other material on which those findings were based; and
(c) giving the
reasons for the decision or determination;
except where subsection 28(4) of
that Act applies.
(5) If the *Arts Minister or the *film authority fails to
comply with subsection (3) or (4), that failure does not affect the
validity of the decision or determination.
376‑255 Review of decisions by the
Administrative Appeals Tribunal
Applications may be
made to the *AAT for review of:
(a) a decision made
by the *Arts Minister to refuse an application for
a certificate under section 376‑20 (certificate for the location offset)
or 376‑45 (certificate for the PDV offset); or
(b) a decision made
by the Arts Minister under section 376‑245 to revoke a certificate; or
(c) a decision made
by the *film authority to refuse an application
for a certificate under section 376‑65 (certificate for the producer
offset); or
(d) a decision made
by the film authority under section 376‑245 to revoke a certificate; or
(e) a determination
by the Arts Minister in relation to the total of a company’s *qualifying Australian production expenditure under section 376‑30
or 376‑50; or
(f) a determination
by the film authority in relation to the total of a company’s *qualifying Australian production expenditure under section 376‑75.
376‑260 Minister may make rules
about the location offset and the PDV offset
Rules establishing the Film
Certification Advisory Board
(1) The *Arts Minister may, by legislative instrument, make rules:
(a) establishing a
Film Certification Advisory Board to:
(i) consider
applications under subsection 376‑230(1) (application for a certificate
for the location offset) or (2) (application for a certificate for the PDV
offset) and advise the Minister on whether to issue certificates under section 376‑20
(certificate for the location offset) or 376‑45 (certificate for the PDV
offset); and
(ii) perform
such other functions in relation to the operation of this Division as are specified
in the rules; and
(b) specifying the
membership of the Board and the terms and conditions of appointment to the
Board; and
(c) specifying
procedures to be followed by the Board in performing its functions.
Rules providing for provisional
certificates in relation to location offset and the PDV offset
(2) The *Arts Minister may, by legislative instrument, make rules providing
for the issue of provisional certificates in relation to the location offset or
the PDV offset.
Rules about applications for
certificates in relation to the location offset and the PDV offset
(3) The *Arts Minister may, by legislative instrument, make rules specifying
how applications for certificates (including provisional certificates) in
relation to the location offset or the PDV offset are to be made, including:
(a) the form in which
applications are to be made; and
(b) the information
to be provided in applications; and
(c) methods for
verifying such information; and
(d) procedures for
providing, at the Minister’s request, additional information in support of an
application.
(4) Rules under paragraph (3)(c)
can include rules requiring reports by auditors or independent line producers.
376‑265 Film authority may make
rules about the producer offset
Rules providing for provisional
certificates in relation to the producer offset
(1) The
*film authority may, by legislative instrument, make rules providing
for the issue of provisional certificates in relation to the producer offset.
Rules about applications for certificates
in relation to the producer offset
(2) The *film authority may, by legislative instrument, make rules specifying
how applications for certificates (including provisional certificates) in
relation to the producer offset are to be made, including:
(a) the form in which
applications are to be made; and
(b) the information
to be provided in applications; and
(c) methods for
verifying such information; and
(d) procedures for
providing, at the authority’s request, additional information in support of an
application.
(3) Rules under paragraph (2)(c)
can include rules requiring reports by auditors or independent line producers.
376‑270 Amendment of assessments
Section 170 of the
Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 does not prevent the amendment of an
assessment for the purposes of giving effect to this Division for an income
year if:
(a) a certificate
issued to a company for a *film is revoked under
section 376‑245 after the time the company lodged its *income tax return for an income year; and
(b) the amendment is
made at any time during the period of 4 years starting immediately after the
revocation of the certificate.
Note: Section 170 of that Act
specifies the periods within which assessments may be amended.
376‑275 Review in relation to certain
production levels
The Minister must,
before the end of 12 months after the commencement of this Division, initiate a
review of the effect of this Division in relation to levels of production by
the Australian independent production sector compared to levels of production
by Australian television broadcasters.
Division 380—National Rental Affordability Scheme
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 380
380‑A National Rental Affordability
Scheme Tax Offset
380‑B Payments made in relation to
the National Rental Affordability Scheme etc.
Guide to Division 380
380‑1 What this Division is about
This Division
provides a tax offset to certain entities as a result of certificates issued
under the National Rental Affordability Scheme Act 2008.
It also ensures that
payments made, and non‑cash benefits provided, by a State or Territory
governmental body in relation to the National Rental Affordability Scheme are
not assessable income and not exempt income.
Subdivision 380‑A—National Rental Affordability Scheme Tax Offset
Table of sections
NRAS certificates issued to
individuals, corporate tax entities and superannuation funds
380‑5 Claims by individuals,
corporate tax entities and superannuation funds
NRAS certificates issued to NRAS
approved participants
380‑10 Members of NRAS
consortiums—individuals, corporate tax entities and superannuation funds
380‑11 Elections by NRAS
approved participants
380‑12 Elections by NRAS
approved participants—tax offsets
380‑13 Elections by NRAS
approved participants—special rule for partnerships and trustees
380‑14 Members of NRAS
consortiums—partnerships and trustees
NRAS certificates issued to
partnerships and trustees
380‑15 Entities to whom NRAS
rent flows indirectly
380‑16 Elections by NRAS
approved participants that are partnerships or trustees
380‑17 Elections by NRAS
approved participants that are partnerships or trustees—tax offsets
380‑18 Elections by NRAS
approved participants that are partnerships or trustees—special rule for
partnerships and trustees
380‑20 Trustee of a trust that
does not have net income for an income year
380‑25 When NRAS rent flows
indirectly to or through an entity
380‑30 Share of NRAS rent
Miscellaneous
380‑32 Amended certificates
NRAS certificates
issued to individuals, corporate tax entities and superannuation funds
380‑5 Claims by individuals,
corporate tax entities and superannuation funds
Entitlement
(1) An entity is entitled to
a *tax offset for an income year if:
(a) the *Housing Secretary issues an *NRAS
certificate in relation to an *NRAS year to the entity
(other than in the entity’s capacity (if any) as the *NRAS
approved participant of an *NRAS consortium); and
(b) the income year
begins in the NRAS year; and
(c) the entity is an
individual, a *corporate tax entity or a *superannuation fund.
Amount
(2) The amount of the
entity’s *tax offset is the amount stated in the *NRAS certificate.
NRAS certificates
issued to NRAS approved participants
380‑10 Members of NRAS
consortiums—individuals, corporate tax entities and superannuation funds
Entitlement
(1) A *member of an *NRAS consortium is
entitled to a *tax offset for an income year if:
(a) the *Housing Secretary issues an *NRAS
certificate in relation to an *NRAS year to the *NRAS approved participant of the NRAS consortium; and
(b) the income year
commences in the NRAS year; and
(c) the member is an
individual, a *corporate tax entity or a *superannuation fund.
Amount
(2) The amount of the *tax offset is the total of the amounts worked out using the
following formula for each *NRAS dwelling:
(a) covered by the *NRAS certificate; and
(b) from which the *member *derives *NRAS
rent during the *NRAS year:

(3) Treat the references in subsection (2)
to the *NRAS year as being references to a period
that occurs during the NRAS year, if the *NRAS
certificate is apportioned for the period.
380‑11 Elections by NRAS approved
participants
Scope
(1) This
section and sections 380‑12 and 380‑13 apply if:
(a) a *member (the electing member) of an *NRAS consortium would, apart from subsection 380‑12(3), be
entitled to a *tax offset under section 380‑10 for
an income year because of:
(i) an *NRAS certificate in relation to an *NRAS
year; and
(ii) an *NRAS dwelling covered by the NRAS certificate; and
(b) the electing
member was the *NRAS approved participant of the NRAS
consortium at any time during the NRAS year; and
(c) the electing
member elects to have this section apply to the NRAS certificate and NRAS
dwelling for the income year.
Requirements for an election
(2) The election must be
made:
(a) in the *approved form; and
(b) within 30 days
after the day the *Housing Secretary issues the *NRAS certificate.
(3) The Commissioner may
require a copy or copies of the election to be given, within the 30 day period
mentioned in paragraph (2)(b):
(a) to the
Commissioner; or
(b) to each *member of the *NRAS consortium who may
be entitled to a *tax offset under section 380‑12 as a
result of the election; or
(c) both to the
Commissioner and to each such member.
(4) The election may not be
revoked.
380‑12 Elections by NRAS approved
participants—tax offsets
Entitlement to tax offset
(1) A *member of the *NRAS consortium (other
than the electing member) is entitled to a *tax
offset for the income year if the member is an individual, a *corporate tax entity or a *superannuation
fund.
Amount of tax offset
(2) The amount of the *tax offset is the amount worked out using the following formula:

where:
member’s rent means:
(a) if *NRAS rent was payable for the *NRAS
dwelling in relation to the whole of the *NRAS
year—the rent *derived by the *member
from the NRAS dwelling during the NRAS year; or
(b) if NRAS rent was
payable for the NRAS dwelling in relation to only part of the NRAS year—the
rent derived by the member from the NRAS dwelling during that part of the NRAS
year.
total rent means:
(a) if *NRAS rent was payable for the *NRAS
dwelling in relation to the whole of the *NRAS
year—the rent *derived from the NRAS dwelling during the
NRAS year; or
(b) if NRAS rent was
payable for the NRAS dwelling in relation to only part of the NRAS year—the
rent derived from the NRAS dwelling during that part of the NRAS year.
(3) The
*tax offset to which the electing member would otherwise be entitled under section 380‑10 for the income
year because of the *NRAS certificate and the *NRAS dwelling is reduced by the same amount.
(4) Treat the references in subsection (2)
to the *NRAS year as being references to a period
that occurs during the NRAS year, if the *NRAS
certificate is apportioned for the period.
Amount of tax offset—rent that passes
through NRAS approved participant
(5) For the purposes of the
references in the definitions in subsection (2) to rent *derived from the *NRAS dwelling during the
*NRAS year, disregard *NRAS rent derived by a *member of the *NRAS consortium from the
NRAS dwelling during a period in the NRAS year, to the extent that another
member derives rent from the NRAS dwelling during the period because:
(a) the first member
is the *NRAS approved participant of the NRAS
consortium throughout the period; and
(b) the first member,
in accordance with the contractual *arrangements that
established the NRAS consortium, passes the NRAS rent on to the other member.
Note: There may be more than one
NRAS approved participant during an NRAS year. The electing member may be the
NRAS approved participant for only part of the NRAS year.
(6) For the purposes of paragraph (5)(b),
treat any *NRAS rent retained by the first *member under the *arrangements as
management fees or commission as having been passed on to the other member.
380‑13 Elections by NRAS approved
participants—special rule for partnerships and trustees
For the purposes of sections 380‑14
to 380‑30 (which apply if a partnership or the trustee of a trust derives NRAS
rent), for each *NRAS dwelling:
(a) from which the
electing member *derived *NRAS
rent during the *NRAS year; and
(b) that is covered
by the *NRAS certificate; and
(c) from which a
partnership, or the trustee of a trust, that is a *member
of the *NRAS consortium derived rent during the
NRAS year;
treat the following proportion of the
NRAS rent as being NRAS rent derived during the NRAS year by the member mentioned
in paragraph (c):

where:
member’s rent has the same meaning as in subsection 380‑12(2).
total rent has the same meaning as in subsection 380‑12(2).
380‑14 Members of NRAS
consortiums—partnerships and trustees
(1) This section applies if:
(a) the *Housing Secretary issues an *NRAS
certificate in relation to an *NRAS year to the *NRAS approved participant of an *NRAS
consortium; and
(b) the NRAS
certificate covers one or more *NRAS dwellings; and
(c) a *member of the NRAS consortium, other than the NRAS approved
participant, *derives *NRAS
rent during the NRAS year from any of those NRAS dwellings; and
(d) the member is a
partnership or a trustee of a trust.
(2) For the purposes of
sections 380‑15 to 380‑20, assume that:
(a) the *member has been issued with an *NRAS
certificate in relation to the *NRAS year; and
(b) the NRAS
certificate covers each *NRAS dwelling:
(i) covered
by the NRAS certificate mentioned in paragraph (1)(b) of this section; and
(ii) from
which the member *derives *NRAS
rent during the NRAS year; and
(c) the amount stated
in the NRAS certificate for each of those NRAS dwellings is the amount worked
out using the formula in subsection 380‑10(2) in relation to the NRAS
dwelling for the NRAS year for the member.
NRAS certificates
issued to partnerships and trustees
380‑15 Entities to whom NRAS rent
flows indirectly
(1) An entity is entitled to
a *tax offset for an income year (the offset year) if:
(a) the *Housing Secretary issues an *NRAS
certificate in relation to an *NRAS year to a
partnership or a trustee of a trust; and
(b) *NRAS rent *derived:
(i) from
any of the *NRAS dwellings covered by the NRAS
certificate; and
(ii) during
the NRAS year;
*flows
indirectly to the entity in any income year; and
(c) the offset year
of the partnership or trustee begins in the NRAS year; and
(d) the entity is:
(i) an
individual; or
(ii) a *corporate tax entity when the NRAS rent flows indirectly to it; or
(iii) the
trustee of a trust that is liable to be assessed on a share of, or all or a
part of, the trust’s *net income under section 98,
99 or 99A of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 for the offset year; or
(iv) the
trustee of an *FHSA; or
(v) a *superannuation fund, an *approved deposit
fund or a *pooled superannuation trust.
Note: The entities covered by this
section are the ultimate recipients of the NRAS rent because the NRAS rent does
not flow indirectly through them to other entities.
(2) The amount of the *tax offset is the sum of the amounts worked out using the following
formula for each *NRAS dwelling from which there is *NRAS rent covered by paragraph (1)(b):

(3) Treat the references in subsection (2)
to the *NRAS year as being references to a period
that occurs during the NRAS year, if the *NRAS
certificate is apportioned for the period.
380‑16 Elections by NRAS approved
participants that are partnerships or trustees
Scope
(1) This section and
sections 380‑17 and 380‑18 apply if:
(a) an entity (the indirect
entity) is entitled to a *tax offset under section 380‑15
or 380‑20 for an income year because *NRAS rent *derived:
(i) from
any of the *NRAS dwellings covered by an *NRAS certificate issued by the *Housing
Secretary in relation to an *NRAS year to a *member (the electing member) of an *NRAS consortium; and
(ii) during
the NRAS year;
*flows
indirectly to the indirect entity in any income year (or would otherwise flow
indirectly to the indirect entity, as mentioned in paragraph 380‑20(1)(d));
and
(b) the electing
member was the *NRAS approved participant of the NRAS
consortium at any time during the NRAS year; and
(c) the electing
member elects to have this section apply to the NRAS certificate and NRAS
dwelling for the income year.
Requirements for an election
(2) The election must be
made:
(a) in the *approved form; and
(b) within 30 days
after the day the *Housing Secretary issues the *NRAS certificate.
(3) The Commissioner may
require a copy or copies of the election to be given, within the 30 day period
mentioned in paragraph (2)(b):
(a) to the
Commissioner; or
(b) to each *member of the *NRAS consortium who may
be entitled to a *tax offset under section 380‑17 as a
result of the election; or
(c) both to the
Commissioner and to each such member.
(4) The election may not be
revoked.
380‑17 Elections by NRAS approved
participants that are partnerships or trustees—tax offsets
Entitlement to tax offset
(1) A *member of the *NRAS consortium (other
than the electing member) is entitled to a *tax
offset for the income year if the member is an individual, a *corporate tax entity or a *superannuation
fund.
Amount of tax offset
(2) The amount of the *tax offset is the amount worked out using the following formula:

where:
member’s rent means:
(a) if *NRAS rent was payable for the *NRAS
dwelling in relation to the whole of the *NRAS
year—the rent *derived by the *member
from the NRAS dwelling during the NRAS year; or
(b) if NRAS rent was
payable for the NRAS dwelling in relation to only part of the NRAS year—the
rent derived by the member from the NRAS dwelling during that part of the NRAS
year.
total rent means:
(a) if *NRAS rent was payable for the *NRAS
dwelling in relation to the whole of the *NRAS
year—the rent *derived from the NRAS dwelling during the
NRAS year; or
(b) if NRAS rent was
payable for the NRAS dwelling in relation to only part of the NRAS year—the
rent derived from the NRAS dwelling during that part of the NRAS year.
total tax offsets means the total of the *tax offsets to
which entities would be entitled under section 380‑15 or 380‑20 because of
*NRAS rent *derived:
(a) from any of the *NRAS dwellings covered by the *NRAS
certificate; and
(b) during the *NRAS year;
that *flows
indirectly to them from the electing member (or would otherwise flow indirectly
to them from the electing member, as mentioned in paragraph 380‑20(1)(d)).
(3) The *tax offset to which the indirect entity would otherwise be entitled
under section 380‑15 for the income year because of the *NRAS certificate and the *NRAS dwelling is
reduced by the amount worked out using the following formula:

where:
total tax offsets has the same meaning as in subsection (2).
(4) Treat the references in subsection (2)
to the *NRAS year as being references to a period
that occurs during the NRAS year, if the *NRAS
certificate is apportioned for the period.
Amount of tax offset—rent that passes
through NRAS approved participant
(5) For the purposes of the
references in the definitions in subsection (2) to rent *derived from the *NRAS dwelling during the
*NRAS year, disregard *NRAS rent derived by a *member of the *NRAS consortium from the
NRAS dwelling during a period in the NRAS year, to the extent that another
member derives rent from the NRAS dwelling during the period because:
(a) the first member
is the *NRAS approved participant of the NRAS
consortium throughout the period; and
(b) the first member,
in accordance with the contractual *arrangements that
established the NRAS consortium, passes the NRAS rent on to the other member.
Note: There may be more than one
NRAS approved participant during an NRAS year. The electing member may be the
NRAS approved participant for only part of the NRAS year.
(6) For the purposes of paragraph (5)(b),
treat any *NRAS rent retained by the first *member under the *arrangements as
management fees or commission as having been passed on to the other member.
380‑18 Elections by NRAS approved
participants that are partnerships or trustees—special rule for partnerships
and trustees
For
the purposes of sections 380‑15 and 380‑20 to 380‑30 (which apply if a
partnership or the trustee of a trust derives NRAS rent), for each *NRAS dwelling:
(a) from
which the electing member *derived *NRAS rent during the *NRAS year; and
(b) that is covered
by the *NRAS certificate; and
(c) from which a
partnership or trust that is a *member of the *NRAS consortium derived rent during the NRAS year;
treat the following proportion of the
NRAS rent as being NRAS rent derived during the NRAS year by the member
mentioned in paragraph (c):

where:
member’s rent has the same meaning as in subsection 380‑14B(2).
total rent has the same meaning as in subsection 380‑14B(2).
380‑20 Trustee of a trust that does
not have net income for an income year
(1) An entity is entitled to
a *tax offset for an income year (the offset year) if:
(a) the *Housing Secretary issues an *NRAS
certificate in relation to an *NRAS year to a
partnership or a trustee of a trust; and
(b) the entity is a
trustee of a trust; and
(c) the trust
mentioned in paragraph (b) does not have a *net
income for an income year; and
(d) *NRAS rent *derived during the NRAS year from
an *NRAS dwelling covered by the NRAS certificate would otherwise *flow indirectly to the entity in the income year mentioned in paragraph (c)
as if:
(i) the
trust did have a net income for the income year; and
(ii) for
the purposes of paragraph 380‑25(4)(b), the entity has a share amount,
being the net income referred to in subparagraph (i) of this paragraph;
and
(iii) the
entity’s *share of the NRAS rent under section 380‑30
was a positive amount; and
(e) the offset year
of the partnership or trustee begins in the NRAS year.
(2) The amount of the *tax offset is the amount worked out in accordance with subsection 380‑15(2),
as if the reference in the formula to the *NRAS
certificate were a reference to the NRAS certificate mentioned in paragraph (1)(a)
of this section.
(3) For the purposes of
working out the entity’s *share of *NRAS rent for an *NRAS dwelling, assume subparagraphs (1)(d)(i),
(ii) and (iii) of this section apply.
(4) If the trustee of a
trust is entitled to a *tax offset under this
section:
(a) a beneficiary of
the trust; or
(b) a subsequent
entity to whom *NRAS rent for an *NRAS
dwelling mentioned in paragraph (1)(d) *flows
indirectly;
is not entitled to a tax offset under
this Subdivision in relation to the NRAS rent *derived
during the *NRAS year from for the NRAS dwelling.
380‑25 When NRAS rent flows
indirectly to or through an entity
(1) This section sets out
the circumstances in which *NRAS rent:
(a) flows
indirectly to an entity (subsection (2), (3) or (4)); or
(b) flows
indirectly through an entity (subsection (5)).
Partners
(2) *NRAS
rent flows indirectly to a partner in a partnership in an
income year if, and only if:
(a) during that
income year, the NRAS rent is *derived by the
partnership, or *flows indirectly to the partnership as a
beneficiary because of a previous application of subsection (3); and
(b) the partner has
an individual interest:
(i) in
the partnership’s *net income for that income year that is
covered by paragraph 92(1)(a) or (b) of the Income Tax Assessment Act
1936; or
(ii) in a *partnership loss of the partnership for that income year that is
covered by paragraph 92(2)(a) or (b) of that Act;
(whether or not
that individual interest becomes assessable income in the hands of the
partner); and
(c) the partner’s *share of the NRAS rent under section 380‑30 is a positive
amount (whether or not the partner actually receives any of that share).
Beneficiaries
(3) *NRAS rent flows indirectly to a beneficiary of a trust
in an income year if, and only if:
(a) during that
income year, the NRAS rent is *derived by the trustee
of the trust, or *flows indirectly to the trustee as a
partner or beneficiary because of a previous application of subsection (2)
or this subsection; and
(b) the beneficiary
has this amount for that income year (the share amount):
(i) a
share of the trust’s *net income for that income year
that is covered by paragraph 97(1)(a) of the Income Tax Assessment Act
1936; or
(ii) an
individual interest in the trust’s net income for that income year that is
covered by section 98A or 100 of that Act;
(whether or not
the share amount becomes assessable income in the hands of the beneficiary);
and
(c) the beneficiary’s
*share of the NRAS rent under section 380‑30 is a positive
amount (whether or not the beneficiary actually receives any of that share).
Trustees
(4) *NRAS
rent flows indirectly to the trustee of a trust in an income year
if, and only if:
(a) during that
income year, the NRAS rent is *derived by the trustee,
or *flows indirectly to the trustee as a partner or beneficiary because
of a previous application of subsection (2) or (3); and
(b) the trustee is
liable or, but for another provision in this Act, would be liable, to be
assessed in respect of an amount (the share amount) that is:
(i) a
share of the trust’s *net income for that income year
under section 98 of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936; or
(ii) all
or a part of the trust’s net income for that income year under section 99
or 99A of that Act;
(whether or not
the share amount becomes assessable income in the hands of the trustee); and
(c) the trustee’s *share of the NRAS rent under section 380‑30 is a positive
amount (whether or not the trustee actually receives any of that share).
Note: A trustee to whom NRAS rent
flows indirectly under this subsection is entitled to a tax offset under
section 380‑15 and the NRAS rent does not flow indirectly through the
trustee to another entity.
(5) *NRAS
rent flows indirectly through an entity (the first
entity) to another entity if, and only if:
(a) the other entity
is the focal entity in an item of the table in section 380‑30 in relation
to the NRAS rent; and
(b) that focal
entity’s *share of the NRAS rent is based on the
first entity’s share of the NRAS rent as an intermediary entity in that or
another item of the table.
380‑30 Share of NRAS rent
Object of section
(1) The object of this
section is to ensure that:
(a) *NRAS rent derived by a partnership or the trustee of a trust is
allocated notionally amongst entities who *derive
benefits from that NRAS rent; and
(b) that allocation
corresponds with the way in which those benefits were derived.
(2) An entity’s share
of *NRAS rent is an amount notionally allocated to the entity as its
share of the NRAS rent, whether or not the entity actually receives any of that
NRAS rent.
(3) That amount is equal to
the entity’s share of the *NRAS
rent as the focal entity in column 3 of an item of the table.
Note: An entity’s share of the NRAS
rent is based on the share of the NRAS rent of each preceding intermediary
entity through which the NRAS rent flows, starting from the intermediary entity
to whom the NRAS rent is paid.
This means that in some
cases (see items 2 and 4 of the table), more than one item of the table
will need to be applied to work out the share of the NRAS rent of an ultimate
recipient of the NRAS rent.
|
Share of NRAS rent
|
|
Item
|
Column
1
For
this intermediary entity and this focal entity:
|
Column
2
The
intermediary entity’s share of the NRAS rent is:
|
Column
3
The
focal entity’s share of the NRAS rent is:
|
|
1
|
a partnership is the intermediary
entity and a partner in that partnership is the focal entity
if:
(a) *NRAS rent is *derived by the
partnership; and
(b) the partner has, in respect of the
partnership, an individual interest mentioned in subsection 380‑25(2)
|
the NRAS rent
|
so much of the NRAS rent as is taken into
account in working out the amount of that individual interest
|
|
2
|
a partnership is the intermediary
entity and a partner in that partnership is the focal entity
if:
(a) *NRAS rent *flows indirectly to
the partnership as a beneficiary of a trust; and
(b) the partner has, in respect of the
partnership, an individual interest mentioned in subsection 380‑25(2)
|
the amount worked out under column 3 of
item 3 or 4 of this table where the partnership, as a beneficiary, is
the focal entity in that item
|
so much of the amount worked out under
column 2 of this item as is attributable to the partner, having regard to the
partnership agreement and any other relevant circumstances
|
|
3
|
the trustee of a trust is the intermediary
entity and the trustee or a beneficiary of the trust is the focal
entity if:
(a) *NRAS rent is *derived by the
trustee; and
(b) the trustee or beneficiary has, in
respect of the trust, a share amount mentioned in subsection 380‑25(3)
or (4)
|
(a) if the trust has a positive amount of *net income for that year—the NRAS rent; or
(b) otherwise—nil
|
so much of the amount worked out under
column 2 of this item as is taken into account in working out that share
amount
|
|
4
|
the trustee of a trust is the intermediary
entity and the trustee or a beneficiary of the trust is the focal
entity if:
(a) *NRAS rent *flows indirectly to
the trustee as a partner in a partnership or as a beneficiary of another
trust; and
(b) the trustee or beneficiary has, in
respect of the trust, a share amount mentioned in subsection 380‑25(3)
or (4)
|
the amount worked out under column 3 of:
(a) item 1 or 2 of this table where the
trustee, as a partner, is the focal entity in that item; or
(b) item 3 or a previous application of
this item where the trustee, as a beneficiary, is the focal entity in that
item
|
so much of the amount worked out under
column 2 of this item as is attributable to the focal entity in this item,
having regard to the trust deed and any other relevant circumstances
|
Note: In item 3 or 4 of the
table, the trustee of a trust can be both the intermediary entity and the focal
entity in the same item.
Miscellaneous
380‑32 Amended certificates
A reference in this
Subdivision to an *NRAS certificate in relation to an *NRAS year is to be treated as a reference to an amended NRAS
certificate in relation to the NRAS year, if the *Housing
Secretary issues such an amended certificate.
Subdivision 380‑B—Payments made in relation to the National Rental
Affordability Scheme etc.
Table
of sections
380‑35 Payments made and non‑cash
benefits provided in relation to the National Rental Affordability Scheme
380‑35 Payments made and non‑cash
benefits provided in relation to the National Rental Affordability Scheme
A payment made to you,
or a *non‑cash benefit provided to you, (whether
directly or indirectly, such as through an *NRAS
consortium of which you are a *member) by:
(a) a Department of a
State or Territory; or
(b) a body (whether
incorporated or not) established for a public purpose by or under a law of a
State or Territory;
in relation to your participation in the *National Rental Affordability Scheme is not assessable income and is
not *exempt income.
Division 385—Primary production
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 385
385‑E Primary producer can elect to
spread or defer tax on profit from forced disposal or death of live stock
385‑F Insurance for loss of live
stock or trees
385‑G Double wool clips
385‑H Rules that apply to all
elections made under Subdivisions 385‑E, 385‑F and 385‑G
Guide to Division 385
385‑1 What this Division is about
This Division
contains rules that are specific to primary producers.
Table of sections
385‑5 Where to find some other
rules relevant to primary producers
385‑5 Where to find some other rules
relevant to primary producers
|
Rules
relevant to primary producers
|
|
Item
|
For
rules about this topic:
|
See:
|
|
1
|
The rules about assessable income arising
from disposals of trading stock apply to live stock, because live stock is
trading stock.
|
Subdivision 70‑D
|
|
2
|
The rules about assessable income arising
from disposals of trading stock apply to:
(a) standing or growing crops; and
(b) crop‑stools; and
(c) trees planted and tended for sale.
|
Subdivision 70‑D
|
|
3
|
There are some capital allowances for
primary producers and some other land‑holders.
|
Subdivisions 40‑F and 40‑G
|
|
4
|
Long‑term averaging of some primary
producers’ tax liability (by tax offsets and extra income tax)
|
Division 392
|
Subdivision 385‑E—Primary producer can elect to spread or defer tax on profit
from forced disposal or death of live stock
Guide to Subdivision 385‑E
385‑90 What this Subdivision is
about
You
can elect to exclude from your assessable income the profit on a forced
disposal or death of live stock that you held as assets of a primary production
business you carry on in Australia.
The excluded profit
is then brought into your assessable income over a 5 year period in one of 2
ways.
Table
of sections
385‑95 Basic principles for
elections under this Subdivision
Operative provisions
385‑100 Cases where you can make
an election
385‑105 Election to spread tax
profit over 5 years
385‑110 Alternative election to
defer tax profit and reduce cost of replacement live stock
385‑115 Your assessable income
includes an amount for replacement live stock you breed
385‑120 Purchase price of
replacement live stock is reduced
385‑125 Alternative election
because of bovine tuberculosis has effect over 10 years not 5
385‑95 Basic principles for
elections under this Subdivision
(1) You can elect:
to spread the profit on the disposal or
death over the income year of the disposal or death and the next 4 income years
(election to spread); or
to defer including the profit in your
assessable income, if you will use the proceeds of the disposal or death mainly
to replace the live stock (election to defer).
(2) If you make an election
to defer, the profit is “used” over the next 5 income years:
by reducing the amount for which you
are taken to have bought replacement stock (as a result, your tax profit on the
disposal of the replacement stock is increased); and
by including in your assessable income
amounts for replacement stock that you breed.
Any unused part of the profit is included
in your assessable income for the fifth income year.
Operative provisions
385‑100 Cases where you can make an
election
(1) You can make an election
if:
(a) you dispose of *live stock, or they die, because:
(i) land
is compulsorily acquired or resumed under an Act; or
(ii) a
State or Territory leases land for a cattle tick eradication campaign; or
(iii) pasture
or fodder is destroyed by fire, drought or flood and you will use the *proceeds of the disposal or death mainly to buy replacement stock or
to maintain breeding stock for the purpose of replacing the live stock; or
(iv) they
are compulsorily destroyed under an *Australian law for
the control of a *disease or they die of such a *disease; or
(v) you
receive an official notification under an *Australian
law dealing with contamination of property; and
(b) you held the live
stock as assets of a *primary production business you
carry on in Australia; and
(c) apart from this
Subdivision, your assessable income for any income year would include the *proceeds of the disposal or death.
(2) The proceeds of
the disposal or death are:
(a) if you dispose of
the *live stock or their carcases in the
ordinary course of *business—the total of:
(i) any
amount you receive as payment for the live stock or carcases; and
(ii) any
compensation you receive for the death or destruction, or a reduction in *market value, of the live stock or their carcases from an *Australian government agency; or
(b) if you dispose of
the *live stock or their carcases outside the
ordinary course of *business—the total of:
(i) the
market value of the live stock or their carcases, at the time of disposal; and
(ii) any
compensation you receive for the death or destruction, or a reduction in market
value, of the live stock or their carcases from an *Australian
government agency; or
(c) if the *live stock die, and you do not dispose of their carcases to someone
else—any compensation you receive for their death or destruction from an *Australian government agency.
385‑105 Election to spread tax
profit over 5 years
(1) You can elect:
(a) to include in
your assessable income for the *disposal year the *proceeds of the disposal or death, reduced by the *tax profit on the disposal or death; and
(b) to include 20% of
the tax profit on the disposal or death in your assessable income for the
disposal year; and
(c) to include 20% of
the tax profit on the disposal or death in your assessable income for each of
the next 4 income years.
For rules about the making and effect of
an election, see Subdivision 385‑H.
(2) The disposal year
is the income year in which you dispose of the *live
stock, or they die, as mentioned in subsection 385‑100(1).
(3) The tax profit on
the disposal or death is any amount remaining after subtracting from
the *proceeds of the disposal or death the sum
of:
(a) the amount paid
or payable for the purchase of as many of the *live
stock as you purchased during the income year; and
(b) the *value of the rest of the live stock as *trading
stock on hand at the start of the income year.
385‑110 Alternative election to
defer tax profit and reduce cost of replacement live stock
(1) Alternatively, you can
elect:
(a) to include in
your assessable income for the *disposal year the *proceeds of the disposal or death, reduced by the *tax profit on the disposal or death; and
(b) to reduce the
cost of replacement *live stock you buy in the
disposal year (or any of the next 5 income years) by amounts totalling not more
than the tax profit on the disposal or death; and
(c) to include in
your assessable income for the last of the 5 income years following the
disposal year any *unused tax profit on the disposal or death
on the last day of that year.
Note: If the election is made because
of bovine tuberculosis, it has effect over 10 income years instead of 5: see
section 385‑125.
For rules about the making and effect of
an election, see Subdivision 385‑H
(2) However, you can only
make this election if you will use the *proceeds
of the disposal or death mainly to buy replacement *live
stock, or to maintain breeding stock for the purpose of replacing the live
stock that were disposed of or died.
(3) The unused tax
profit on the disposal or death is the *tax profit on the disposal or death less the total of:
(a) the amounts
included in your assessable income under section 385‑115 for replacement
animals you breed; and
(b) the amounts by
which the amount paid or payable for the purchase of replacement animals is
reduced under section 385‑120.
385‑115 Your assessable income
includes an amount for replacement live stock you breed
If you make the
election in section 385‑110, then for the *disposal
year and each of the next 5 income years, your assessable income includes any
amount you choose for each replacement animal you breed during that income
year. (However, you can choose not to include an amount.)
385‑120 Purchase price of
replacement live stock is reduced
(1) If you make the election
in section 385‑110, then the amount paid or payable for the purchase of
each replacement animal you buy in the *disposal
year, or in the next 5 income years, is treated as if it were reduced by the *reduction amount.
Meaning of reduction amount
(2) The reduction
amount is:
so much of the *tax profit on the
disposal or death as is attributable to live stock of the species you are
replacing;
divided by:
the number of animals of that species that you disposed of or that
died.
(3) However,
if:
(a) you purchase a
replacement animal of a different species from the *live
stock it replaces; and
(b) you pay
substantially more for it than you could have paid for a replacement animal of
the same species;
the reduction amount for
the animal is any reasonable amount at least equal to the amount worked out
under subsection (2).
Exception to avoid reducing unused tax
profit to less than nil
(4) However, if applying subsection (1)
to a particular purchase would reduce the *unused
tax profit on the disposal or death to less than nil, instead reduce the amount
paid or payable for the purchase of each replacement animal in that purchase
by:
the *unused tax profit on the disposal or
death;
divided by:
the number of animals in the purchase.
385‑125 Alternative election because
of bovine tuberculosis has effect over 10 years not 5
If you can make an
election under this Subdivision because:
(a) *live stock are compulsorily destroyed under an *Australian law for the control of bovine tuberculosis; or
(b) *live stock die of that *disease;
sections 385‑110 to 385‑120 apply as
if they referred to 10 income years instead of 5 years.
Subdivision 385‑F—Insurance for loss of live stock or trees
Table of sections
385‑130 Insurance for loss of live
stock or trees
385‑130 Insurance for loss of live
stock or trees
If your assessable
income for an income year would otherwise include an insurance recovery for a
loss of *live stock, or for a loss by fire of
trees, that you hold as assets of a *primary production
business you carry on in Australia, you can elect:
(a) to
include only 20% of the insurance recovery in your assessable income for that
income year; and
(b) to include 20% of
the insurance recovery in your assessable income for each of the next 4 income
years.
For rules about the making and effect of
an election, see Subdivision 385‑H.
Subdivision 385‑G—Double wool clips
Table of sections
385‑135 Election to defer
including profit on second wool clip
385‑135 Election to defer including
profit on second wool clip
(1) If your assessable
income for an income year would otherwise include the *proceeds
of the sale of 2 wool clips because fire, drought or flood causes you to shear
your sheep earlier than normal, you can elect to include in your assessable
income for the next income year the *profit
on the sale of the earlier than normal wool clip.
For rules about the making and effect of
an election, see Subdivision 385‑H.
(2) However, at the time the
wool was shorn, the sheep must have been assets of a *primary
production business you carried on in Australia. Also, the fire, drought or
flood must have been in an area of Australia where you carried on that business
at that time.
(3) The proceeds of
the sale of 2 wool clips are:
(a) the proceeds of
the sale of the earlier than normal wool clip; and
(b) an
amount covered by one or more of the following:
(i) proceeds
of the sale of another wool clip in the income year;
(ii) proceeds
of the sale of wool shorn in the previous income year that you hold at the
start of the income year and that you took into account at cost in working out
the *value of your *trading
stock under Division 60 at the end of the previous income year;
(iii) an
amount for wool shorn in the previous income year that is included in your
assessable income of the income year because of a previous election under this
section.
(4) The profit on the
sale of the earlier than normal wool clip is the proceeds of the sale
of the wool clip that would otherwise be included in your assessable income for
the income year, less the expenses you incur in the income year that are
directly attributable to the earlier shearing and sale.
Subdivision 385‑H—Rules that apply to all elections made under Subdivisions 385‑E,
385‑F and 385‑G
Table of sections
385‑145 Partnerships and trusts
385‑150 Time for making election
385‑155 Amounts are assessable
income from carrying on the primary production business
385‑160 Effect of certain events
on election
385‑163 Disentitling events
385‑165 New partnership can elect
to be treated as same entity as old partnership
385‑170 New partnership can elect
to take advantage of election made by former owner of the business
385‑145 Partnerships and trusts
If a partnership or
trustee carries on a *primary production business, only
the partnership or trustee can make an election under Subdivision 385‑E,
385‑F or 385‑G.
385‑150 Time for making election
You can only make an
election under Subdivision 385‑E, 385‑F or 385‑G before you lodge your *income tax return for the last income year for which your assessable
income would (apart from the election) include any of:
(a) the *proceeds of the disposal or death of *live
stock; or
(b) the insurance
recovery for the loss of *live stock or trees; or
(c) the *proceeds of the sale of the 2 wool clips.
The Commissioner may allow you further
time to make the election.
385‑155 Amounts are assessable
income from carrying on the primary production business
The following are taken
to be assessable income from carrying on a *primary
production business in Australia:
(a) an amount
included in your assessable income because of an election under Subdivision 385‑E,
385‑F or 385‑G; or
(b) an amount included
in your assessable income because of section 385‑160 (Effect of certain
events on election).
385‑160 Effect of certain events on
election
(1) You cannot make an
election under Subdivision 385‑E, 385‑F or 385‑G after a *disentitling event happens.
(2) If a *disentitling event happens after you make an election under
Subdivision 385‑E, 385‑F or 385‑G, your assessable income for the income
year in which the event happens includes:
(a) the *proceeds of the disposal or death of *live
stock; or
(b) the insurance
recovery for the loss of *live stock or trees; or
(c) the *proceeds of the sale of 2 wool clips;
reduced by each amount that, because of
the election, is included in your assessable income for that or an earlier
income year.
(3) However, if a *disentitling event happens after you make an election under
section 385‑110 (Alternative election to defer tax profit and reduce cost
of replacement live stock), your assessable income for the income year in which
the event happens includes any *unused tax profit on the
disposal or death on the last day of that income year.
385‑163 Disentitling events
(1) A
disentitling event happens when:
(a) you
die; or
(b) you become
bankrupt, insolvent, commence to be wound up, apply to take the benefit of a
law for the relief of bankrupt or insolvent debtors, compound with creditors,
or make an assignment of any property for the benefit of creditors; or
(c) you leave Australia permanently, or it appears to the Commissioner that you are about to do so; or
(d) you cease to
carry on the *primary production business to which the
election relates.
(2) In
the case of a partnership, a disentitling event happens when:
(a) a
partner in the partnership becomes bankrupt, insolvent, commences to be wound
up, applies to take the benefit of a law for the relief of bankrupt or
insolvent debtors, compounds with creditors, or makes an assignment of any
property for the benefit of creditors; or
(b) a partner leaves Australia permanently, or it appears to the Commissioner that a partner is about to do so;
or
(c) the partnership
ceases to carry on the *primary production
business to which the election relates; or
(d) there is a
variation in the constitution of the partnership or the interests of the
partners.
(3) In the case of a trust,
a disentitling event happens when:
(b) an order for the
administration of the trust estate is made under a law relating to bankruptcy;
or
(c) a beneficiary
becomes bankrupt, insolvent, commences to be wound up, applies to take the
benefit of a law for the relief of bankrupt or insolvent debtors, compounds
with creditors, or makes an assignment of any property for the benefit of
creditors; or
(d) the trustee or a
beneficiary leaves Australia permanently, or it appears to the Commissioner
that the trustee or a beneficiary is about to do so; or
(e) the trustee
ceases to carry on the *primary production
business to which the election relates.
(4) However,
in the case of a trust, a disentitling event does not happen if:
(a) either:
(i) the
disentitling event is covered by paragraph 3(c); or
(ii) the
disentitling event is covered by paragraph 3(d) and a beneficiary leaves
Australia permanently, or it appears to the Commissioner that a beneficiary is
about to do so; and
(b) the Commissioner
makes a determination under subsection (5).
(5) The Commissioner may
make a determination for the purpose of subsection (4) if it is fair and
reasonable to do so having regard to:
(a) the nature of the
*disentitling event to which subsection (3) applies; and
(b) any relevant
circumstances relating to the beneficiary mentioned in paragraph (3)(c) or
(d); and
(c) any other
relevant circumstances relating to the trust; and
(d) any other matters
the Commissioner considers relevant.
(6) A determination made
under subsection (5) must be made in writing.
(7) The Commissioner must
give the trustee of the trust a copy of the determination.
385‑165 New partnership can elect to
be treated as same entity as old partnership
(1) Under Subdivision 385‑E,
385‑F or 385‑G a new partnership can elect to be treated as a continuation of
an old partnership that would otherwise cease to exist if:
(a) it immediately
takes over the relevant *primary production
business of the old partnership; and
(b) partners,
together entitled to at least 25% of the income of the new partnership, were
also partners in the old partnership.
(2) The new partnership must
make this election before it lodges its *income
tax return for the income year in which it takes over the *business.
385‑170 New partnership can elect to
take advantage of election made by former owner of the business
(1) If an entity (except a
partnership):
(a) has made an
election under Subdivision 385‑E, 385‑F or 385‑G; and
(b) transfers the
relevant *primary production business to a
partnership; and
(c) is entitled to at
least 25% of the income of that partnership;
the partnership may elect to apply the
Subdivision under which the entity made the election to all future events as if
it were that entity.
(2) The
partnership must make this election before it lodges its *income tax return for the income year in which the *business is transferred to it.
Division 392—Long‑term averaging of primary producers’
tax liability
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 392
392‑A Is your income tax affected by
averaging?
392‑B What kind of averaging
adjustment must you make?
392‑C How big is your averaging
adjustment?
392‑D Effect of permanent reduction
of your basic taxable income
Guide to Division 392
392‑1 What this Division is about
If you are a primary
producer for 2 or more years in a row, this Division evens out your income tax
liability from year to year. (It does so by reducing the effect that
fluctuations in your taxable income have on the marginal rates of tax that
apply to you from year to year.)
Table of sections
392‑5 Overview of averaging
process
392‑5 Overview of averaging process
How averaging adjustments work
(1) This Division reduces or
increases your income tax liability to bring it closer to what it would have
been if worked out using a special rate of income tax. That rate (the
comparison rate) is based on the income tax that you would pay for the current
year on the average of your taxable income for up to the last 5 income years.
Example: The graph shows how averaging
taxable income reduces the effect of variations in taxable income (giving a
fairly steady comparison rate from year to year).

Tax offset as averaging adjustment
(2) You may be entitled to a
tax offset if the income tax you would pay on your basic taxable income for the
current year at the comparison rate is less than the income tax you
would pay on that income (apart from this Division and certain other
provisions).
See the examples of years 5, 6, 7 and 9
in the graph in subsection (4).
Extra income tax as averaging
adjustment
(3) You may be liable to
extra income tax on some or all of your basic taxable income for the current
year if the income tax you would pay on your basic taxable income for the
current year at the comparison rate is more than the income tax on that
income (apart from this Division and certain other provisions).
See the examples of years 8 and 10 in
the graph in subsection (4).
Example of the effect of averaging
(4) The graph shows an
example of the effect of averaging, using the same income figures as the graph
in the example in subsection (1).

Note: The example assumes that all
the basic taxable income was from a primary production business.
Effect of non‑primary production
income on averaging adjustment
(5) Your income from sources
other than your primary production business may affect the adjustment of your
income tax. If more than $5,000 of your basic taxable income is attributable to
those sources, your averaging adjustment will be reduced to reflect the
proportion of your basic taxable income attributable to primary production.
(There are special shading‑out arrangements if your taxable income from other
sources is between $5,000 and $10,000.)
No adjustment in certain cases
(6) Your income tax will not
be adjusted under this Division in certain cases. In particular, you can choose
not to have your income tax adjusted under this Division for the rest of your
life.
Subdivision 392‑A—Is your income tax affected by averaging?
Table
of sections
392‑10 Individuals who carry on
a primary production business
392‑15 Meaning of basic
taxable income
392‑20 Trust beneficiaries taken
to be carrying on primary production business
392‑22 Trustee may choose that a
beneficiary is a chosen beneficiary of the trust
392‑25 Choosing not to have your
income tax averaged
392‑10 Individuals who carry on a
primary production business
(1) This Division applies to
your assessment for the *current year if:
(a) you are an
individual; and
(b) you have carried
on a *primary production business in Australia for 2 or more income years in a row (the last of which is the current year); and
(c) for at least one
of those income years your *basic taxable income is
less than or equal to your basic taxable income for the next of those income
years.
Note 1: It follows that this Division
does not apply if your basic taxable income has decreased every income
year since you started carrying on a primary production business.
Note 2: In working out whether this
Division applies to your assessment for an income year, you may need to take
account of income years before the 1998‑99 income year: see section 392‑1
of the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997.
Continued application of this Division
after you stop carrying on a primary production business
(2) This Division also
applies to your assessment for the *current year if:
(a) this Division
applied to your assessment for an earlier income year during which you carried
on a *primary production business in Australia; and
(b) you do not carry
on that business during the current year; and
(c) at least one of
the following conditions is met for each income year (including the current
year) after the income year in which you stopped carrying on that business:
(i) your
assessable income for the income year included assessable income that was *derived from, or resulted from, your having carried on that
business;
(ii) you
carried on a *primary production business in Australia during the income year.
Note: In working out whether this
Division applies to your assessment for an income year, you may need to take
account of income years before the 1998‑99 income year. See section 392‑1
of the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997.
392‑15 Meaning of basic taxable
income
(1) Work out your basic
taxable income for an income year as follows:
Method
statement
Step 1. Work out what would have been your taxable income for the income
year if your assessable income for the income year:
(a) had
not included any amount under section 82‑65, 82‑70 or 302‑145 of
the Income Tax Assessment Act 1997 (certain superannuation benefits and
employment termination payments); and
Note: This
means that certain deductions will also be excluded.
(b) had
not included any *net capital gain for the
income year.
Step 2. Subtract
from the Step 1 amount any *above‑average special
professional income included in your taxable income for the income year under
Division 405.
(2) However, your basic
taxable income for an income year is nil if:
(a) you do not have a
taxable income for the income year; or
(b) the amount worked
out under subsection (1) for the income year is less than nil.
392‑20 Trust beneficiaries taken to
be carrying on primary production business
(1) You are taken to carry
on a *primary production business carried on by
a trust during an income year if you satisfy the requirements in subsection (2),
(3) or (4).
Primary production business carried on
by a trust with beneficiary presently entitled to income of the trust
(2) You satisfy the
requirements in this subsection if:
(a) you are a
beneficiary of the trust referred to in subsection (1); and
(b) you are presently
entitled to a share of the income of the trust for the income year; and
(c) if you are
presently entitled to less than $1,040 of the income of the trust for the
income year—the Commissioner is satisfied that your interest in the trust was
not acquired or granted wholly or primarily to enable your income tax to be
adjusted under this Division.
Primary production business carried on
by a fixed trust with no income of the trust
(3) You satisfy the
requirements in this subsection if:
(a) you are a
beneficiary of the trust referred to in subsection (1); and
(b) at all times
during the income year, the manner or extent to which each beneficiary of the
trust can benefit from the trust is not capable of being significantly affected
by the exercise, or non‑exercise, of a power; and
(c) the trust does
not have any income of the trust for the income year to which a beneficiary of
the trust could be presently entitled; and
(d) if the trust had
income of the trust for the income year, you would have been presently entitled
to a share of the income of the trust.
Primary production business carried on
by a non‑fixed trust with no income of the trust
(4) You satisfy the
requirements in this subsection if you do not satisfy the requirements in subsection (3)
and you are a chosen beneficiary of the trust referred to in subsection (1)
for the purposes of section 392‑22 for the income year.
Corporate unit trusts and public
trading trusts
(5) You are not taken to
carry on a *primary production business carried on by
the trustee of:
(a) a corporate unit
trust (as defined in section 102J of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936,
which deals with corporate unit trusts); or
(b) a public trading
trust (as defined in section 102R of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936,
which deals with public trading trusts).
392‑22 Trustee may choose that a
beneficiary is a chosen beneficiary of the trust
(1) The trustee of a trust
may choose that a beneficiary of the trust is a chosen beneficiary of the trust
for an income year if the trust does not have income of the trust for the
income year to which a beneficiary of the trust could be presently entitled.
(2) The maximum number of
choices that the trustee may make in respect of the trust for an income year is
the higher of:
(a) the number of
individuals that were taken to be carrying on a *primary
production business carried on by the trust under subsection 392‑20(1) in
the income year immediately before the current income year; and
(b) 12.
(3) A choice made under subsection (1)
must be:
(a) in writing; and
(b) signed by the
trustee and the person chosen.
(4) The trustee can make the
choice no later than the time it lodges the trust’s *income
tax return for the income year to which the choice relates. However, the
Commissioner can allow the trustee to make a choice at a later time.
(5) A choice cannot be
revoked or varied.
392‑25 Choosing not to have your income
tax averaged
(1) You can choose that this
Division (except this section) not apply to your assessment for an income year.
If you make this choice, this Division (except this section) does not apply to
your assessment for the income year or any later income year.
(2) You must make your
choice in writing and give it to the Commissioner by the time you lodge your *income tax return for the income year to which your choice relates.
However, the Commissioner may allow you to give the choice later.
(3) Your choice cannot be
revoked after it is given to the Commissioner.
Subdivision 392‑B—What kind of averaging adjustment must you make?
Guide to Subdivision 392‑B
392‑30 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision
explains how to work out whether you are entitled to a tax offset for the
current year or whether you must pay extra income tax for the current year.
Table of sections
Tax offset or extra income tax
392‑35 Will you get a tax offset
or have to pay extra income tax?
How
to work out the comparison rate
392‑40 Identify income years for
averaging your basic taxable income
392‑45 Work out your average
income for those years
392‑50 Work out the income tax
on your average income at basic rates
392‑55 Work out the comparison
rate
Tax offset or extra
income tax
392‑35 Will you get a tax offset or
have to pay extra income tax?
(1) Compare:
(a) the amount (the income
tax you would pay at the comparison rate) worked out using the formula:

(b) the amount of
income tax that you would pay on your *basic taxable
income for the *current year at *basic
rates.
Note: You must disregard some
provisions of this Act in working out amounts of income tax for the purposes of
this subsection: see subsection (5).
Tax offset
(2) You are entitled to a *tax offset equal to the *averaging
adjustment worked out under Subdivision 392‑C if the income tax you would
pay at the comparison rate is less than the amount of income tax you
would pay at *basic rates.
Extra income tax
(3) You must pay extra
income tax on the *averaging component of your *basic taxable income if the income tax you would pay at the
comparison rate is more than the amount of income tax you would pay at *basic rates.
Note 1: Section 12A of the Income
Tax Rates Act 1986 sets the rate at which you must pay extra income tax on
the averaging component of your basic taxable income.
Note 2: It does so in such a way that,
generally, the extra income tax you must pay equals the averaging adjustment
worked out under Subdivision 392‑C.
Meaning of basic rates
(4) The basic rates
at which you would pay income tax are:
(a) if you are a
resident taxpayer as defined in the Income Tax Rates Act 1986—the rates
of income tax in paragraph (1)(b) of Part I of Schedule 7 to
that Act, taking into account the way it would apply with any changes to your
tax‑free threshold under section 20 of that Act; or
(b) if you are a non‑resident
taxpayer as defined in the Income Tax Rates Act 1986—the rates of income
tax in paragraph 1(b) of Part II of Schedule 7 to that Act.
Disregard certain provisions in
working out amounts
(5) Work out the amount of
income tax mentioned in paragraph (1)(b) as if:
(a) the following
provisions did not apply:
(i) this
Division;
(ii) section 94
(Partner not having control and disposal of share in partnership income) of the
Income Tax Assessment Act 1936;
(iii) Division 6AA
(Income of certain children) of Part III of the Income Tax Assessment
Act 1936;
(iv) Part VIIB
(Medicare levy) of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936; and
(b) you were not
entitled to any rebate or credit under the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936
or to any *tax offset under this Act.
No adjustment
(6) This Division does not
affect your income tax for the *current year if the
income tax you would pay at the *comparison rate equals
the amount of income tax you would pay at *basic
rates.
Note: The 2 amounts will be equal
if:
·
your basic taxable income and your average
income are both below the tax‑free threshold; or
·
your average income equals your basic taxable
income for the current year.
How to work out the
comparison rate
392‑40 Identify income years for
averaging your basic taxable income
The income years over
which you must average your *basic taxable income
are:
(a) if this Division
has applied to your assessment for at least 4 income years in a row (including
the *current year)—the current year and the 4
previous income years; or
(b) if this Division
has applied to your assessment for less than 4 income years in a row (including
the *current year)—those income years and the
last income year before them.
Note: You may need to average your
basic taxable income for one or more income years before the 1998‑99 income
year. See section 392‑1 of the Income Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act
1997.
392‑45 Work out your average income
for those years
(1) Work
out your average income in this way:
Method statement
Step 1. Add up your *basic taxable income for
each of the income years over which you must average your basic taxable income.
Step 2. Divide the sum by the number of those income years.
Step 3. Round the result down to the nearest whole dollar if the result
is not already a number of whole dollars.
(2) Your basic
assessable income for an income year is your assessable income for the
income year, less:
(a) any amount
included in your assessable income section 82‑65, 82‑70 or 302‑145 of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1997 (certain employment termination payments and
superannuation benefits); and
(b) any *net capital gain included in your assessable income under Division 102
of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1997.
392‑50 Work out the income tax on
your average income at basic rates
Work out the amount of
income tax that you would pay on your *average income for
the *current year at *basic
rates.
392‑55 Work out the comparison rate
Work
out the comparison rate using the formula:

Subdivision 392‑C—How big is your averaging adjustment?
Guide to Subdivision 392‑C
392‑60 What this Subdivision is
about
This Subdivision
explains how to work out the amount of the averaging adjustment of your income
tax for the current year (whether it is a tax offset or is used by the Income
Tax Rates Act 1986 to set the rate at which you must pay extra income tax).
Table of sections
392‑65 What your averaging
adjustment reflects
Your gross averaging amount
392‑70 Working out your gross
averaging amount
Your averaging adjustment
392‑75 Working out your
averaging adjustment
How to work out your averaging
component
392‑80 Work out your taxable
primary production income
392‑85 Work out your taxable non‑primary
production income
392‑90 Work out your averaging
component
392‑65 What your averaging
adjustment reflects
(1) Your averaging
adjustment is a proportion of your gross averaging amount, taking account of:
(a) your taxable
primary production income (the part of your basic taxable income from your
primary production business); and
(b) your taxable non‑primary
production income (the part of your basic taxable income from other sources).
Your averaging component is the means of
taking into account the different parts of your basic taxable income in working
out your averaging adjustment.
(2) If your taxable non‑primary
production income is less than or equal to $5,000, your averaging component
equals the whole of your basic taxable income. (In other words, your averaging
component includes all of your taxable primary production income and all of
your taxable non‑primary production income.)
(3) If your taxable non‑primary
production income is between $5,000 and $10,000, a shading‑out system applies
so that your averaging component includes some of your taxable non‑primary
production income as well as all of your taxable primary production income.
(4) If your taxable non‑primary
production income is $10,000 or more, your averaging component equals your
taxable primary production income. Your averaging component does not include
any of your taxable non‑primary production income.
(5) The following diagram
shows examples of these relationships.

The second and third columns show that as
taxable non‑primary production income increases above $5,000 (up to a maximum
of $10,000), less of it is counted in the averaging component.
Your gross averaging
amount
392‑70 Working out your gross
averaging amount
Your gross
averaging amount is the amount of the difference between the following
amounts worked out under section 392‑35:
(a) the income tax
you would pay at the comparison rate;
(b) the amount of
income tax that you would pay on your *basic taxable
income for the *current year at *basic
rates.
Your averaging
adjustment
392‑75 Working out your averaging
adjustment
Work
out your averaging adjustment for the *current
year using the formula:

How to work out your
averaging component
392‑80 Work out your taxable primary
production income
(1) Work out your taxable
primary production income for the *current
year in this way:
Method
statement
Step 1. Compare your *assessable primary
production income for the *current year with your *primary production deductions for the current year.
Step 2. If your assessable primary
production income is larger than your primary production deductions, your taxable
primary production income is the difference between them.
Step 3. If your primary production deductions are larger than (or equal
to) your assessable primary production income, your taxable primary
production income is nil.
Assessable primary production income
(2) Your assessable
primary production income for the *current
year is the amount of your *basic assessable income
for the current year that was *derived from, or
resulted from, your carrying on a *primary production
business.
Primary production deductions
(3) Your primary
production deductions for the *current year are:
(a) all amounts you
can deduct that relate exclusively to your *assessable
primary production income for the current year; and
(b) so much of any
other amounts you can deduct (other than *apportionable
deductions) to the extent that they reasonably relate to your assessable
primary production income for the current year.
392‑85 Work out your taxable non‑primary
production income
(1) Work out your taxable
non‑primary production income for the *current
year in this way:
Method statement
Step 1. Compare your *assessable non‑primary
production income for the *current year with your *non‑primary production deductions for the current year.
Step 2. If your assessable non‑primary
production income is larger than your non‑primary production deductions, your taxable
non‑primary production income is the difference between them.
Step 3. If your non‑primary production deductions are larger than (or
equal to) your assessable non‑primary production income, your taxable non‑primary
production income is nil.
Assessable non‑primary production
income
(2) Your assessable
non‑primary production income for the *current
year is the difference between:
(a) your *basic assessable income for the current year; and
(b) your *assessable primary production income for the current year.
Non‑primary production deductions
(3) Your non‑primary
production deductions for the *current year are
the difference between:
(a) the sum of your
deductions for the current year; and
(b) your *primary production deductions for the current year.
392‑90 Work out your averaging
component
(1) Work out your averaging
component for the *current year using the
following table, taking into account:
(a) your *taxable primary production income for the current year; and
(b) your *taxable non‑primary production income for the current year.
|
Averaging
component
|
|
|
If *taxable
|
The
averaging component equals:
|
|
Item
|
non‑primary
production income:
|
for *taxable primary production income > 0
|
for *taxable primary production income = 0
|
|
1
|
is nil
|
*Basic taxable income
|
Nil
|
|
2
|
is more
than nil but does not exceed $5,000
|
*Basic taxable income
|
*Basic taxable income
|
|
3
|
exceeds $5,000 but does not exceed
$10,000
|
*Taxable primary production income plus *non‑primary production shade‑out amount
|
*Non‑primary production shade‑out amount
|
|
4
|
is $10,000 or more
|
*Taxable primary production income
|
Nil
|
Note: Subsections (2) and (3)
explain how to work out your non‑primary production shade‑out amount if your
taxable non‑primary production income is between $5,000 and $10,000.
Non‑primary production shade‑out
amount if your taxable primary production income is more than nil
(2) If your *taxable primary production income is more than nil, your non‑primary
production shade‑out amount is the amount worked out using the formula:

Non‑primary production shade‑out
amount if your taxable primary production income is nil
(3) If your *taxable primary production income is nil, your non‑primary
production shade‑out amount is the amount worked out using the formula:

However, if that amount is less than nil,
your non‑primary production shade‑out amount is nil.
(4) In this section:
Assessable PP income means your *assessable primary
production income for the *current year.
PP deductions means your *primary production
deductions for the *current year.
Taxable non‑PP income your *taxable non‑primary production income for
the *current year.
Subdivision 392‑D—Effect of permanent reduction of your basic taxable income
Table of sections
392‑95 You are treated as if you
had not carried on business before
392‑95 You are treated as if you had
not carried on business before
Choosing to discontinue and restart
averaging
(1) You can choose that this
Division not affect your income tax liability for an income year (the reduction
year) if you show the Commissioner that, because of retirement
from your occupation or from any other cause, your *basic
taxable income for the reduction year is permanently reduced during that year
to less than two thirds of your *average income for that
year.
(1A) You must make the choice
by notifying the Commissioner in writing by the day you lodge your *income tax return for the reduction year. However, the Commissioner
can allow you to make it later.
(1B) If you make a choice under
subsection (1), this Division applies to assessments for later income
years as if you had never carried on a *primary
production business before the reduction year.
Working out the extent of the
permanent reduction
(2) In working out the
extent of the permanent reduction, you must work out your *average income for the reduction year on the basis that your *basic assessable income for an income year taken into account in working
out your average income did not include any assessable income from
sources from which you do not usually receive assessable income.
(3) In working out the
extent of the permanent reduction, disregard a reduction in *basic taxable income to the extent that it results from a change of
assets from which assessable income was *derived
into assets from which you derive income that is not assessable income.
Division 393—Farm management deposits
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 393
393‑A Tax consequences of farm
management deposits
393‑B Meaning of farm management
deposit and owner
393‑C Special rules relating to
financial claims scheme for account‑holders with insolvent ADIs
Guide to Division 393
393‑1 What this Division is about
You can deduct a farm
management deposit you make, if:
(a) you
are an individual carrying on a primary production business (including a
primary production business you carry on as a partner in a partnership or as a
beneficiary of a trust); and
(b) you
hold the deposit for at least 12 months; and
(c) you
meet some other tests.
The amount of the
deposit withdrawn is included in your assessable income in the income year in
which it is repaid. Special rules apply if the deposit is repaid in exceptional
circumstances or in the event of an applicable natural disaster.
Farm management deposits allow you to carry over income from years
of good cash flow and to draw down on that income in years when you need the
cash. This enables you to defer the income tax on your taxable primary
production income from the income year in which you make the deposit until the
income year in which the deposit is repaid.
Note: An FMD provider must, every
calendar month, give certain information to the Agriculture Secretary about
farm management deposits: see section 398‑5 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation
Administration Act 1953.
Subdivision 393‑A—Tax consequences of farm management deposits
Table of sections
393‑5 Deduction for making
farm management deposit
393‑10 Assessability on
repayment of deposit
393‑15 Transactions to which the
deduction, assessment and 12 month rules have modified application
393‑16 Consolidation of farm
management deposits
393‑5 Deduction for making farm
management deposit
Entitlement to deduction
(1) You can deduct the
amount of a *farm management deposit for an income year
if:
(a) you are the *owner of the deposit; and
(b) the deposit is
made at a time during the year when you are an individual carrying on a *primary production business in Australia; and
(c) if during the
year, at a time after the deposit was made, you stopped carrying on a primary
production business in Australia—you started carrying on such a business again
within 120 days (whether or not during the year); and
(d) your *taxable non‑primary production income for the year is not more than
$100,000; and
(e) you do not die or
become bankrupt during the year.
Note 1: This section does not apply if
a deposit is reinvested, the term of a deposit is extended, or a deposit is
transferred at the depositor’s request: see sections 393‑15 and 393‑16.
Note 2: This Division applies to
certain partners and beneficiaries as if they were individuals who carried on a
primary production business: see subsections 393‑25(2), (3), (4), (5) and
(6).
Sum of deductions not to exceed
taxable primary production income
(2) The sum of the
deductions that you would otherwise be entitled to under this section for *farm management deposits made in the income year must not
exceed your *taxable primary production income for the
income year.
Amounts to be deducted in order of
deposits
(3) If you are entitled to
deduct amounts in respect of 2 or more deposits, deduct the amounts in the
order in which the deposits were made (until you reach the limit imposed by subsection (2)).
393‑10 Assessability on repayment of
deposit
Amount assessable
(1) Your assessable income
for an income year includes the amount worked out using the following formula,
if:
(a) you are the *owner of a *farm management deposit;
and
(b) the deposit is
repaid in full or in part in the year; and
(c) the amount worked
out using the formula is greater than nil:

Note 1: This subsection does not apply
if the deposit is reinvested, the term of the deposit is extended, or the
deposit is transferred at the depositor’s request: see sections 393‑15 and
393‑16.
Note 2: In a case where not all of the
deposit is deductible under section 393‑5, repayment of the non‑deductible
amount can take place without the amount being assessable. Once that amount is
repaid, the remainder is assessable when it is repaid, so that the deduction is
recouped.
Example: Matt makes a farm management
deposit of $120,000 on 1 April 2011. His taxable primary production income
for the 2010—11 income year is $50,000; therefore, the deposit is only partly
deductible in the year because it exceeds his taxable primary production
income. Matt makes the following withdrawals from the deposit: $45,000 on 1 May
2013, $40,000 on 1 March 2014 and $35,000 on 1 September 2015.
The unrecouped FMD
deduction immediately before the first repayment of $45,000 is $50,000. No
amount is included in his assessable income for the 2012‑2013 income year
because the difference between the unrecouped FMD deduction ($50,000) and the
amount of the deposit remaining after the repayment ($75,000) is less than nil.
The unrecouped FMD
deduction immediately before the second repayment of $40,000 is $50,000.
$15,000 is included in Matt’s assessable income for the 2013‑2014 income year
because the difference between the unrecouped FMD deduction ($50,000) and the
amount of the deposit remaining after the second repayment ($35,000) is
$15,000, which is greater than nil.
The unrecouped FMD
deduction immediately before the third repayment of $35,000 is $35,000; that
is, $50,000 less $15,000. $35,000 is included in Matt’s assessable income for
the 2015‑2016 income year; that is, the difference between the unrecouped FMD
deduction ($35,000) and the amount of the deposit remaining after the third
repayment ($0).
Unrecouped FMD deduction
(2) The unrecouped FMD
deduction in respect of a *farm management
deposit at a particular time is:
(a) if no part of the
deposit has been repaid before that time—the amount of the deduction under
section 393‑5 for making the deposit; or
(b) if one or more parts
of the deposit have been repaid before that time—the unrecouped FMD deduction
in respect of the deposit just before the most recent such repayment, reduced
by any amount included in the *owner’s assessable
income under this section as a result of that repayment.
Example: Mia makes a deposit of $3,000,
all of which is deductible. The deposit’s unrecouped FMD deduction just before
a first repayment of $1,000 is the amount of the deduction (that is, $3,000—see
paragraph (2)(a)). The deposit’s unrecouped FMD deduction just before a
second repayment is $2,000 (that is, according to paragraph (2)(b), the
unrecouped FMD deduction immediately before the first repayment ($3,000)
reduced by the $1,000 included in Mia’s assessable income as a result of the
first repayment).
Note 1: If the deposit was originally
an income equalisation deposit, see section 393‑10 of the Income Tax
(Transitional Provisions) Act 1997.
Note 1A: Subsection 393‑16(3)
affects the unrecouped FMD deduction of a consolidated farm management deposit.
Note 2: Section 393‑55
affects the unrecouped FMD deduction of a new deposit linked to an old deposit
affected by Division 2AA (Financial claims scheme for account‑holders with
insolvent ADIs) of Part II of the Banking Act 1959.
Application of Division to transfer,
reinvestment or other dealing
(3) This Division applies to
a transfer, reinvestment or other dealing with a *farm
management deposit as if it were a repayment of the deposit, if:
(a) you are the
depositor; and
(b) the transfer, reinvestment
or other dealing is on your behalf or at your request.
Note: Section 393‑15 modifies
the application of the deduction, assessment and 12 month rules to certain
transfers, reinvestments and other dealings.
Deemed repayment because of death, bankruptcy
etc.
(4) This section applies as
if a *farm management deposit had been repaid
when it became repayable, rather than when it is actually repaid, if the
deposit became repayable because of the requirement contained in the relevant
agreement as set out in item 11 of the table in section 393‑35
(death, bankruptcy etc.).
Note 1: This means that the amount of
the deposit is included in your assessable income for the income year when the
death, bankruptcy etc. occurs, rather than for any later year in which the
deposit might be repaid.
Note 2: This also means that, under
subsection 45‑120(5) in Schedule 1 to the Taxation Administration
Act 1953 (about Pay as you go (PAYG) instalments), the amount of the
deposit is included in your instalment income for the period in which the
death, bankruptcy etc. occurs.
However, under section 12‑140
in that Schedule, an amount may also be required to be withheld from the actual
payment if you do not quote your tax file number or ABN to the relevant FMD
provider.
Note 3: Section 393‑60 of this
Act may limit the operation of subsection (4) if the farm management
deposit is with an ADI that becomes a declared ADI under Division 2AA
(Financial claims scheme for account‑holders with insolvent ADIs) of
Part II of the Banking Act 1959.
393‑15 Transactions to which the
deduction, assessment and 12 month rules have modified application
(1) The
provisions mentioned in subsection (2) do not apply in relation to the
following transactions:
(a) the
immediate reinvestment of a *farm management deposit
as a farm management deposit with the same *FMD
provider;
(b) the
extension of the term of a farm management deposit (even if other terms such as
those relating to interest payable are also varied);
(c) the
transfer of a farm management deposit in accordance with a requirement of the
relevant agreement as set out in item 13 of the table in section 393‑35
(which allows for transfers of deposits at the request of the depositor).
Note: This means that these
transactions:
(a) will not result in assessable income
for the owner; and
(b) will not give rise to a deduction;
and
(c) will not, if the transaction occurs
within 12 months after the end of the day the deposit is made, result in the
deposit losing its status as a farm management deposit.
(2) The provisions are:
(a) section 393‑5
(about deductions for making a farm management deposit); and
(b) subsection 393‑10(1)
(about assessability of the repayment of a farm management deposit); and
(c) subsections 393‑40(1)
and (2) (about repayment of a farm management deposit within the first 12
months); and
(d) subsections 393‑40(3A)
and (4) (about repayment of a farm management deposit in the event of an
applicable natural disaster).
(3) For the purposes of
working out the *unrecouped FMD deduction for a deposit
that is subject to a transaction mentioned in subsection (1), the
transaction does not cause the deposit to be a different deposit.
Note: This ensures that the
unrecouped FMD deduction (which affects how much income tax is assessed in the
event of a repayment) equals the deduction for the original deposit, less any
amount included in your assessable income because of a previous repayment of
the deposit.
393‑16 Consolidation of farm
management deposits
(1) The provisions mentioned
in subsection (2) do not apply in relation to the immediate reinvestment
of 2 or more *farm management deposits (original
deposits) if:
(a) just before the
reinvestment occurs the balance of each of the original deposits is equal to
the *unrecouped FMD deduction for the deposit;
and
(b) the original
deposits are immediately reinvested as a single farm management deposit with
the same *FMD provider, or with a different FMD
provider; and
(c) just before the
reinvestment occurs the original deposits have each been held for a period of
at least 12 months.
Note: This means that the
reinvestment:
(a) will not result in assessable income
for the owner; and
(b) will not give rise to a deduction.
(2) The provisions are:
(a) section 393‑5
(about deductions for making a farm management deposit); and
(b) subsection 393‑10(1)
(about assessability of the repayment of a farm management deposit).
(3) Despite paragraph 393‑10(2)(a),
the unrecouped FMD deduction in respect of the *farm management deposit at a time before any part of the deposit has
been repaid is the sum of the unrecouped FMD deductions in respect of each of
the original deposits just before the reinvestment occurred.
(4) Section 393‑40
(about the repayment of farm management deposits within 12 months) applies as
if the new *farm management deposit was made on the
same day that the most recent of the original deposits was made.
Subdivision 393‑B—Meaning of farm management deposit and owner
Table
of sections
393‑20 Farm
management deposits
393‑25 Owners
of farm management deposits
393‑27 Trustee may choose that a
beneficiary is a chosen beneficiary of the trust
393‑28 Application of Division
to beneficiary no longer under legal disability
393‑30 Effect of contravening
requirements
393‑35 Requirements of agreement
for a farm management deposit
393‑40 Repayment of deposit
within first 12 months
393‑45 Partly repaid farm
management deposits
393‑20 Farm management deposits
Meaning of farm management deposit
(1) A
deposit with an *FMD provider is a farm management
deposit if:
(a) the
depositor applies to make the deposit in accordance with subsection (2);
and
(b) the
deposit is made under an agreement between the FMD provider and the depositor
that:
(i) describes
the deposit as a farm management deposit; and
(ii) at
all times while the deposit is with the FMD provider, contains requirements to
the effect set out in the table in section 393‑35.
The agreement may also contain additional
requirements that are not inconsistent with those set out in that table.
Depositor to provide information in
application form
(2) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(a),
the depositor must apply to the *FMD provider to make the
deposit by completing and signing a form that:
(a) permits the
depositor to state the *owner’s *tax file number in the form; and
(b) requires the
depositor to provide any other information required by regulations for the
purposes of this paragraph; and
(c) contains any
statements, required by regulations for the purposes of this paragraph, that
are to be read by the depositor when completing the form.
Note 1: A depositor who makes a false
or misleading statement in such a form commits an offence against section 8K
or 8N of the Taxation Administration Act 1953.
Note 2: If the owner does not quote
his or her tax file number or ABN to the FMD provider, the Pay as you go (PAYG)
withholding required under section 12‑140 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation
Administration Act 1953 from a repayment of the deposit is at the highest
marginal tax rate.
Note 3: Division 4A of
Part VA of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 sets out rules for
quoting tax file numbers in connection with farm management deposits.
Meaning of FMD provider
(3) In this Act:
FMD provider means an entity that:
(a) is an *ADI; or
(b) carries on in
Australia the *business of banking, so long as the
Commonwealth, a State or a Territory guarantees the repayment of any deposit
taken in the course of that business; or
(c) carries on in
Australia a business that consists of or includes taking money on deposit, so
long as the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory guarantees the repayment of
any deposit taken in the course of that business.
393‑25 Owners of farm management
deposits
Meaning of owner
(1) The owner
of a *farm management deposit is:
(a) if paragraph (b)
does not apply—the individual who made or is making the deposit; or
(b) in the case of a
deposit made or being made by the trustee of a trust on behalf of a beneficiary
who is an individual—the beneficiary.
Primary production business carried on
by a partnership
(2) This Division applies to
you as if you were an individual who is carrying on a *primary
production business that is actually carried on by a partnership, if you are an
individual who is a partner in the partnership.
Primary production business carried on
by a trust
(3) This Division, and
section 97A of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 (about
beneficiaries who are owners of farm management deposits), apply to you as if
you were an individual who is carrying on a *primary
production business that is actually carried on by a trust, if you satisfy the
requirements in subsection (4), (5) or (6).
Primary production business carried on
by a trust with beneficiary presently entitled to income of the trust
(4) You satisfy the
requirements in this subsection if:
(a) you are an
individual and a beneficiary of the trust referred to in subsection (3);
and
(b) you are presently
entitled to a share of the income of the trust for the income year.
Primary production business carried on
by a fixed trust with no income of the trust
(5) You satisfy the
requirements in this subsection if:
(a) you are an
individual and a beneficiary of the trust referred to in subsection (3);
and
(b) at all times
during the income year, the manner or extent to which each beneficiary of the
trust can benefit from the trust is not capable of being significantly affected
by the exercise, or non‑exercise, of a power; and
(c) the trust does
not have any income of the trust for the income year to which a beneficiary of
the trust could be presently entitled; and
(d) if the trust had
income of the trust for the income year, you would have been presently entitled
to a share of the income of the trust.
Primary production business carried on
by a non‑fixed trust with no income of the trust
(6) You satisfy the
requirements in this subsection if you do not satisfy the requirements in subsection (5)
and you are an individual and a chosen beneficiary of the trust referred to in subsection (3)
for the purposes of section 393‑27 for the income year.
393‑27 Trustee may choose that a
beneficiary is a chosen beneficiary of the trust
(1) The trustee of a trust
may choose that a beneficiary of the trust is a chosen beneficiary of the trust
for an income year if the trust does not have any income of the trust for the
income year to which a beneficiary of the trust could be presently entitled.
(2) The maximum number of
choices that the trustee may make in respect of the trust for an income year is
the higher of:
(a) the number of
individuals to which subsection 393‑25(3) applied in the income year
immediately before the current income year; and
(b) 12.
(3) A choice made under subsection (1)
must be:
(a) in writing; and
(b) signed by the
trustee and the person chosen.
(4) The trustee can make the
choice no later than the time it lodges the trust’s *income
tax return for the income year to which the choice relates. However, the
Commissioner can allow the trustee to make a choice at a later time.
(5) A choice cannot be revoked
or varied.
393‑28 Application of Division to
beneficiary no longer under legal disability
If:
(a) a *farm management deposit was made by a trustee on behalf of a
beneficiary of a trust; and
(b) the beneficiary
was under a legal disability when the deposit was made; and
(c) the beneficiary
is no longer under a legal disability;
then this Division, and Division 4A
of Part VA of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936, apply as if the
beneficiary had made the deposit.
Note: Division 4A of
Part VA of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 is about quotation of
tax file numbers in connection with farm management deposits.
393‑30 Effect of contravening
requirements
(1) A deposit is not a farm
management deposit if, when the deposit was accepted, a requirement
contained in the relevant agreement as set out in items 1 to 6 of the
table in section 393‑35 was contravened.
(2) A deposit is not, and is
taken never to have been, a farm management deposit if a requirement
contained in the relevant agreement as set out in items 7 to 9 of the
table in section 393‑35 is contravened at any time in relation to the
deposit.
(3) So much of a deposit as
causes a requirement contained in the relevant agreement as set out in item 10
of the table in section 393‑35 to be contravened is not a farm
management deposit.
393‑35 Requirements of agreement for
a farm management deposit
An agreement mentioned
in paragraph 393‑20(1)(b) must contain requirements to the effect of those
set out in the following table:
|
Requirements
of agreement for a farm management deposit
|
|
Item
|
Requirement
|
|
1
|
The *owner must be an individual who is carrying on a *primary production business in Australia when the deposit is made.
Note: This Division applies to
certain partners and beneficiaries as if they were individuals who carried on
a primary production business: see subsections 393‑25(2), (3), (4), (5)
and (6).
|
|
2
|
The deposit:
(a) must not be made by 2 or more
individuals jointly; and
(b) must not be made on behalf of 2 or more
individuals.
|
|
3
|
The deposit must not be made by a trustee
on behalf of a beneficiary unless the beneficiary is:
(a) under a legal disability; and
(b) presently entitled to a share of the
income of the trust.
|
|
4
|
The deposit must be $1,000 or more when
it is made, unless the deposit is:
(a) the immediate reinvestment of a *farm management deposit as a farm management deposit with the same
*FMD provider; or
(b) the extension of the term of a farm
management deposit (even if other terms such as those relating to interest
payable are also varied).
|
|
6
|
Rights of the depositor in respect of the
deposit must not be transferable to another entity.
|
|
7
|
The deposit must not be the subject of a
charge or other encumbrance to secure any amount.
|
|
8
|
Amounts that would otherwise accrue as
interest or other earnings on the deposit must not reduce liabilities of the
depositor to pay interest to the *FMD provider in
respect of loans or other debts of the depositor.
|
|
9
|
Interest or other earnings on the deposit
must not be invested as a *farm management
deposit with the *FMD provider without having
first been paid to the depositor.
|
|
10
|
The deposit must not be more than
$400,000, and the sum of the balances from time to time of the deposit and
all other *farm management deposits of the *owner with *FMD providers must not
be more than $400,000.
|
|
11
|
The deposit must be repaid if:
(a) the *owner dies or becomes bankrupt; or
(b) the owner ceases to carry on a *primary production business in Australia and does not start
carrying on such a business again within 120 days.
|
|
12
|
The amount of any repayment of the
deposit must be $1,000 or more, except if the entire amount of the deposit is
repaid.
|
|
13
|
The *FMD provider must transfer the deposit by electronic means to
another FMD provider that agrees to accept the deposit as a *farm management deposit, if the first FMD provider is:
(a) requested in writing by the depositor to
do so; and
(b) given any information or other
assistance from the depositor necessary for the purpose.
|
|
14
|
The *FMD provider must not deduct from the deposit (whether at the time
it is made, while it is with the FMD provider or at the time of its
repayment) any administration fee or other amount required by the FMD
provider to be paid in respect of the deposit or otherwise.
|
393‑40 Repayment of deposit within
first 12 months
Partial repayment within first 12
months
(1) Any part of a deposit
repaid before the last day of the 12 months after the day the deposit is made
is not, and is taken never to have been, part of a farm management
deposit.
Note 1: A repayment covered by subsection (3A)
or (5) is disregarded in applying this subsection. The normal rules in sections 393‑5
(about deductions for making a farm management deposit) and 393‑10 (about
assessability of the repayment of a farm management deposit) apply instead.
Note 2: This subsection does not apply
if a deposit is reinvested, the term of a deposit is extended, or a deposit is
transferred at the depositor’s request: see section 393‑15.
Deposit not to be reduced to less than
$1,000 within first 12 months
(2) A deposit is not, and is
taken never to have been, a farm management deposit if the amount
of the deposit is reduced to less than $1,000 because of one or more repayments
before the last day of the 12 months after the day the deposit is made.
Note 1: A repayment covered by subsection (3A)
or (5) is disregarded in applying this subsection.
Note 2: This subsection does not apply
if a deposit is reinvested, the term of a deposit is extended, or a deposit is
transferred at the depositor’s request: see section 393‑15.
Repayment in the event of an
applicable natural disaster
(3A) Subsections (1) and
(2) do not apply to a repayment of the whole or a part of a *farm management deposit if:
(a) natural disaster
relief and recovery arrangements made by or on behalf of the Commonwealth
apply, in a way specified in regulations made for the purposes of this
subsection, to a *primary production business of the *owner of the deposit; and
(b) all of the other
circumstances specified in those regulations are satisfied.
Any later deposit not a farm
management deposit
(4) If subsection (3A)
applies to an *owner and a repayment, any later deposit
that is made by, or on behalf of, the owner in the income year in which the
repayment is made is not, and is taken never to have been, a farm
management deposit.
Repayment in the case of death,
bankruptcy or ceasing to carry on a primary production business
(5) Subsections (1) and
(2) do not apply to a repayment of a *farm management
deposit because of the requirement contained in the relevant agreement as set
out in item 11 of the table in section 393‑35 (death, bankruptcy
etc.).
Certain transactions do not affect the
day the deposit was made
(6) Subsections (1) to
(4) apply as if a *farm management deposit that:
(a) is made as a
result of a transaction mentioned in subsection 393‑15(1) (about
reinvesting a deposit, extending the term of a deposit and transferring a
deposit at the depositor’s request); or
(b) is affected by
such a transaction;
were made on the day on which the
original deposit was made.
Example: A farm management deposit is
made on 1 July 2010 for a term of 6 months, but is extended in December
2010 for another 6 months. For the purposes of subsections (1) to (4), the
day the extended deposit was made remains as 1 July 2010.
Note: Section 393‑40 of the Income
Tax (Transitional Provisions) Act 1997 provides for a special rule for
deposits transferred under the repealed Loan (Income Equalization Deposits)
Act 1976.
393‑45 Partly
repaid farm management deposits
A reference to a farm
management deposit is a reference to so much of the deposit as has not
been repaid.
Subdivision 393‑C—Special rules relating to financial claims scheme for
account‑holders with insolvent ADIs
Guide to Subdivision 393‑C
393‑50 What this Subdivision is
about
A deposit (the new deposit) arising from:
(a) an entitlement under Division 2AA
(Financial claims scheme for account‑holders with insolvent ADIs) of
Part II of the Banking Act 1959 relating to a farm management
deposit (the old deposit); or
(b) a
distribution from liquidation of an ADI that is attributable to a farm
management deposit (also the old deposit);
is treated as a
transfer of the old deposit and does not give rise to new assessable income or
deductions.
Table
of sections
Operative
provisions
393‑55 Farm management deposits
arising from farm management deposits with ADIs subject to financial claims
scheme
393‑60 Repayment if owner of
farm management deposit with insolvent ADI dies, is bankrupt or ceases to be a
primary producer
Operative provisions
393‑55 Farm management deposits
arising from farm management deposits with ADIs subject to financial claims
scheme
Application
(1) This section applies if
an entitlement arises under Division 2AA (Financial claims scheme for
account‑holders with insolvent ADIs) of Part II of the Banking Act 1959
in connection with an account containing a *farm
management deposit (the old deposit) with an *ADI (the old ADI) and either:
(a) an amount (the new
deposit) is deposited into either of the following to meet, in whole or
part, so much of the entitlement as relates to the old deposit:
(i) an
existing account for a farm management deposit;
(ii) an
account established under section 16AH of that Act for the purposes of
meeting (in whole or part) the entitlement; or
(b) an amount (also
the new deposit) is deposited by a liquidator of the old ADI into
either of the following as so much of a distribution from the liquidation of
the old ADI as relates to the old deposit:
(i) an
existing account for a farm management deposit;
(ii) an
account established under section 16AR of that Act for the payment of the
distribution.
Note: If an amount is deposited in
connection with an account with the old ADI containing 2 or more old deposits,
the amount is to be apportioned between each old deposit, so that so much of
the amount as is attributable to a particular old deposit is regarded as a
distinct new deposit relating to that old deposit.
New deposit is a farm management
deposit
(2) This Division (except
this section) applies to the new deposit as if the new deposit were a transfer
of the old deposit in accordance with a requirement contained in the relevant
agreement for the old deposit as set out in item 13 of the table in
section 393‑35 (which allows for transfers of deposits at the request of
the depositor). To avoid doubt, this Division applies in that way as if the
amount transferred were the amount of the new deposit, even if that is more or
less than the amount of the old deposit.
Note 1: The effects of this include
the following:
(a) section 393‑5 (about deductions
for making a farm management deposit) does not apply in relation to the making
of the new deposit (see paragraphs 393‑15(1)(c) and (2)(a));
(b) subsection 393‑10(1) (about
assessability of the repayment of a farm management deposit) can only apply to
the extent of any difference between the amount transferred and the amount of
the old deposit (see paragraphs 393‑15(1)(c) and (2)(b));
(c) subsections 393‑40(1), (2) and
(4) (about repayment of a farm management deposit within the first 12 months)
can only apply to the extent of any difference between the amount transferred
and the amount of the old deposit (see paragraphs 393‑15(1)(c) and (2)(c) and
(d));
(d) the day the old deposit was made, for
the purposes of subsections 393‑40(1) and (2) (about repayment of a farm
management deposit within the first 12 months) and (3A) and (4) (about
repayment in the event of an applicable natural disaster), is maintained for
the new deposit (see subsection 393‑40(6)).
Note 2: Also, the unrecouped FMD
deduction in respect of the new deposit is the same as the unrecouped FMD
deduction in respect of the old deposit (see subsection 393‑15(3)), unless
subsection (6) or (7) of this section applies because the new deposit is
less than the old deposit.
(3) In determining whether
either of the following is a *farm management deposit,
disregard a requirement contained in an agreement as set out in item 4 of
the table in section 393‑35 (requiring the deposit to be $1,000 or more):
(a) the new deposit;
(b) a deposit made
later directly by the transfer of the new deposit in accordance with a
requirement of the relevant agreement for the new deposit as mentioned in item 13
of that table.
Unrecouped FMD deduction for new
deposit less than old deposit
(6) Despite subsection (2)
and subsection 393‑15(3), if the new deposit is less than the old deposit
at the time (the declaration time) the old ADI became a declared
ADI under the Banking Act 1959, the unrecouped FMD deduction
in respect of the new deposit is the amount worked out using the following
formula:

Note: The new deposit could be less
than the old deposit if the entitlement is paid in instalments (each of which
will be a separate new deposit).
(7) However,
if the amount worked out under subsection (6) is more than the difference
(if any) between:
(a) the *unrecouped FMD deduction in respect of the old deposit just before
the declaration time; and
(b) the total of the
amounts worked out under all previous applications of subsection (6) in
relation to that old deposit;
the unrecouped FMD deduction
in respect of the new deposit is equal to the difference (if any).
Note: This ensures that when new
deposits linked to the old deposit are repaid, the total amount included in
assessable income will not exceed the unrecouped FMD deduction in respect of
the old deposit.
Relationship with other provisions
(8) This section has effect
despite Division 253 (about tax treatment of entitlements under the
financial claims scheme for insolvent ADIs).
393‑60 Repayment if owner of farm
management deposit with insolvent ADI dies, is bankrupt or ceases to be a
primary producer
Subsection 393‑10(4)
does not apply in relation to so much of a *farm
management deposit with an *ADI as is equal to the
sum of the amounts described in subparagraphs (d)(i) and (ii) of this
section if:
(a) you are the *owner of the deposit; and
(b) the deposit
becomes repayable during an income year because of the requirement contained in
the relevant agreement as set out in item 11 of the table in section 393‑35
(death, bankruptcy etc.); and
(c) during the income
year, the ADI becomes a declared ADI under Division 2AA (Financial claims
scheme for account‑holders with insolvent ADIs) of Part II of the Banking
Act 1959; and
(d) at the end of the
income year, you have either or both of the following:
(i) an
unmet entitlement under that Division connected with the account for the farm
management deposit;
(ii) an
unmet claim against the ADI, or an unpaid debt owed to you by the ADI, in the
winding up of the ADI connected with the account for the deposit.
Note: Subsection 393‑10(4)
makes the repayment of a farm management deposit assessable in the income year
when the death, bankruptcy etc. occurs, rather than in any later year in which
it might be repaid.
Division 394—Forestry managed investment schemes
Guide to Division 394
394‑1 What this Division is about
This Division sets
out rules about deductions for contributions to forestry managed investment
schemes. It also sets out the tax treatment of proceeds from the sale of interests in such schemes, and of proceeds
from harvesting trees under such schemes.
Table
of sections
394‑5 Object of this Division
394‑10 Deduction for amounts
paid under forestry managed investment schemes
394‑15 Forestry managed
investment schemes and related concepts
394‑20 Payments on behalf of
participant in forestry managed investment scheme
394‑25 CGT event in relation to
forestry interest in forestry managed investment scheme—initial participant
394‑30 CGT event in relation to
forestry interest in forestry managed investment scheme—subsequent participant
394‑35 70% DFE rule
394‑40 Payments under forestry
managed investment scheme
394‑45 Direct forestry
expenditure
394‑5 Object of this Division
The object of this
Division is to encourage the expansion of commercial plantation forestry in Australia through the establishment and tending of new plantations for felling. This is
achieved by:
(a) permitting
investors to deduct amounts paid under a forestry scheme in the year of
payment, if certain conditions are met (for example, that it is reasonable to
expect that the manager of the scheme will spend at least 70% of investors’
contributions, on a market value basis, on activities that establish, tend,
fell and harvest trees); and
(b) allowing
secondary market trading of interests in such schemes, while minimising tax
arbitrage and providing tax certainty for investors.
394‑10 Deduction for amounts paid
under forestry managed investment schemes
(1) You can deduct an amount
if:
(a) you hold a *forestry interest in a *forestry managed
investment scheme; and
(b) you pay the
amount under the scheme; and
(c) the scheme
satisfies the *70% DFE rule (see section 394‑35) on
30 June in the income year in which a *participant
in the scheme first pays an amount under the scheme; and
(d) you do not have
day to day control over the operation of the scheme (whether or not you have
the right to be consulted or give directions); and
(e) at least one of
these conditions is satisfied:
(i) there
is more than one participant in the scheme;
(ii) the *forestry manager of the scheme, or an *associate
of the forestry manager, manages, arranges or promotes similar schemes; and
(f) the condition in
subsection (4) is satisfied.
(2) You deduct the amount
for the income year in which you pay it.
(3) For the purposes of this
Division, do not treat an amount as being paid under a *forestry managed investment scheme if:
(a) you pay the
amount in connection with a *CGT event in relation to
a *forestry interest in the scheme; and
(b) as a result of
the CGT event:
(i) another
*participant in the scheme no longer holds the forestry interest; and
(ii) you
start to hold the forestry interest.
(4) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(f),
the condition in this subsection is satisfied unless:
(a) 18 months have
elapsed since the end of the income year in which an amount is first paid under
the *forestry managed investment scheme by a *participant in the scheme; and
(b) the trees
intended to be established in accordance with the scheme have not all been
established before the end of those 18 months.
(5) You cannot deduct an
amount under subsection (1) if:
(a) you hold the *forestry interest mentioned in paragraph (1)(a) as an *initial participant; and
(b) a *CGT event happens in relation to the forestry interest within 4
years after the end of the income year in which you first pay an amount under
the scheme.
If you have already deducted it, your
assessment may be amended to disallow the deduction.
(5A) Paragraph (5)(b) does
not apply to a *CGT event if:
(a) the CGT event
happens because of circumstances outside your control; and
Example: The forestry interest is
compulsorily acquired.
(b) when you acquired
the *forestry interest, you could not
reasonably have foreseen the CGT event happening.
(6) Despite section 170
of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936, the Commissioner may amend your
assessment at any time within 2 years after the *CGT
event, for the purpose of giving effect to subsection (5).
(7) Sections 82KZMD and
82KZMF of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 do not affect the timing of
a deduction under this section.
394‑15 Forestry managed investment
schemes and related concepts
(1) A *scheme is a forestry managed investment scheme if the
purpose of the scheme is for establishing and tending trees for felling in Australia.
(2) The entity that manages,
arranges or promotes a *forestry managed
investment scheme is the forestry manager of the scheme.
(3) A forestry
interest in a *forestry managed
investment scheme is a right to benefits produced by the scheme (whether the
right is actual, prospective or contingent and whether it is enforceable or
not).
(4) An entity that holds a *forestry interest in a *forestry managed
investment scheme (other than the *forestry manager
of the scheme) is a participant in the scheme.
(5) A *participant in a *forestry managed
investment scheme holds a *forestry interest in the
scheme as an initial participant if:
(a) the participant
obtains the forestry interest from the *forestry
manager of the scheme; and
(b) the payment by
the participant to obtain the forestry interest results in the establishment of
trees.
394‑20 Payments on behalf of
participant in forestry managed investment scheme
For the purposes of
this Division, treat a payment to the *forestry manager
of a *forestry managed investment on behalf of a
*participant in the scheme as a payment by the participant to the
forestry manager.
394‑25 CGT event in relation to
forestry interest in forestry managed investment scheme—initial participant
(1) This section applies if:
(a) you hold a *forestry interest in a *forestry managed
investment scheme as an *initial participant in
the scheme; and
(b) at least one of
these conditions is satisfied:
(i) you
can deduct or have deducted an amount for an income year under section 394‑10
in relation to the forestry interest;
(ii) the
condition in subparagraph (i) would be satisfied if subsection 394‑10(5)
were disregarded; and
(c) a *CGT event happens in relation to the forestry interest, other than a
CGT event that happens in respect of thinning.
(2) Your
assessable income for the income year in which the *CGT
event happens includes:
(a) if, as a result
of the CGT event, you no longer hold the *forestry
interest—the *market value of the forestry interest
(worked out as at the time of the event); or
(b) otherwise—the
decrease (if any) in the market value of the forestry interest as a result of
the CGT event.
(3) Any amount that you
actually receive because of the *CGT event is not
included in your assessable income (nor is it *exempt
income).
394‑30 CGT event in relation to
forestry interest in forestry managed investment scheme—subsequent participant
(1) This section applies if:
(a) you hold a *forestry interest in a *forestry managed
investment scheme otherwise than as an *initial
participant in the scheme; and
(b) at least one of
these conditions is satisfied:
(i) you
can deduct or have deducted an amount for an income year under section 394‑10
in relation to the forestry interest;
(ii) you
could deduct an amount for an income year under section 394‑10 if you had
paid the amount under the scheme in that year; and
(c) a *CGT event happens in relation to the forestry interest, other than a
CGT event that happens in respect of thinning.
(2) Your assessable income
for the income year in which the *CGT event happens
includes the lesser of the following:
(a) the *market value of the forestry interest (worked out as at the time of
the event);
(b) the amount (if
any) by which the *total forestry scheme deductions in
relation to the forestry interest exceeds the *incidental
forestry scheme receipts in relation to the forestry interest.
(3) The total forestry
scheme deductions in relation to the *forestry
interest is the total of each amount that you can deduct or have deducted under
section 394‑10 for each income year in relation to the forestry interest.
(4) The incidental
forestry scheme receipts in relation to the *forestry
interest is the total of each amount that you have received under the scheme in
each income year in relation to the forestry interest for a reason otherwise
than because of the *CGT event.
(5) However, if you still
hold the forestry interest despite the *CGT
event, work out the amount included in your assessable income under subsection (2)
using this formula (instead of using the amount worked out under subsection (2)):

(6) If this section has
operated previously in relation to the *forestry
interest, disregard an amount for the purposes of subsections (3) and (4)
to the extent that it has already been reflected in your assessable income
under that previous operation in relation to the forestry interest.
(7) These provisions do not
apply to the *CGT event:
(a) section 6‑5
(about *ordinary income);
(b) any other
provision that includes an amount in assessable income, other than the
following:
(i) a
provision in Part 3‑1 or 3‑3;
(ii) subsection (2)
of this section;
(c) section 8‑1
(about amounts you can deduct);
(d) any other
provision that allows you to deduct an amount from your assessable income;
(e) section 118‑20.
(8) However, the provisions
referred to in subsection (7) can apply to the *CGT
event if a *capital gain or *capital
loss from the event is disregarded because of section 118‑25.
(9) Just before the *CGT event, increase the *cost base and *reduced cost base of the *forestry interest
by the amount included in your assessable income under subsection (2).
394‑35 70% DFE rule
(1) A
*forestry managed investment scheme satisfies the 70% DFE rule
on 30 June in an income year if it is reasonable to expect on that 30 June
that the amount of DFE under the scheme (see subsection (2)) is no less
than 70% of the amount of the payments under the scheme (see subsection (3)).
(2) The amount of DFE under
the scheme is the amount of the net present value (on that 30 June) of all
*direct forestry expenditure under the scheme that the *forestry manager of the scheme has paid or will pay under the
scheme.
(3) The amount of payments
under the scheme is the amount of the net present value (on that 30 June)
of all amounts that all current and future *participants
in the scheme have paid or will pay under the scheme.
(4) In working out the net
present value of an amount paid before that 30 June:
(a) unless paragraph (b)
applies—treat the amount as having been paid on that 30 June; or
(b) if the amount was
paid in an income year ending before that 30 June—treat the amount as
having been paid on the 30 June in that income year.
(5) In working out the net
present value of an amount expected to be paid after that 30 June, treat
the amount as having been paid on 1 January in the income year in which it
is expected to be paid.
(6) Reduce an amount worked
out under subsection (2) or (3) to the extent (if any) to which that
amount can reasonably be expected to be recouped.
(7) In working out the net
present value of an amount for the purposes of this section, use the yield on
Australian Government Treasury Bonds with the maturity closest to 10 years (as
published by the Reserve Bank of Australia).
(8) For the purposes of subsection (2),
if:
(a) the *forestry manager of the scheme has paid or will pay an amount under
the scheme in a transaction; and
(b) the forestry
manager and at least one other party to the transaction did not or will not
deal at *arm’s length in relation to the
transaction; and
(c) the amount is or
will be more or less than the *market value of what it
is for;
treat the amount as that market value.
394‑40 Payments under forestry
managed investment scheme
For the purposes of
this Division, do not treat the following payments as payments under a *forestry managed investment scheme by a *participant
in the scheme:
(a) payments for *borrowing money;
(b) payments of
interest and payments in the nature of interest;
(c) payments of stamp
duty;
(d) payments of *GST;
(e) payments that
relate to one or more of the matters mentioned in paragraphs 394‑45(4)(a), (b)
or (c).
394‑45 Direct forestry expenditure
(1) Direct forestry
expenditure under a *forestry managed
investment scheme means:
(a) an amount paid
under the scheme that is attributable to establishing, tending, felling and
harvesting trees; and
(b) notional amounts
reflecting the *market value of goods, services or the use
of land, provided by the *forestry manager of the
scheme, for establishing, tending, felling and harvesting trees.
Example 1: Notional amounts reflecting the
value of the use of land owned by the forestry manager that is provided for
establishing, tending, felling and harvesting trees.
Example 2: Notional amounts reflecting the
value of tree felling services provided by the forestry manager.
(2) Treat *direct forestry expenditure covered by paragraph (1)(b) as paid
annually for each income year of the *forestry manager
of the scheme based on the *market value of the
goods, services, or the use of the land. Treat the day on which it is paid as:
(a) unless paragraph (b)
or (c) applies—1 January in the income year; or
(b) if the first time
an amount is paid under the scheme is later than the first day of the income
year—the last day of the income year; or
(c) if the scheme
comes to an end on a day before the end of the income year—that day.
Exclusions—general
(3) However, direct
forestry expenditure under the scheme does not include amounts paid
under the scheme to the extent that they relate to any of the following:
(a) marketing of the
scheme;
Example: Advertising, sales, sponsorship
and entertainment.
(b) insurance,
contingency funds or provisions (other than provisions for employee
entitlements);
(c) financing;
(d) lobbying;
(e) general business
overheads (but not overheads directly related to forestry);
(f) subscriptions to
industry bodies;
(g) commissions for
financial planners or financial advisers;
(h) compliance with
requirements related to the structure and operations of the *forestry manager of the scheme;
Example: Product design and preparation of
product disclosure statements.
(i) supervision
and auditing of contracts, other than direct supervision of direct forestry
activities (such as establishing trees for felling);
(j) legal fees
relating to any matter mentioned in this subsection.
Exclusions—expenditure after harvest
etc.
(4) Also, direct
forestry expenditure under the scheme does not include amounts paid
under the scheme to the extent that they relate to any of the following:
(a) transportation
and handling of felled trees that happens after the earliest of the following:
(i) sale
of the trees;
(ii) arrival
of the trees at the mill door;
(iii) arrival
of the trees at the port;
(iv) arrival
of the trees at the place of processing (other than where processing happens in‑field);
(b) processing;
(c) stockpiling
(other than in‑field stockpiling);
(d) marketing and
sale of forestry produce.
Division 405—Above‑average special professional income
of authors, inventors, performing artists, production associates and
sportspersons
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 405
405‑A Above‑average special
professional income
405‑B Assessable professional
income
405‑C Taxable professional income
and average taxable professional income
Guide to Division 405
405‑1 What this Division is about
Significant
fluctuations can occur in the professional incomes of authors, inventors,
performing artists, production associates and sportspersons.
To lessen the impact of
these fluctuations on your marginal tax rates, special tax rates apply if your
professional income is above your average.
This Division explains
how the scheme works and sets out the rules for working out your above‑average
special professional income.
Table of sections
405‑5 Special rate of income
tax on your above‑average special professional income
405‑10 Overview of the Division
405‑5 Special rate of income tax on
your above‑average special professional income
(1) If you have above‑average
special professional income, the Income Tax Rates Act 1986 generally
sets a special rate so that the amount of income tax you pay on the top 4/5 of your above‑average special professional income is effectively 4
times what you would pay on the bottom 1/5 of that income at
basic rates.
Note : Your overall income tax will
be less only if 2 marginal rates of income tax would apply to your above‑average
special professional income if it were treated as the top slice of your taxable
income.
(2) The
following diagram illustrates how the special rate works.

405‑10 Overview of the Division
For which income years do you have
above‑average special professional income?
(1) The first income year
for which you have above‑average special professional income is the first
income year (professional year 1):
(a) for which your
taxable professional income is more than $2,500; and
(b) during all or
part of which you are an Australian resident.
(2) After
professional year 1, you have above‑average special professional income for any
income year for all or part of which you are an Australian resident.
Note: You need not have been an
Australian resident for every income year since professional year 1.
What is above‑average special
professional income?
(3) Your above‑average
special professional income for the current year is the amount (if any) by
which your taxable professional income exceeds your average taxable
professional income.
See Subdivision 405‑A.
What is taxable professional income?
(4) Your taxable
professional income depends on your assessable professional income.
See section 405‑45.
(5) Your assessable
professional income is assessable income from your work as an author, inventor,
performing artist, production associate or sportsperson.
See Subdivision 405‑B.
How do you work out your average
taxable professional income?
(6) Generally, your average
taxable professional income for the current year is the average of your taxable
professional income for the last 4 income years.
See section 405‑50.
(7) However, special phasing‑in
arrangements apply to work out your average taxable professional income for an
income year that is less than 4 income years after professional year 1.
These
arrangements favour people who were Australian residents for at least part of
the income year before professional year 1.
See section 405‑50.
Subdivision 405‑A—Above‑average special professional income
Table of sections
405‑15 When do you have above‑average
special professional income?
405‑15 When do you have above‑average
special professional income?
(1) Your taxable income for
the *current year includes above‑average
special professional income if and only if:
(a) you are an
individual; and
(b) you have been an
Australian resident for all or part of the current year; and
(c) your *taxable professional income for the current year exceeds your *average taxable professional income for the current year; and
(d) either:
(i) your *taxable professional income for the current year is more than
$2,500; or
(ii) your *taxable professional income for an earlier income year was more than
$2,500 and you were an Australian resident for all or part of that income year.
How much above‑average special
professional income do you have?
(2) The amount of *above‑average special professional income in your taxable income for
the *current year is the difference between:
(a) your *taxable professional income for the current year; and
(b) your *average taxable professional income for the current year.
Subdivision 405‑B—Assessable professional income
Table
of sections
405‑20 What you count as assessable
professional income
405‑25 Meaning of special
professional, performing artist, production associate, sportsperson
and sporting competition
405‑30 What you cannot
count as assessable professional income
405‑35 Limits on counting
amounts as assessable professional income
405‑40 Joint author or inventor
treated as sole author or inventor
405‑20 What you count as assessable
professional income
(1) Work out your assessable
professional income for an income year by adding up all your assessable
income for the income year that you count under this Subdivision.
Note 1: Section 405‑30 may
stop you counting an amount.
Note 2: Subsection 405‑35(1)
stops you counting an amount more than once, even if it is described in more
than one subsection of this section.
Note 3: Subsection 405‑35(2) may
affect the amount you count.
Assessable income from professional
services
(2) You count any assessable
income that you *derive as a reward for providing services
relating to your activities as a *special professional.
Assessable income from prizes
(3) You also count any
assessable income that you *derive as a prize for
your activities as a *special professional.
Assessable income from promotions and
commentary
(4) You also count any
assessable income that you *derive, because you are
or were a *special professional, for:
(a) endorsing or
promoting goods or services; or
(b) appearing or
participating in an advertisement; or
(c) appearing or
participating in an interview; or
(d) providing
services as a commentator; or
(e) providing similar
services.
Assessable income from assigning
copyright or granting a licence
(5) You also count any
assessable income that you *derive:
(a) as consideration
for:
(i) assigning
all or part of the copyright in a literary, dramatic, musical or artistic work
of which you are the author; or
(ii) granting
an interest in the copyright in such a work by granting a licence; or
(b) as an advance on
account of royalties relating to such a copyright.
Assessable income from assigning or
granting patent rights
(6) You also count any
assessable income that you *derive:
(a) as consideration
for:
(i) assigning
all or part of the patent for an invention that you invented; or
(ii) granting
an interest in the patent for such an invention by granting a licence; or
(iii) assigning
the right to apply for a patent for such an invention; or
(b) as an advance on
account of royalties relating to such a patent.
Other assessable income from works or
inventions
(7) You also count any
assessable income that you *derive (as *royalties or otherwise):
(a) for a literary,
dramatic, musical or artistic work of which you are the author; or
(b) in relation to
copyright in such a work; or
(c) for an invention
that you invented; or
(d) in relation to a
patent for such an invention.
405‑25 Meaning of special
professional, performing artist, production associate, sportsperson
and sporting competition
Special professional
(1) You
are a special professional if you are:
(a) the
author of a literary, dramatic, musical or artistic work; or
Note: The expression “author” is a
technical term from copyright law. In general, the “author” of a musical work
is its composer and the “author” of an artistic work is the artist, sculptor or
photographer who created it.
(b) the inventor of
an invention; or
(c) a *performing artist; or
(d) a *production associate; or
(e) a *sportsperson.
Performing artist
(2) You are a performing
artist if you exercise intellectual, artistic, musical, physical or
other personal skills in the presence of an audience by performing or
presenting:
(a) music; or
(b) a play; or
(c) dance; or
(d) an entertainment;
or
(e) an address; or
(f) a display; or
(g) a promotional
activity; or
(h) an exhibition; or
(i) any similar
activity.
(3) You are also a performing
artist if you perform or appear in or on a *film,
tape, disc or television or radio broadcast.
Production associate
(4) You
are a production associate if you provide *artistic support for:
(a) an activity
described in subsection (2); or
(b) the activity of
making a *film, tape, disc or television or radio
broadcast.
(5) You provide artistic
support for an activity if:
(a) you provide
services relating to the activity as:
(i) an
art director; or
(ii) a
choreographer; or
(iii) a
costume designer; or
(iv) a
director; or
(v) a
director of photography; or
(vi) a film
editor; or
(vii) a
lighting designer; or
(viii) a
musical director; or
(ix) a
producer; or
(x) a
production designer; or
(xi) a set
designer; or
(b) you provide
similar services relating to the activity.
Sportsperson
(6) You are a sportsperson
if you compete in a *sporting competition.
(7) A sporting
competition is a sporting activity to the extent that:
(a) human beings are
the only competitors in it, or it is one in which human beings:
(i) compete
by riding animals or exercising other skills in relation to animals; or
(ii) compete
by driving, piloting or crewing *motor vehicles, boats,
aircraft or other forms of transport; or
(iii) compete
with natural obstacles or natural forces, or by overcoming them; and
(b) participation in
it by human competitors involves primarily their exercising physical prowess,
physical strength or physical stamina.
(8) However, the
participation:
(a) of a navigator in
the activity of car rallying; or
(b) of a coxswain in
the activity of rowing; or
(c) of a competitor
in a similar role in some other activity;
need not involve primarily exercising
physical prowess, physical strength or physical stamina for the activity to be
a sporting competition.
405‑30 What you cannot count
as assessable professional income
Assessable income from continuous
service as author or inventor
(1) You cannot count as *assessable professional income any assessable income you *derive for meeting your obligations under a *scheme
to provide services to another person by engaging in activities as the author
of a literary, dramatic, musical or artistic work, or as the inventor of an
invention, unless:
(a) the scheme was
entered into solely to require you to provide services by:
(i) making
one or more specified literary, dramatic, musical or artistic works; or
(ii) inventing
one or more specified inventions; and
(b) you have not been
providing services, and may not reasonably be expected to provide services, to
that person or his or her *associates under
successive *schemes that result in substantial
continuity of your providing services.
Assessable income from certain
activities
(2) You cannot count as *assessable professional income any assessable income that you *derive for:
(a) coaching or
training *sportspersons; or
(b) umpiring or
refereeing a *sporting competition; or
(c) administering a *sporting competition; or
(d) being a member of
the pit crew in motor sport; or
(e) being a
theatrical or sports entrepreneur; or
(f) owning or
training animals.
Payments at end of employment, and
capital gains
(3) You
cannot count as *assessable professional income:
(a) a *superannuation lump sum or an *employment
termination payment; or
(b) an *unused annual leave payment or an *unused
long service leave payment; or
(c) a *net capital gain.
This section prevails over section 405‑20
(4) You cannot count
particular assessable income as *assessable professional
income if this section says you cannot, even if section 405‑20 says you
count it.
405‑35 Limits on counting amounts as
assessable professional income
No double‑counting
(1) You cannot count the
same amount as *assessable professional income more than
once, even if it is described in more than one subsection of section 405‑20.
Amounts that are partly assessable
professional income
(2) If:
(a) you *derive assessable income under or as a result of a *scheme; and
(b) the assessable
income consists of a part that is counted as *assessable
professional income and another part that cannot be; and
(c) one component is
unreasonably large and the other component is unreasonably small, for reasons
that are directly or indirectly related to one another;
you must work out your *assessable professional income as if the unreasonably large
component were reduced by a reasonable amount and the unreasonably small
component were increased by the same amount.
(3) Subsection (2)
affects your *assessable professional income:
(a) whether you *derived the assessable income directly or indirectly under or as a
result of the *scheme; and
(b) whether or not a
reason mentioned in paragraph (2)(c) is the only reason why a component is
unreasonably large or small.
405‑40 Joint author or inventor
treated as sole author or inventor
(1) If
you are a joint author of a literary, dramatic, musical or artistic work, work
out your *assessable professional income as if you
were the author of that work.
Note: This section means that you
are treated as a special professional, even if you have never been the sole
author of a work.
(2) If
you are a joint inventor of an invention, work out your *assessable professional income as if you were the inventor of that
invention.
Note: This section means that you
are treated as a special professional, even if you have never been the sole
inventor of an invention.
Subdivision 405‑C—Taxable professional income and average taxable professional
income
Table of sections
405‑45 Working out your taxable
professional income
405‑50 Working out your average
taxable professional income
405‑45 Working out your taxable
professional income
Your taxable
professional income for an income year is the amount (if any) by which your
*assessable professional income for that year exceeds the amount of
your deductions for that year worked out as follows:
Method statement
Step 1. Add up any
amounts you can deduct for that year (except *apportionable
deductions), so far as they reasonably relate to your *assessable
professional income for the year.
Step 2. Work out the
amount using the formula:

Note: The result may be greater than
the apportionable deductions. Also, it may be negative.
Step 3. Add the sum from Step 1 to the
result from Step 2. If the result is more than nil, it is the amount of your
deductions to be subtracted from your *assessable
professional income.
405‑50 Working out your average
taxable professional income
It is generally a 4‑year average
(1) Work out your average
taxable professional income for the *current
year by:
(a) adding up your *taxable professional income for each of the last 4 income years
before the current year; and
(b) dividing the
total by 4.
Phasing‑in arrangements for new
professionals
(2) However, if the *current year is less than 4 income years after *professional year 1, work out your average taxable
professional income using the table in subsection (5).
(3) Professional
year 1 is the first income year:
(a) during which you
were an Australian resident (for all or part of the income year); and
(b) for
which your *taxable professional income was more than
$2,500.
(4) Professional year
2, professional year 3 and professional year 4
are respectively the next 3 income years after *professional
year 1.
(5) The table is as follows:
|
Average
taxable professional income during phase‑in period
|
|
Item
|
Current year
|
Average
taxable professional income if you were an Australian resident for all or
part of the income year immediately before professional year 1
|
Average
taxable professional income if you were a foreign resident for any of the
income year immediately before professional year 1
|
|
1
|
Professional year 1
|
Nil
|
Your *taxable professional income for *professional year 1
|
|
2
|
Professional year 2
|
1/3 of your *taxable professional income for *professional year 1
|
Your *taxable professional income for *professional year 1
|
|
3
|
Professional year 3
|
1/4 of the sum of your *taxable professional income for each of *professional years 1 and 2
|
1/2 of the sum of your *taxable professional income for each of *professional years 1 and 2
|
|
4
|
Professional year 4
|
1/4 of the sum of your *taxable professional income for each of *professional years 1, 2 and 3
|
1/3 of the sum of your *taxable professional income for each of *professional years 1, 2 and 3
|
Note: If
you were a foreign resident for any part of the income year immediately before
professional year 1, the effect of item 1 of the table is that your
taxable income for professional year 1 will not include above‑average special
professional income.
Division 410—Copyright and resale royalty collecting
societies
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 410
410‑A Notice of payments
Guide to Division 410
410‑1 What this Division is about
This Division sets
out rules that apply whenever:
(a) a
copyright collecting society to which section 51‑43 applies makes a
payment to a member of the society; or
(b) the
resale royalty collecting society pays a resale royalty.
Subdivision 410‑A—Notice of payments
Table of sections
410‑5 Copyright collecting
society must give notice to member of society
410‑50 Resale royalty collecting
society must give notice to holder of resale royalty right
410‑5 Copyright collecting society
must give notice to member of society
(1) A *copyright collecting society must give a *member
of the society notice of any payment it makes to the member, if section 51‑43
applies to the society.
(2) The society must give the
notice at the time of the payment.
(3) The notice must be in
the *approved form.
Note: Under section 288‑75 in
Schedule 1 to the Taxation Administration Act 1953 a society is
liable to an administrative penalty for failing to give a notice required under
this section.
410‑50 Resale royalty collecting
society must give notice to holder of resale royalty right
(1) The *resale royalty collecting society must give an entity notice of any
payment it makes to the entity under section 26 of the Resale Royalty
Right for Visual Artists Act 2009, if section 51‑45 of this Act
applies to the society.
(2) The society must give
the notice at the time of the payment.
(3) The notice must be in
the *approved form.
Note: Under section 288‑75 in
Schedule 1 to the Taxation Administration Act 1953 the society is
liable to an administrative penalty for failing to give a notice required under
this section.
Division 415—Designated infrastructure projects
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 415
415‑A Object of this Division
415‑B Tax losses and bad debts
415‑C Designating infrastructure
projects
Guide to Division 415
415‑1 What this Division is about
This Division
provides for special treatment for tax losses and bad debts for certain
entities (called “designated infrastructure project entities”) that carry on
infrastructure projects that the Infrastructure CEO designates under
Subdivision 415‑C.
Subdivision 415‑A—Object of this Division
Table of sections
415‑5 Object of this Division
415‑5 Object of this Division
The object of this
Division is to reduce the disincentives for private expenditure on nationally
significant infrastructure that result from the long lead times between
incurring deductions for, and earning assessable income from, such expenditure.
Subdivision 415‑B—Tax losses and bad debts
Guide to Subdivision 415‑B
415‑10 What this Subdivision is
about
The unutilised
amounts of a designated infrastructure project entity’s tax losses are
increased each year by the long term bond rate. A designated
infrastructure project entity is a fixed trust or company that:
(a) carries
on an infrastructure project designated under Subdivision 415‑C; and
(b) only
engages, and has only ever engaged, in activities for the purposes of carrying
on that designated infrastructure project.
The tests that apply
in relation to tax losses and bad debts if there is a change of ownership of an
entity are modified so that periods during which the entity is a designated
infrastructure project entity are not tested.
The loss utilisation
rules in Subdivision 707‑C do not apply if the head company of a
consolidated group is a designated infrastructure project entity after another
designated infrastructure project entity joins the group.
Note: The
transfer rules in subsection 707‑120(1A) do not apply if a designated
infrastructure project entity joins a consolidated group: see subsection 707‑120(5).
Table of sections
Uplift of tax losses
415‑15 Uplift of tax losses of
designated infrastructure project entities
415‑20 Designated infrastructure project entity
Change of ownership of trusts
and companies
415‑25 Tax losses of trusts
415‑30 Bad debts written off
etc. by trusts
415‑35 Tax losses of companies
415‑40 Bad debts written off by
companies
Consolidated groups
415‑45 Losses transferred to
head companies of consolidated groups
Uplift of tax losses
415‑15 Uplift of tax losses of
designated infrastructure project entities
(1) The amount of a *tax loss of a *loss year of an entity
is increased, at the end of each later income year (and before any *utilisation of the tax loss by the entity in the later income year),
by the amount worked out using the following formula:

where:
eligible portion of the later income
year means the amount worked out using the
following formula:

(2) This subsection applies
to the entity on a day in the later income year if:
(a) the entity is a *designated infrastructure project entity on that day; and
(b) on the day
mentioned in subsection (3), the entity has notified the Commissioner
(whether before, during or after the later income year) in the *approved form that the entity was, at any time, a designated
infrastructure project entity.
(3) For the purposes of paragraph (2)(b),
the day is the day after the latest of the following days:
(a) the day before
which the entity:
(i) is
required to lodge its *income tax return for
the later income year with the Commissioner; or
(ii) if
the entity is not required to lodge an income tax return for the later income
year—would be required to lodge its income tax return for the later income year
were the entity required to lodge such a return;
(b) the 28th day
after the first day the entity *carries on the
infrastructure project mentioned in paragraph 415‑20(1)(b);
(c) the 28th day
after the day the *Infrastructure CEO designates the
infrastructure project under section 415‑70;
(d) a later day
allowed by the Commissioner.
Note: The increase under this
section can occur at the end of an income year even if, at the end of the year,
the entity does not know the entity is a designated infrastructure project
entity (e.g. because the Infrastructure CEO has not yet designated the
infrastructure project that the entity carries on, but the Infrastructure CEO
does so later).
Consolidated groups
(4) Disregard paragraph 701‑30(3)(a)
for the purposes of the denominator in the formula in the definition of eligible
portion of the later income year in subsection (1) of this
section.
Note: Paragraph 701‑30(3)(a)
applies if the entity becomes a subsidiary member of a consolidated group
during the later income year.
(5) For the purposes of
applying this section to a *tax loss the *head company of a *consolidated group makes
as mentioned in subsection 707‑140(1):
(a) the head company
is treated as having made the loss in the income year before the income year in
which the transfer mentioned in that subsection occurs; and
(b) subsection (2)
of this section is treated as not applying to the head company on or before the
day the transfer occurs;
unless the transferred loss was a non‑membership
period loss (within the meaning of subsection 701‑30(3)) in relation to
the group.
Note: Subsection 707‑140(1)
treats the head company of a consolidated group as having made a loss in an
income year in which a loss is transferred to the head company from an entity
that joins the group.
415‑20 Designated infrastructure
project entity
Designated infrastructure project
entity
(1) An entity is a designated
infrastructure project entity at a time (the relevant time)
if:
(a) at the relevant
time, the entity is a *fixed trust or a
company; and
(b) at or after the
relevant time, the entity *carries on a single *designated infrastructure project; and
(c) the entity does
not, at or before the relevant time, carry on any other designated
infrastructure project; and
(d) the only
activities in which the entity engages at the relevant time, or engaged before
the relevant time, are or were for the purposes of the entity carrying on the
single designated infrastructure project.
(2) For the purposes of this
section:
(a) an *enterprise that becomes a *designated
infrastructure project at a time is treated as having been a designated
infrastructure project at all earlier times; and
(b) if the entity *carries on (whether or not at the same time) one or more parts, but
not the whole, of a single designated infrastructure project—the parts are
treated as being a single designated infrastructure project; and
(c) in any case—the
following are treated as being a single designated infrastructure project:
(i) a
single designated infrastructure project (the listed infrastructure
project) that is included on an Infrastructure Priority List;
(ii) any designated
infrastructure projects that the entity carries on (whether or not at the same
time) and that are part of the listed infrastructure project; and
Note: For Infrastructure Priority
Lists, see paragraph 5(b) of the Infrastructure Australia Act 2008.
(d) in any case—any
designated infrastructure projects that the entity carries on (whether or not
at the same time) and that are part of a single infrastructure project that:
(i) is
included on an Infrastructure Priority List; and
(ii) is
not a designated infrastructure project;
are treated as
being a single designated infrastructure project.
Partnerships
(3) Subsection (4)
applies to an entity if:
(a) the entity is a *fixed trust or a company; and
(b) the person that
is the trustee of the trust, or the person that is the company, is a partner in
a partnership.
(4) For the purposes of subsections (1)
and (2), the entity:
(a) is treated as *carrying on any *designated
infrastructure project carried on by the partnership; and
(b) is treated as engaging
in any activity engaged in by the partnership; and
(c) if the
partnership engages in an activity for the purpose of the partnership carrying
on a designated infrastructure project—is treated as engaging in that activity
for the purpose of the entity carrying on that designated infrastructure
project.
Consolidated groups
(5) For the purposes of
working out whether the *head company of a *consolidated group was a *designated
infrastructure project entity at a time (whether before or after the group consolidates),
section 701‑5 (Entry history rule) is treated as not applying to the head
company in relation to an entity that was not a *member
of the consolidated group at that time.
(6) For the purposes of
working out whether an entity is a *designated
infrastructure project entity at a time after the entity ceases to be a *subsidiary member of a *consolidated
group, section 701‑40 (Exit history rule) is treated as not applying to
the entity in relation to the group.
Change of ownership
of trusts and companies
415‑25 Tax losses of trusts
Scope
(1) This section applies to
a *tax loss of a *trust if the trust is a *designated infrastructure project entity at a time (the status
time) in the *loss year.
Modifications of Schedule 2F to
the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936
(2) Despite paragraph 266‑25(1)(b),
266‑30(a), 266‑75(1)(b) or (2)(b), 266‑80(1)(a) or (2)(a), 266‑110(1)(b), 266‑115(a),
266‑150(2)(a), 266‑155(2)(a), 267‑20(1)(b) or 267‑60(a) in Schedule 2F to
the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936, for the purposes of sections 266‑40
and 266‑45, section 266‑90, subsections 266‑125(1) and (2),
subsections 266‑165(1) and (2), sections 267‑40 and 267‑45 or
sections 267‑70 and 267‑75 in that Schedule (whichever are applicable),
the test period starts at the first time:
(a) that occurs after
the status time; and
(b) at which the
trust is not a *designated infrastructure project entity;
if, apart from this subsection, the test
period would start earlier.
(3) For the purposes of
section 267‑30 in that Schedule, disregard any part of an income year
during which the trust is a *designated
infrastructure project entity.
(4) For the purposes of
working out, under subsection 268‑10(3), 268‑15(3) or 268‑20(3) in that
Schedule, the end of the first period, disregard any part of the income year
mentioned in that subsection during which the trust is a *designated infrastructure project entity.
Note: A trust does not calculate
its net income and tax loss under Division 268 in that Schedule if the
trust was a designated infrastructure project entity during the whole of the
income year: see paragraphs 266‑30(c), 266‑80(1)(d) and (2)(c), 266‑115(b), 266‑155(2)(b),
267‑60(b) and 272‑100(f) in that Schedule.
(5) For the purposes
paragraph 268‑20(4)(b) in that Schedule, disregard any part of the first
of the successive periods during which the trust is a *designated
infrastructure project entity.
415‑30 Bad debts written off etc. by
trusts
Scope
(1) This section applies to
a debt to which paragraph 266‑35(1)(a), 266‑85(1)(a) or (2)(a), 266‑120(1)(a),
266‑160(1)(a) or (b), 267‑25(1)(a) or 267‑65(1)(a) in Schedule 2F to the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936 applies, if the trust is a *designated
infrastructure project entity at a time (the status time) in the
income year in which the debt was incurred.
Modifications of Schedule 2F to
the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936
(2) Despite paragraph 266‑35(1)(b),
266‑85(1)(b) or (2)(b), 266‑120(1)(b), 266‑160(2)(a), 267‑25(1)(b) or 267‑65(1)(a)
in that Schedule, for the purposes of sections 266‑40 and 266‑45, section 266‑90,
subsections 266‑125(1) and (2), subsections 266‑165(1) and (2),
sections 267‑40 and 267‑45 or sections 267‑70 and 267‑75 in that
Schedule (whichever are applicable), the test period starts at the first time:
(a) that occurs after
the status time; and
(b) at which the
trust is not a *designated infrastructure project entity.
(3) For the purposes of
section 267‑30 in that Schedule, disregard any part of an income year
during which the trust is a *designated infrastructure
project entity.
415‑35 Tax losses of companies
Scope
(1) This section applies to
a *tax loss of a company if the company is a *designated
infrastructure project entity at a time (the status time) in the *loss year.
Modifications of Divisions 165
and 166
(2) Despite subsection 165‑12(1),
166‑5(2) or 166‑20(1), the *ownership test period or
*test period under that subsection starts at the earlier of:
(a) the first time:
(i) that
occurs after the status time; and
(ii) at
which the company is not a *designated
infrastructure project entity; and
(b) the end of the
income year referred to in that subsection as the income year.
(3) In a case to which paragraph (2)(b)
applies, the company is treated as meeting the conditions in section 165‑12.
(4) Despite subsection 165‑13(2),
166‑5(5), 165‑15(2) or 166‑20(4), the *same business test
period under that subsection starts at the start of the *ownership test period or *test period
(whichever is applicable) if, apart from this subsection, the same business
test period would start earlier.
(5) Despite subsection 165‑13(2),
165‑15(3), 166‑5(6) or 166‑20(4), the *test time under
that subsection occurs just after the start of the *ownership
test period or *test period (whichever is applicable) if,
apart from this subsection, the test time would occur earlier.
(6) A reference in
subsection 165‑15(1) to the *loss year is treated as
being a reference to the period:
(a) starting at the
start of the *ownership test period; and
(b) ending at the end
of the income year in which the ownership test period starts.
(7) For the purposes of
working out, under paragraph 165‑45(3)(a) or (b) or subsection 165‑45(4),
the end of the first period, disregard any part of the income year mentioned in
section 165‑45 during which the company is a *designated
infrastructure project entity.
Note: A company does not calculate
its taxable income and tax loss under Subdivision 165‑B if the company was
a designated infrastructure project entity during the whole of the income year:
see paragraph 165‑35(c).
Exceptions
(8) Disregard this section
for the purposes of Subdivisions 165‑CA and 165‑CB (about net capital
losses) and 175‑A and 175‑CA (about tax benefits).
415‑40 Bad debts written off by
companies
Scope
(1) This section applies to
a debt that a company writes off as bad, if the company is a *designated infrastructure project entity at a time (the status
time) in the income year in which the debt was incurred.
Modifications of Divisions 165
and 166
(2) Despite subsection 165‑123(1)
or 166‑40(2), the *ownership test period or *test period under that subsection starts at the earlier of:
(a) the first time
that occurs after the status time and on or after:
(i) in
the case of subsection 165‑123(1)—the start of the *first continuity period; or
(ii) in
the case of subsection 166‑40(2)—the time the company chooses under that
subsection;
and at which
the company is not a *designated infrastructure project
entity; and
(b) the end of the *second continuity period.
(3) In a case to which paragraph (2)(b)
applies, the company is treated as meeting the conditions in section 165‑123.
(4) Despite subsection 165‑126(2),
165‑129(2), 165‑132(1) or 166‑40(5), the *same
business test period under that subsection starts at the start of the *ownership test period or *test period
(whichever is applicable) if, apart from this subsection, the same business
test period would start earlier.
(5) Despite subsection 165‑126(2),
165‑129(3) or 166‑40(6), the *test time under that
subsection occurs just after the start of the *ownership
test period or *test period (whichever is applicable) if,
apart from this subsection, the test time would occur earlier.
(6) A reference in
subsection 165‑129(1) to the *first continuity
period is treated as being a reference to the period:
(a) starting at the
start of the *ownership test period; and
(b) ending at the end
of the income year in which the ownership test period starts.
Exception
(7) Disregard this section
for the purposes of Subdivision 175‑C (about tax benefits).
Consolidated groups
415‑45 Losses transferred to head
companies of consolidated groups
Subdivision 707‑C
(Amount of transferred losses that can be utilised) does not apply to a loss
transferred under Subdivision 707‑A (Transfer of previously unutilised
losses to head company), if:
(a) just before the
transfer, the transferor of the loss was a *designated
infrastructure project entity; and
(b) just after the
transfer, the transferee of the loss is a designated infrastructure project
entity.
Subdivision 415‑C—Designating infrastructure projects
Guide to Subdivision 415‑C
415‑50 What this Subdivision is
about
To receive the
special treatment for tax losses and bad debts under Subdivision 415‑B, an
entity must only engage in activities for the purposes of carrying on an
infrastructure project designated by the Infrastructure CEO under this
Subdivision.
Designation is
dependent on:
(a) criteria
prescribed by the Minister; and
(b) a
cap on the total estimated private capital expenditure that would be incurred
for all provisionally designated and designated infrastructure projects.
Table
of sections
Designating
infrastructure projects
415‑55 Applications for
designation
415‑60 Dealing with applications
415‑65 Provisional designation
415‑70 Designation
Infrastructure project capital
expenditure cap
415‑75 Infrastructure project
capital expenditure cap
415‑80 Acceptance of estimates
of infrastructure project capital expenditure
Miscellaneous
415‑85 Review of decisions
415‑90 Information to be made
public
415‑95 Delegation
415‑100 Infrastructure project
designation rules
Designating
infrastructure projects
415‑55 Applications for designation
(1) An entity may apply to
the *Infrastructure CEO to have the Infrastructure
CEO designate an *enterprise (the infrastructure
project) that is a proposed investment in, or enhancement to,
infrastructure as being an infrastructure project in relation to which
Subdivision 415‑B applies.
Note: The Infrastructure CEO holds
office under the Infrastructure Australia Act 2008.
(2) The application must
include an estimate of the *infrastructure project
capital expenditure that would be incurred for the purpose of the
infrastructure project.
(3) Subsection (2) does
not apply to *infrastructure project capital expenditure
to the extent that the infrastructure project capital expenditure would be:
(a) incurred by an *Australian government agency; or
(b) funded by a grant
from an Australian government agency.
(4) The application must:
(a) be in a form (if
any) approved by the *Infrastructure CEO; and
(b) be accompanied by
the fee (if any) prescribed by the *infrastructure
project designation rules.
(5) A fee prescribed as
mentioned in paragraph (4)(b) is payable to the *Infrastructure
CEO, on behalf of the Commonwealth.
415‑60 Dealing with applications
Dealing with applications
(1) The *Infrastructure CEO must deal with applications made under this
Division:
(a) in accordance
with the requirements prescribed by the *infrastructure
project designation rules; or
(b) if the
infrastructure project designation rules do not prescribe any requirements—in
the order in which the applications are made.
(2) Without limiting paragraph (1)(a),
the requirements the *infrastructure project
designation rules may prescribe for the purposes of that paragraph include:
(a) requirements
relating to the time at which or by which the *Infrastructure
CEO must deal with an application; and
(b) requirements
relating to applications that, in the opinion of the Infrastructure CEO, are
incomplete or do not contain sufficient information for the Infrastructure CEO
to deal with the applications.
(3) For the purposes of subsection (1),
the *Infrastructure CEO deals with an
application by:
(a) designating the
infrastructure project provisionally under section 415‑65, or deciding not
to designate the infrastructure project provisionally under that section; or
(b) designating the
infrastructure project under section 415‑70 or deciding not to designate
the infrastructure project under that section (whether or not the Infrastructure
CEO has previously dealt with the application by designating the infrastructure
project provisionally under section 415‑65).
(4) Paragraph (1)(b)
does not apply to the *Infrastructure CEO
deciding whether to designate a *provisionally designated
infrastructure project under section 415‑70.
No designation after 30 June 2017
or later prescribed day
(5) Despite anything else in
this Subdivision, the *Infrastructure CEO must
not provisionally designate the infrastructure project under section 415‑65,
or designate the infrastructure project under section 415‑70, after:
(a) 30 June
2017; or
(b) a later day (if
any) prescribed by the *infrastructure project
designation rules.
415‑65 Provisional designation
Provisional designation
(1) The *Infrastructure CEO must, by instrument in writing, designate the
infrastructure project provisionally for the purposes of this Division if:
(a) the entity
applies to have the Infrastructure CEO designate the infrastructure project in
accordance with section 415‑55; and
(b) the Infrastructure
CEO accepts the estimate of the *infrastructure project
capital expenditure under section 415‑80; and
(c) the provisional
designation would not breach the infrastructure project capital expenditure cap
under section 415‑75; and
(d) the
following conditions are satisfied:
(i) the
conditions prescribed by the *infrastructure project
designation rules;
(ii) if
the infrastructure project designation rules do not prescribe any conditions—in
the opinion of the Infrastructure CEO, the infrastructure is nationally
significant infrastructure (within the meaning of the Infrastructure
Australia Act 2008); and
(e) the
infrastructure project is not a *designated
infrastructure project.
(2) The instrument of
provisional designation must contain any details prescribed by the *infrastructure project designation rules.
Amendment of instruments of
provisional designation
(3) The *Infrastructure CEO must, by instrument in writing, amend the
instrument of provisional designation in accordance with any requirements
prescribed by the *infrastructure project designation rules.
The Infrastructure CEO must not amend the instrument in any other
circumstances.
(4) Without limiting subsection (3),
the requirements the *infrastructure project
designation rules may prescribe for the purposes of that subsection include
requirements relating to when an amendment must take effect, which may be a
time before the amendment is made.
Revocation of instruments of
provisional designation
(5) The *Infrastructure CEO must, by instrument in writing, revoke the
instrument of provisional designation:
(a) if the Infrastructure
CEO has designated the project under section 415‑70, or decides not to
designate the project; or
(b) if the Infrastructure
CEO has revoked the instrument of acceptance of the estimate under section 415‑80;
or
(c) in the
circumstances (if any) prescribed by the *infrastructure
project designation rules.
The Infrastructure CEO must not revoke
the instrument in any other circumstances.
(6) Without limiting paragraph (5)(c),
the circumstances the *infrastructure project
designation rules may prescribe for the purposes of that paragraph include:
(a) circumstances
involving a failure by a prescribed entity to give prescribed information to
the *Infrastructure CEO; and
(b) circumstances
involving a breach of conditions set by the Infrastructure CEO for the *provisionally designated infrastructure project to remain
provisionally designated.
(7) The *infrastructure project designation rules must prescribe matters to
which the *Infrastructure CEO must have regard in
setting conditions for a *provisionally designated
infrastructure project to remain provisionally designated, if the
infrastructure project designation rules provide for the Infrastructure CEO to
set such conditions, as mentioned in paragraph (6)(b).
415‑70 Designation
Designation
(1) The *Infrastructure CEO must, by instrument in writing, designate the
infrastructure project for the purposes of this Division if:
(a) the entity
applies to have the Infrastructure CEO designate the infrastructure project in
accordance with section 415‑55; and
(b) the Infrastructure
CEO accepts the estimate of the *infrastructure project
capital expenditure under section 415‑80; and
(c) the designation
would not breach the infrastructure project capital expenditure cap under
section 415‑75; and
(d) the following
conditions are satisfied:
(i) the
conditions prescribed by the *infrastructure project
designation rules;
(ii) if
the infrastructure project designation rules do not prescribe any
conditions—the conditions mentioned in subsection (2);
(whether or not the infrastructure
project is a *provisionally designated infrastructure
project).
(2) For the purposes of subparagraph (1)(d)(ii),
the following are the conditions:
(a) in the opinion of
the *Infrastructure CEO, the infrastructure is
nationally significant infrastructure (within the meaning of the Infrastructure
Australia Act 2008);
(b) in the opinion of
the Infrastructure CEO, financial close on the infrastructure project has
occurred or is imminent.
(3) The instrument of
designation must contain any details prescribed by the *infrastructure
project designation rules.
Amendment of instruments of
designation
(4) The *Infrastructure CEO must, by instrument in writing, amend the
instrument of designation in accordance with any requirements prescribed by the
*infrastructure project designation rules. The Infrastructure CEO
must not amend the instrument in any other circumstances.
(5) Without limiting subsection (4),
the requirements the *infrastructure project designation
rules may prescribe for the purposes of that subsection include requirements
relating to when an amendment must take effect, which may be a time before the
amendment is made.
Revocation of instruments of
designation
(6) The *Infrastructure CEO must, by instrument in writing, revoke the
instrument of designation in the circumstances prescribed by the *infrastructure project designation rules. The Infrastructure CEO
must not revoke the instrument in any other circumstances.
(7) Without limiting subsection (6),
the circumstances the *infrastructure project
designation rules may prescribe for the purposes of that subsection include:
(a) circumstances
involving a failure by a prescribed entity to give prescribed information to
the *Infrastructure CEO; and
(b) circumstances
involving a breach of conditions set by the Infrastructure CEO for the *designated infrastructure project to remain designated.
(8) The *infrastructure project designation rules must prescribe matters to
which the *Infrastructure CEO must have regard in
setting conditions for a *designated
infrastructure project to remain designated, if the infrastructure project
designation rules provide for the Infrastructure CEO to set such conditions, as
mentioned in paragraph (7)(b).
Infrastructure CEO must notify
Commissioner
(9) The *Infrastructure CEO must notify the Commissioner of a decision made
by the Infrastructure CEO:
(a) to designate the
infrastructure project; or
(b) to amend or to
revoke the instrument of designation;
within 28 days after making the decision.
Infrastructure
project capital expenditure cap
415‑75 Infrastructure project
capital expenditure cap
(1) Provisional designation,
or designation, of the infrastructure project would breach the *infrastructure project capital expenditure cap under this section
if, were the provisional designation or designation to occur, the total of the
estimates accepted under section 415‑80 for each infrastructure project
that, just after the provisional designation or designation, would be:
(a) a *provisionally designated infrastructure project; or
(b) a *designated infrastructure project;
would exceed the amount mentioned in subsection (2).
(2) The amount is:
(a) $25 billion; or
(b) if the *infrastructure project designation rules prescribe a greater
amount—that prescribed amount.
(3) For the purposes of subsection (1),
disregard so much of the amount of an estimate for an infrastructure project
(the listed infrastructure project) as relates to a part of the
listed infrastructure project, if:
(a) that part of the
listed project is (or would be, were the provisional designation or designation
mentioned in that subsection to occur):
(i) a *provisionally designated infrastructure project; or
(ii) a *designated infrastructure project; and
(b) the listed
infrastructure project is included on an Infrastructure Priority List.
Note: For Infrastructure Priority
Lists, see paragraph 5(b) of the Infrastructure Australia Act 2008.
(4) In this Act:
infrastructure project capital
expenditure:
(a) has the meaning
given by the *infrastructure project designation rules;
or
(b) if the
infrastructure project designation rules do not give infrastructure
project capital expenditure a meaning—means capital expenditure.
415‑80 Acceptance of estimates of
infrastructure project capital expenditure
Acceptance of estimates
(1) The *Infrastructure CEO must, by instrument in writing, accept the
estimate of *infrastructure project capital expenditure
if the following conditions are satisfied:
(a) the conditions
prescribed by the *infrastructure project designation rules;
(b) if the
infrastructure project designation rules do not prescribe any conditions—in the
opinion of the Infrastructure CEO, the estimate is acceptable.
Revocation of instruments of
acceptance
(2) The *Infrastructure CEO must not revoke the instrument of acceptance if
the infrastructure project is a *designated
infrastructure project.
(3) Subject to subsection (2),
the *Infrastructure CEO must, by instrument in
writing, revoke the instrument of acceptance in the circumstances prescribed by
the *infrastructure project designation rules.
The Infrastructure CEO must not revoke the instrument in any other
circumstances.
(4) Without limiting subsection (3),
the circumstances the *infrastructure project
designation rules may prescribe for the purposes of that subsection include:
(a) circumstances
involving a failure by a prescribed entity to give prescribed information to
the *Infrastructure CEO; and
(b) circumstances
involving a failure by the applicant to amend the estimate in accordance with a
request made by the Infrastructure CEO.
(5) The *infrastructure project designation rules must prescribe matters to
which the *Infrastructure CEO must have regard in
requesting the applicant to amend the estimate, if the infrastructure project
designation rules provide for the Infrastructure CEO to make such requests as
mentioned in paragraph (4)(b).
(6) If:
(a) the *infrastructure project designation rules provide for the *Infrastructure CEO to request the applicant to amend the estimate;
and
(b) the applicant
amends the estimate in accordance with such a request;
the acceptance is treated, from the time
the amendment is made, as being an acceptance of the amended estimate.
Miscellaneous
415‑85 Review of decisions
Applications
may be made to the *AAT for review of the following
decisions of the *Infrastructure CEO:
(a) a
decision not to designate the infrastructure project provisionally under
section 415‑65;
(b) a decision to
amend or revoke the instrument of provisional designation under section 415‑65;
(c) a decision not to
designate the infrastructure project under section 415‑70;
(d) a decision to
amend or revoke the instrument of designation under section 415‑70.
415‑90 Information to be made public
The *Infrastructure CEO must comply with any requirements prescribed by
the *infrastructure project designation rules
in relation to the publication of information about:
(a) *provisionally designated infrastructure projects and *designated infrastructure projects; and
(b) the *infrastructure project capital expenditure cap under section 415‑75.
415‑95 Delegation
The *Infrastructure CEO may, by instrument in writing, delegate any of
the Infrastructure CEO’s powers or functions under this Subdivision to an SES
employee, or acting SES employee, referred to in paragraph 39(1)(a) or
39A(1)(a) of the Infrastructure Australia Act 2008.
415‑100 Infrastructure project
designation rules
(1) The Minister may, by
legislative instrument, make rules (the infrastructure project
designation rules) prescribing matters:
(a) required or
permitted by this Subdivision to be prescribed by the rules; or
(b) necessary or
convenient to be prescribed for carrying out or giving effect to this
Subdivision.
(2) Despite subsection 14(2)
of the Legislative Instruments Act 2003, the *infrastructure
project designation rules may make provision in relation to a matter by
applying, adopting or incorporating any matter contained in an instrument, or
other writing, made by Infrastructure Australia as in force or existing from
time to time.
Division 418—Exploration for minerals
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 418
418‑A Object of this Division
418‑B Exploration development
incentive tax offset
418‑C Exploration development
incentive franking credit
418‑D Creating exploration credits
418‑E Issuing exploration credits
418‑F Excess exploration credits
Guide to Division 418
418‑1 What this Division is about
Generally speaking,
you are entitled to a tax offset for exploration credits issued to you, but
exploration credits issued to corporate tax entities instead give rise to
franking credits.
For the 2015‑16, 2016‑17
or 2017‑18 income year, a greenfields minerals explorer can create, and then
issue, exploration credits for the explorer’s greenfields minerals expenditure
for the previous income year. However, the total amount of exploration credits
for an income year is limited to the explorer’s maximum exploration credit
amount.
The explorer is liable
to pay excess exploration credit tax if the explorer issues exploration credits
in excess of that maximum exploration credit amount.
Note: Excess exploration credit tax
is imposed by the Excess Exploration Credit Tax Act 2015, and the amount
of the tax is set out in that Act.
Subdivision 418‑A—Object of this Division
Table of sections
418‑5 Object of this Division
418‑5 Object of this Division
The object of this
Division is to encourage investment in minerals exploration in Australia by allowing
the benefit of losses from minerals exploration to flow to shareholders who
share in the risk of the exploration.
Subdivision 418‑B—Exploration development incentive tax offset
Table of sections
Entitlement to exploration
development incentive tax offset
418‑10 Who is entitled to the
tax offset—ordinary case
418‑15 Who is entitled to the
tax offset—life insurance company
418‑20 Entitlement of member of
a trust or partnership to a share of exploration credits
Amount of exploration
development incentive tax offset
418‑25 The amount of the tax
offset
418‑30 Reduced amount of the tax
offset for certain trusts
Entitlement to
exploration development incentive tax offset
418‑10 Who is entitled to the tax
offset—ordinary case
You are entitled to a *tax offset for an income year if:
(a) an *exploration credit is issued to you under Subdivision 418‑E for
the income year; and
(b) you are not:
(i) a *corporate tax entity; or
(ii) a
trust (other than a trust in relation to which some or all of the liability of
the trustee to tax is provided under subsection 98(1) or (2) or 99(2) or
(3) of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936); or
(iii) a
partnership; or
(iv) an *exempt entity (other than an *exempt
institution that is eligible for a refund); and
(c) you are an
Australian resident during the whole of that income year.
418‑15 Who is entitled to the tax
offset—life insurance company
(1) An entity is entitled to
a *tax offset for an income year if:
(a) the entity is a *life insurance company; and
(b) an *exploration credit is issued to the entity under Subdivision 418‑E
for the income year; and
(c) the entity is an
Australian resident during the whole of that income year; and
(d) were the
exploration credit to be a *franked distribution
made:
(i) by
the same entity that issued the credit; and
(ii) in
the same circumstances in which the credit was issued;
the exploration
credit would be a distribution to which paragraph 207‑110(1)(b) would
apply.
(2) If:
(a) an *exploration credit is issued to a *life
insurance company; and
(b) paragraph (1)(d)
applies in relation to only part of the exploration credit;
this Division applies as if that part of
the exploration credit, and the part of the exploration credit in relation to
which that paragraph does not apply, were 2 separate exploration credits issued
to the life insurance company.
418‑20 Entitlement of member of a
trust or partnership to a share of exploration credits
Members taken to be issued with
exploration credits
(1) If:
(a) you are a *member of a trust or partnership during the income year; and
(b) an *exploration credit is issued to the trust or partnership under
Subdivision 418‑E for the income year; and
(c) the trust or
partnership is not a *corporate tax entity; and
(d) the trustee of the
trust, or the partnership, determines that you are entitled to a share of the
exploration credits issued to the trust or partnership for the income year; and
(e) the trustee of
the trust, or the partnership, gives you a statement, in accordance with subsection (4),
informing you of that entitlement;
you are taken, for the purposes of this
Subdivision, to have been issued with an exploration credit under Subdivision 418‑E,
for the income year, of an amount equal to your share of the exploration
credits issued to the trust or partnership for the income year.
Effect of restrictions on
distributions
(2) Despite subsection (1),
you are not taken, under that subsection, to have been issued with an *exploration credit under Subdivision 418‑E to the extent that,
if the exploration credit referred to in paragraph (1)(b) were a *franked distribution of the same amount made:
(a) at the time of
the determination referred to in paragraph (1)(d); and
(b) in relation to
the interest, held by the trust or partnership, in relation to which the
exploration credit referred to in paragraph (1)(b) is issued to the trust
or partnership during the income year;
the terms and conditions under which the
trust or partnership operates would not permit you to be paid the amount, or the
proportion, of the franked distribution that would reflect your entitlement
referred to in paragraph (1)(d).
Anti‑avoidance
(3) Despite subsection (1),
you are not taken, under that subsection, to have been issued with an *exploration credit under Subdivision 418‑E to the extent that,
if the exploration credit were a distribution to you, from the trust or
partnership, of a *franked distribution that:
(a) was of the same
amount as the amount of your share, referred to in paragraph (1)(d), of
the exploration credit referred to in paragraph (1)(b); and
(b) was made:
(i) by
the same entity that issued that exploration credit; and
(ii) in
relation to the same interest in that entity; and
(iii) in
the same circumstances in which that exploration credit was issued; and
(c) *flowed indirectly through one or more trusts or partnerships that
were the same as the one or more trusts or partnerships that, apart from
subparagraphs 418‑10(b)(ii) and (iii), would have been entitled to a *tax offset under this Subdivision in relation to:
(i) that
exploration credit; or
(ii) another
exploration credit from which that exploration credit is directly or indirectly
derived;
you would not be entitled to a tax offset
under Division 207 in relation to the franked distribution.
Statements to members
(4) A statement referred to
in paragraph (1)(e) must:
(a) be in the *approved form; and
(b) be given to you
on or before the due date:
(i) if
the trust or partnership is an *investment body for *Part VA investments—for giving to the Commissioner an *annual investment income report in respect of the *financial year corresponding to the income year; or
(ii) otherwise—for
the trust or partnership to lodge its *income tax return
for the income year.
Reports to the Commissioner
(5) A trust or partnership
that has given one or more statements under paragraph (1)(e) relating to *exploration credits for an income year must give to the
Commissioner, on or before the due date referred to in paragraph (4)(b) in
relation to that income year, a report that:
(a) relates to all
the statements that the trust or partnership has given under paragraph (1)(e)
relating to exploration credits for that income year; and
(b) is in the *approved form.
Amount of exploration
development incentive tax offset
418‑25 The amount of the tax offset
The amount of your *tax offset under this Subdivision for an income year is the sum of:
(a) all the *exploration credits issued to you under Subdivision 418‑E; and
(b) all the exploration
credits taken under section 418‑20 to have been issued to you;
for the income year.
418‑30 Reduced amount of the tax
offset for certain trusts
(1) If an entity is a trust
in relation to which some, but not all, of the liability of the trustee to tax
is provided under subsection 98(1) or (2) or 99(2) or (3) of the Income
Tax Assessment Act 1936, the amount of the entity’s *tax offset under this Subdivision for an income year is:

where:
income taxed under subsection 98(1)
or (2) or 99(2) or (3) is the amount of the *net income of the trust, for the income year, in relation to which
the trustee is liable to tax under subsection 98(1) or (2) or 99(2) or (3)
of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936.
(2) If:
(a) an entity is a
trust; and
(b) one or more *members of the trust are taken under section 418‑20 to have
been issued with one or more *exploration credits for
an income year;
the amount of the entity’s *tax offset, under section 418‑25 or subsection (1) of this
section, for the income year is reduced by the sum of amounts of the
exploration credits taken to be issued to those members.
Subdivision 418‑C—Exploration development incentive franking credit
Table of sections
418‑50 Exploration development
incentive franking credit—ordinary case
418‑55 Exploration development
incentive franking credit—life insurance company
418‑50 Exploration development
incentive franking credit—ordinary case
(1) A *franking credit arises in the *franking
account of a *corporate tax entity (other than a *life insurance company) if:
(a) an *exploration credit is issued to the entity under Subdivision 418‑E
during an income year; and
(b) if the entity
were not a corporate tax entity, the entity would be entitled to a *tax offset under Subdivision 418‑B in relation to the
exploration credit.
(2) The amount of the *franking credit is the amount of the *tax
offset to which the entity would be entitled under Subdivision 418‑B if:
(a) the entity were
not a *corporate tax entity; and
(b) no other *exploration credits were issued to the entity during the income
year.
(3) The *franking credit arises at the same time the *exploration
credit is issued.
418‑55 Exploration development
incentive franking credit—life insurance company
(1) A *franking credit arises in the *franking
account of a *life insurance company if:
(a) an *exploration credit is issued to the life insurance company under
Subdivision 418‑E during an income year; and
(b) paragraph 418‑15(1)(d)
does not apply in relation to the exploration credit; and
(c) if that paragraph
were to apply in relation to the credit, the life insurance company would be
entitled to a *tax offset under Subdivision 418‑B in
relation to the exploration credit.
(2) The amount of the *franking credit is the amount of the *tax
offset to which the *life insurance company would be
entitled under Subdivision 418‑B if no other *exploration
credits were issued to the life insurance company during the income year.
(3) The *franking credit arises at the same time the *exploration
credit is issued.
Subdivision 418‑D—Creating exploration credits
Table
of sections
418‑70 Entities that may create
exploration credits
418‑75 Meaning of greenfields
minerals explorer
418‑80 Meaning of greenfields
minerals expenditure
418‑85 Exploration credits must
not exceed maximum exploration credit amount
418‑90 Modulation factors
418‑95 Effect on tax losses of
creating exploration credits
418‑70 Entities that may create
exploration credits
(1) An entity may create exploration
credits for an income year if:
(a) the entity was a *greenfields minerals explorer in the previous income year; and
(b) on or before 30 September
in the *financial year corresponding to the income
year, the entity has given to the Commissioner, in the *approved
form, a declaration stating:
(i) their
estimated *tax loss for the previous income year; and
(ii) their
estimated *greenfields minerals expenditure, for the
previous income year.
(2) However, the entity
cannot create the exploration credits:
(a) before the
legislative instrument under section 418‑90 declaring the modulation
factor for the income year has been registered under Division 2 of Part 4
of the Legislative Instruments Act 2003; or
(b) for the 2018‑19
income year or a later income year.
(3) A failure to comply with
subsection (1) or paragraph (2)(a) does not invalidate the creation
of an *exploration credit.
(4) An *exploration credit is to be expressed as a monetary amount.
(5) The entity cannot make
more than one decision to create *exploration credits for
an income year, and the decision is final and irrevocable.
418‑75 Meaning of greenfields
minerals explorer
(1) An entity is a greenfields
minerals explorer in an income year if:
(a) the entity has *greenfields minerals expenditure for the income year; and
(b) during the income
year, the entity is a disclosing entity (within the meaning of section 111AC
of the Corporations Act 2001); and
(c) during the income
year, the entity is a *constitutional
corporation; and
(d) during the income
year, and during the immediately preceding income year, neither:
(i) the
entity; nor
(ii) any
other entity that is *connected with or is an *affiliate of the entity;
carried on any
mining operations on a mining property for extracting *minerals
(except *petroleum) from their natural site, for
the *purpose of producing assessable income.
(2) However, an entity is
not a greenfields minerals explorer in an income year in which
either or both of the following happens, or in any subsequent income year:
(a) the entity fails
to comply with a request of the Commissioner under subsection 418‑80(5);
(b) a determination
under section 418‑185 has effect.
Note 1: Under subsection 418‑80(5),
the Commissioner may request a report on an area in relation to which an entity
has greenfields minerals expenditure.
Note 2: Under section 418‑185,
the Commissioner may determine that an entity that is, or has been, liable to
excess exploration credit tax is not to be treated as a greenfields minerals
explorer.
418‑80 Meaning of greenfields
minerals expenditure
(1) An entity’s greenfields
minerals expenditure for an income year is the sum of:
(a) the amounts of
any deductions to which the entity is entitled under section 40‑25 for
that income year in relation to declines in value that:
(i) are
declines in value of *depreciating assets used for *exploration or prospecting for *minerals
in an area to which subsection (3) of this section applies; and
(ii) are
worked out under subsection 40‑80(1); and
(b) the amounts of
any deductions for that income year to which the entity is entitled in relation
to expenditure:
(i) that
is of a kind referred to in subsection 40‑730(1); and
(ii) in
relation to which the entity satisfies one or more of paragraphs 40‑730(1)(a)
to (c); and
(iii) that
is expenditure on exploration or prospecting for minerals in an area to which subsection (3)
of this section applies.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1),
disregard a deduction to the extent that it relates to:
(a) matters other
than:
(i) declines
in value of *depreciating assets used for; or
(ii) expenditure
on;
*exploration
or prospecting for *minerals in an area to which subsection (3)
of this section applies; or
(b) exploration or
prospecting for *petroleum or oil shale; or
(c) activities (such
as feasibility studies) undertaken to identify the viability of a mineral
resource rather than its existence.
(3) This subsection applies
to an area:
(a) that is in
Australia; and
(b) in relation to
which the entity *holds a *mining,
quarrying or prospecting right at the time of incurring the expenditure; and
(c) that has not been
identified as containing a mineral resource that is at least inferred in a
report prepared in accordance with the requirements of:
(i) unless
subparagraph (ii) applies—the document that is known as the Australasian
Code for Reporting of Exploration Results, Minerals Resources and Ore Reserves
and that took effect on 20 December 2012; or
Note: This document is commonly
referred to as the JORC Code (2012 Edition).
(ii) such
other document as the regulations prescribe; and
(d) that is not, and
is not in, any of the following:
(i) the
coastal sea of Australia (within the meaning of subsection 15B(4) of the Acts
Interpretation Act 1901);
(ii) an
offshore area for the purpose of the Offshore Petroleum and Greenhouse Gas
Storage Act 2006;
(iii) the
Joint Petroleum Development Area (within the meaning of the Petroleum (Timor
Sea Treaty) Act 2003).
Note: An offshore area and the Joint
Petroleum Development Area include the territorial sea, the exclusive economic
zone and the continental shelf of Australia.
(4) For the purposes of paragraph (3)(c),
disregard any mineral resource, identified in a report of a kind referred to in
that paragraph, that does not include *minerals the
exploration or prospecting for which involved:
(a) use of assets
referred to in paragraph (1)(a); or
(b) expenditure
referred to in paragraph (1)(b).
(5) The Commissioner may
request an entity that is a *greenfields minerals
explorer in an income year to prepare, within the period specified in the
request, a report that:
(a) is of the kind
referred to in paragraph (3)(c); and
(b) relates to an
area in relation to which the entity has *greenfields
minerals expenditure for the income year.
The request may specify the manner in
which, and the form in which, the report is to be prepared.
418‑85 Exploration credits must not
exceed maximum exploration credit amount
(1) An entity must not
create *exploration credits for an income year
(the current income year) of a total amount that exceeds the
entity’s *maximum exploration credit amount for the
income year.
(2) The entity’s maximum
exploration credit amount for the current income year is worked out as
follows:
Method
statement
Step 1. Ascertain
which of the following is the smallest amount:
(a) the
entity’s estimated *tax loss for the previous income
year, as stated in the entity’s declaration under paragraph 418‑70(1)(b);
(b) the
entity’s actual tax loss for the previous income year;
(c) the
entity’s estimated *greenfields minerals expenditure
for the previous income year, as stated in the entity’s declaration under
paragraph 418‑70(1)(b);
(d) the
entity’s actual greenfields minerals expenditure for the previous income year.
Step 2. Multiply
that smallest amount by the *corporate tax rate
applying to the previous income year.
Step 3. Multiply
the result of step 2 by the modulation factor declared under section 418‑90
for the current income year. The result of this step is the entity’s maximum
exploration credit amount for the current income year.
(3) In working out the
entity’s actual *tax loss for the previous income year for
the purposes of step 1 of the method statement in subsection (2), reduce
that tax loss by the sum of:
(a) all *recoupments that the entity receives in relation to the entity’s *greenfields minerals expenditure for the previous income year; and
(b) any part of the
entity’s tax loss for the previous income year that would not be deductible in
the current income year; and
(c) if:
(i) an
amount has been included in the entity’s assessable income because a *balancing adjustment event occurs for a *depreciating
asset; and
(ii) all
or part of the amount of the deduction to which the entity is entitled under
section 40‑25 for the previous income year in relation to the decline in
value of the asset is included in the entity’s greenfields minerals expenditure
for that income year;
so much of the
amount of that deduction as was included in that greenfields minerals expenditure.
(4) For the purposes of paragraph (3)(b),
assume that the entity’s assessable income for the current income year is
sufficient to allow the entity to utilise the whole of that tax loss in
relation to the current income year.
(5) In working out the
entity’s actual *greenfields minerals expenditure for the
previous income year for the purposes of step 1 of the method statement in subsection (2),
reduce that greenfields minerals expenditure by the sum of:
(a) all *recoupments that the entity receives in relation to the entity’s
greenfields minerals expenditure for the previous income year; and
(b) if:
(i) an
amount has been included in the entity’s assessable income because a *balancing adjustment event occurs for a *depreciating
asset; and
(ii) all
or part of the amount of the deduction to which the entity is entitled under
section 40‑25 for the previous income year in relation to the decline in
value of the asset is included in the entity’s greenfields minerals expenditure
for that income year;
so much of the
amount of that deduction as was included in that greenfields minerals
expenditure.
(6) A failure to comply with
this section does not invalidate the creation of an *exploration
credit.
418‑90 Modulation factors
(1) The Commissioner must,
by legislative instrument, declare modulation factors in accordance with this
section for each of the following:
(a) the 2015‑16
income year;
(b) the 2016‑17
income year;
(c) the 2017‑18
income year.
(2) The modulation factor
for an income year is to be one if the Commissioner is satisfied that the total
amount of *exploration credits that could be created
in respect of that income year will not exceed the following amount (the exploration
credit cap) for the income year:
(a) for the 2015‑16
income year—$25 million;
(b) for the 2016‑17
income year—$35 million;
(c) for the 2017‑18
income year—$40 million.
(3) If subsection (2)
does not apply, the modulation factor for the income year is to be such a
number as the Commissioner is satisfied would reduce the total amount of *exploration credits that could be created in that income year to the
exploration credit cap for the income year.
(4) In ascertaining for the
purposes of subsection (2) or (3) the total amount of *exploration credits that could be created in an income year (the current
income year), the Commissioner is to:
(a) use the
information provided in declarations under paragraph 418‑70(1)(b) for the
previous income year; and
(b) disregard the
possible application of any modulation factor.
(5) A failure to comply with
subsection (2), (3) or (4) does not invalidate the declaration of a
modulation factor for an income year.
(6) A declaration made under
subsection (1) is a legislative instrument, but section 42
(disallowance) of the Legislative Instruments Act 2003 does not apply to
the declaration.
418‑95 Effect on tax losses of
creating exploration credits
(1) If an entity creates any
*exploration credits in respect of a *loss
year, the amount of the entity’s *tax loss for the loss
year is reduced by the amount worked out as follows:

(2) However, if the amount
worked out under subsection (1) equals or exceeds what would (apart from
this section) be the entity’s *tax loss for the *loss year, that tax loss is taken to be nil.
Subdivision 418‑E—Issuing exploration credits
Table of sections
418‑110 Issuing exploration
credits
418‑115 Restricting exploration
credits to post 1 July 2014 shares
418‑120 Exploration credits to be
issued on a proportionate basis
418‑125 Expiry of exploration credits
418‑130 Notifying the Commissioner
of issuing or expiry of exploration credits
418‑110 Issuing exploration credits
(1) An entity that has
created *exploration credits for an income year may
issue any of those exploration credits to *members
of the entity, in respect of *shares that:
(a) are*equity interests; and
(b) are held by the
members.
(2) The *exploration credits are issued by giving each of the *members a statement in the *approved form.
(3) The issuing of *exploration credits is of no effect unless:
(a) the statements
under subsection (2) are given to the *members
on or before the first 30 June after the day on which the modulation
factor in respect of the income year is declared under section 418‑90; and
(b) the issuing of
credits complies with section 418‑120.
418‑115 Restricting exploration
credits to post 1 July 2014 shares
(1) An entity may, before it
has issued any *exploration credits for any income year,
choose to restrict the issuing of exploration credits to issuing exploration
credits in relation to *shares that:
(a) are*equity interests; and
(b) have come into
existence on or after 1 July 2014.
(2) A choice under this
section is irrevocable.
418‑120 Exploration credits to be
issued on a proportionate basis
(1) An entity issuing *exploration credits for an income year must ensure that the total
number of exploration credits issued to any *member
of the entity for the year, expressed as a percentage of the total number of
all exploration credits issued to the members of the entity for the year, is
the same as:
(a) if the entity has
made a choice under section 418‑115—the total number of *shares in the entity that:
(i) are *equity interests held by the member; and
(ii) have
come into existence on or after 1 July 2014;
expressed as a
percentage of the total number of the shares in the entity that:
(iii) are
equity interests held by any members of the entity; and
(iv) have
come into existence on or after that day; or
(b) otherwise—the
total number of shares in the entity that are equity interests held by the
member, expressed as a percentage of the total number of the shares in the
entity that are equity interests held by any members of the entity.
(2) For the purposes of this
section, the number of *shares that a *member holds in the entity is taken to be the number that the member
held on the day occurring 30 days before the *exploration
credits were issued.
418‑125 Expiry of exploration
credits
An *exploration credit created by an entity for an income year expires
if the entity does not issue the credit under this Subdivision on or before the
first 30 June after the day on which the modulation factor in respect of
the income year is declared under section 418‑90.
418‑130 Notifying the Commissioner
of issuing or expiry of exploration credits
(1) An entity that has
created *exploration credits for an income year
must notify the Commissioner of the issuing or expiry of the credits.
(2) The notice must:
(a) be in the *approved form; and
(b) be given to the
Commissioner on or before the due date:
(i) if
the entity is an *investment body for *Part VA investments—for giving to the Commissioner an *annual investment income report in respect of the *financial year corresponding to the income year; or
(ii) otherwise—for
the entity to lodge its *income tax return for
the income year.
Subdivision 418‑F—Excess exploration credits
Table of sections
418‑150 Excess exploration credit
tax
418‑155 Due date for payment of
excess exploration credit tax
418‑160 Returns
418‑165 When shortfall interest
charge is payable
418‑170 General interest charge
418‑175 Refunds of amounts
overpaid
418‑180 Record keeping
418‑185 Determining an entity not
to be a greenfields minerals explorer
418‑150 Excess exploration credit
tax
An entity is liable to
pay *excess exploration credit tax for an
income year if the sum of the *exploration credits it
issues for the income year exceeds the entity’s *maximum
exploration credit amount for the income year.
Note: The tax is imposed by the Excess
Exploration Credit Tax Act 2014, and the amount of the tax is set out in
that Act.
418‑155 Due date for payment of
excess exploration credit tax
An entity’s *excess exploration credit tax for an income year, as assessed under
Schedule 1 to the Taxation Administration Act 1953, is due and
payable at the end of the day by which the entity is required under section 418‑160
to give the return relating to the income year.
Note: For assessments of excess
exploration credit tax, see Division 155 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation
Administration Act 1953.
418‑160 Returns
An entity that is
liable to pay *excess exploration credit tax for an
income year must give the Commissioner a return relating to excess exploration
credit tax, in the *approved form, within 21 days
after the end of the *financial year corresponding to
the income year.
418‑165 When shortfall interest
charge is payable
An amount of *shortfall interest charge that an entity is liable to pay is due and
payable 21 days after the day on which the Commissioner gives the entity notice
of the charge.
Note: Shortfall interest charge is
imposed if the Commissioner amends an assessment and the amended assessment
results in an increase in some tax payable. For provisions about liability for
shortfall interest charge, see Division 280 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation
Administration Act 1953.
418‑170 General interest charge
If:
(a) *excess exploration credit tax or *shortfall
interest charge payable by an entity remains unpaid after the time by which it
is due and payable; and
(b) the
Commissioner has not allocated the unpaid amount to an *RBA;
the entity is liable to pay the *general interest charge on the unpaid amount for each day in the
period that:
(c) starts at the
beginning of the day on which the excess exploration credit tax or shortfall
interest charge was due to be paid; and
(d) ends at the end
of the last day on which, at the end of the day, any of the following remains
unpaid:
(i) the
excess exploration credit tax or shortfall interest charge;
(ii) general
interest charge on any of the excess exploration credit tax or shortfall interest
charge.
Note: The general interest charge
is worked out under Part IIA of the Taxation Administration Act 1953.
418‑175 Refunds of amounts overpaid
Section 172 of the
Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 applies for the purposes of this Division
as if references in that section to tax included references to *excess exploration credit tax.
418‑180 Record keeping
Section 262A of
the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 applies for the purposes of this
Division as if:
(a) the reference in
that section to a person carrying on a business were a reference to a *corporate tax entity; and
(b) the reference in paragraph (2)(a)
of that section to the person’s income and expenditure were a reference to the
entity’s liability to pay *excess exploration
credit tax; and
(c) paragraph (5)(a)
of that section were omitted.
418‑185 Determining an entity not to
be a greenfields minerals explorer
(1) The Commissioner may
determine, by written notice given to an entity that is, or has been, liable to
pay *excess exploration credit tax for an
income year, that the entity is no longer to be treated as a *greenfields minerals explorer.
(2) The determination takes
effect from:
(a) if, at the time
the notice is given, the entity has not issued any *exploration
credits for the income year in which the notice is given—that income year; or
(b) otherwise—the
next income year.
(3) If the entity or a *member of the entity is dissatisfied with a determination under subsection (1),
the entity or member may object to it in the manner set out in Part IVC of
the Taxation Administration Act 1953.
Part 3‑50—Climate change
Division 420—Registered emissions units
Table of Subdivisions
Guide to Division 420
420‑A Registered emissions units
420‑B Acquiring registered
emissions units
420‑C Disposing of registered
emissions units etc.
420‑D Accounting for registered
emissions units you hold at the start or end of the income year
420‑E Exclusivity of Division
Guide to Division 420
420‑1 What this Division is about
This
Division deals with amounts you can deduct, and amounts included in your
assessable income, because of these situations:
• you
acquire a registered emissions unit;
• you hold a
registered emissions unit at the start or the end of the income year;
• you
dispose of a registered emissions unit.
Table
of sections
420‑5 The 4 key features of
tax accounting for registered emissions units
420‑5 The 4 key features of tax
accounting for registered emissions units
The purpose of income
tax accounting for registered emissions units is to produce the same tax
treatment, irrespective of your purpose in acquiring or holding the registered
emissions units.
There are 4 key
features:
(1) You bring your gross
expenditure and gross proceeds to account, not your net profits and losses on
disposal of a registered emissions unit.
(2) The gross expenditure is
deductible.
(3) The gross proceeds are
assessable income.
(4) You must bring to
account any difference between the value of your registered emissions units
held at the start and at the end of the income year. This is done in such a way
that:
(a) any increase in
value is included in assessable income; and
(b) any decrease in
value is a deduction.
Subdivision 420‑A—Registered emissions units
Table of sections
420‑10 Meaning of registered emissions unit
420‑12 Meaning of hold a registered emissions unit
420‑10 Meaning of registered
emissions unit
A registered emissions unit is:
(b) a *Kyoto unit; or
(d) an *Australian carbon credit unit;
for which there is an entry in a Registry
account (within the meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions
Units Act 2011).
420‑12 Meaning of hold a
registered emissions unit
(1) You hold a
*registered emissions unit if you are the entity in whose Registry
account (within the meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions
Units Act 2011) there is an entry for the unit.
(2) However, if the entity
(the nominee entity) in whose Registry account (within the
meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011)
there is an entry for a *registered emissions
unit holds the unit as nominee for another entity:
(a) the other entity
is taken to hold the unit; and
(b) the nominee
entity is taken not to hold the unit.
Subdivision 420‑B—Acquiring registered emissions units
Table of sections
420‑15 What you can deduct
420‑20 Non‑arm’s length
transactions and transactions with associates
420‑21 Incoming international
transfers of emissions units
420‑22 Becoming taxable in
Australia on the proceeds of sale of registered emissions units
420‑15 What you can deduct
(1) You can deduct
expenditure to the extent that you incur it in becoming the *holder of a *registered emissions
unit.
Timing
(2) You deduct the
expenditure in the income year in which you start to *hold
the *registered emissions unit.
Australian carbon credit units
(4) You cannot deduct under
this section expenditure you incur in becoming the *holder
of an *Australian carbon credit unit issued to
you in accordance with the Carbon Credits (Carbon Farming Initiative) Act
2011 unless you incur the expenditure in preparing or lodging:
(a) an application
for a certificate of entitlement (within the meaning of that Act); or
(b) an offsets report
(within the meaning of that Act).
No deduction if sale proceeds would
not be assessable
(5) You cannot deduct under
this section expenditure you incur in becoming the *holder
of a *registered emissions unit if, assuming
that you had sold the unit to someone else immediately after you started to *hold the unit, the proceeds of the sale would not have been included
in your assessable income under section 420‑25.
Note: Under the International
Tax Agreements Act 1953, for some foreign residents, the proceeds of the
sale of a registered emissions unit are not assessable income in Australia.
420‑20 Non‑arm’s length transactions
and transactions with associates
(1) If:
(a) an entity becomes
the *holder of a *registered
emissions unit; and
(b) either:
(i) the
entity and the previous holder of the unit did not deal with each other at *arm’s length; or
(ii) the
previous holder is the entity’s *associate; and
(c) the entity did
not pay or give consideration equal to the *market
value of the unit for becoming the holder of the unit;
the entity is treated as if:
(d) the entity had
incurred expenditure in becoming the holder of the unit; and
(e) the amount of the
expenditure were equal to that market value.
(2) This section does not
apply if a *registered emissions unit *held by an individual just before the individual’s death:
(a) devolves to the
individual’s *legal personal representative; or
(b) *passes to a beneficiary in the individual’s estate.
(3) This section does not
apply to the issue of an *Australian carbon credit
unit under the Carbon Credits (Carbon Farming Initiative) Act 2011.
420‑21 Incoming international
transfers of emissions units
Unit held as trading stock or as a revenue
asset
(1) If:
(a) any of the
following conditions is satisfied:
(iii) a *Kyoto unit is transferred from your foreign account (within the
meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011)
to your Registry account (within the meaning of that Act) or your nominee’s
Registry account (within the meaning of that Act);
(iv) a
Kyoto unit is transferred from your nominee’s foreign account (within the
meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011)
to your Registry account (within the meaning of that Act) or your nominee’s
Registry account (within the meaning of that Act);
(v) an *Australian carbon credit unit is transferred from your foreign
account (within the meaning of the Carbon Credits (Carbon Farming Initiative)
Act 2011) to your Registry account (within the meaning of the Australian
National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011) or your nominee’s Registry
account (within the meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions
Units Act 2011);
(vi) an
Australian carbon credit unit is transferred from your nominee’s foreign
account (within the meaning of the Carbon Credits (Carbon Farming
Initiative) Act 2011) to your Registry account (within the meaning of the Australian
National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011) or your nominee’s Registry
account (within the meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions
Units Act 2011); and
(b) as a result of
the transfer, you start to *hold the unit as a *registered emissions unit; and
(c) just before the
transfer, the unit was your *trading stock or *revenue asset;
you are treated as if:
(d) just before the
transfer, you had sold the unit to someone else for its *cost; and
(e) you had,
immediately after the sale, bought it back as a registered emissions unit for
the same amount.
Example: An Australian resident company
carries on a business of trading in emissions units. The units are trading
stock. The company owns 10,000 emission reduction units (a type of Kyoto unit)
that are registered in New Zealand. 5,000 of those emission reduction units are
transferred from the company’s New Zealand registry account to the company’s
Australian registry account.
The company is treated as
having sold each unit to someone else at its cost just before it became a
registered emissions unit. As the unit was previously held as trading stock,
the unit ceases to be trading stock (section 70‑12). The cost of the unit
just before it became a registered emissions unit is included in the company’s
assessable income.
The company is also
treated as having bought 5,000 registered emissions units for the same amount.
The company is entitled to a deduction for that amount (section 420‑15).
Unit held otherwise than as trading
stock or as a revenue asset
(2) If:
(a) any of the
following conditions is satisfied:
(iii) a *Kyoto unit is transferred from your foreign account (within the
meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011)
to your Registry account (within the meaning of that Act) or your nominee’s
Registry account (within the meaning of that Act);
(iv) a
Kyoto unit is transferred from your nominee’s foreign account (within the
meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011)
to your Registry account (within the meaning of that Act) or your nominee’s
Registry account (within the meaning of that Act);
(v) an *Australian carbon credit unit is transferred from your foreign
account (within the meaning of the Carbon Credits (Carbon Farming
Initiative) Act 2011) to your Registry account (within the meaning of the Australian
National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011) or your nominee’s Registry
account (within the meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions
Units Act 2011);
(vi) an
Australian carbon credit unit is transferred from your nominee’s foreign
account (within the meaning of the Carbon Credits (Carbon Farming
Initiative) Act 2011) to your Registry account (within the meaning of the Australian
National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011) or your nominee’s Registry
account (within the meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions
Units Act 2011); and
(b) as a result of
the transfer, you start to *hold the unit as a *registered emissions unit; and
(c) just before the
transfer, the unit was neither your *trading stock nor
your *revenue asset;
you are treated as if:
(d) just before the
transfer, you had sold the unit to someone else for its *market value just before the transfer; and
(e) you had,
immediately after the sale, bought it back as a registered emissions unit for
the same amount.
420‑22 Becoming taxable in Australia
on the proceeds of sale of registered emissions units
If:
(a) you start to *hold a *registered emissions unit at a particular
time; and
(b) assuming that you
had sold the unit to someone else immediately after you started to hold the
unit, the proceeds of the sale would not have been included in your assessable
income under section 420‑25; and
(c) you hold the unit
until a later time (the taxable status commencement time), where
the following conditions are satisfied:
(i) assuming
that you had sold the unit to someone else immediately before the taxable
status commencement time, the proceeds of the sale would not have been included
in your assessable income under section 420‑25;
(ii) assuming
that you had sold the unit to someone else at the taxable status commencement
time, the proceeds of the sale would have been included in your assessable
income under section 420‑25;
you are treated as if:
(d) immediately after
the taxable status commencement time, you had bought the unit from someone else
for its *market value; and
(e) you had started
to hold the unit immediately after the taxable status commencement time instead
of at the time mentioned in paragraph (a).
Note: Under the International
Tax Agreements Act 1953, for some foreign residents, the proceeds of the
sale of a registered emissions unit are not assessable income in Australia.
Subdivision 420‑C—Disposing of registered emissions units etc.
Table
of sections
420‑25 Assessable income on
disposal of registered emissions units
420‑30 Non‑arm’s length
transactions and transactions with associates
420‑35 Outgoing international
transfers of emissions units
420‑40 Disposal of registered
emissions units for a purpose other than gaining assessable income
420‑41 Ceasing to be taxable in
Australia on the proceeds of sale of registered emissions units
420‑42 Deduction for expenses
incurred in ceasing to hold a registered emissions unit
420‑25 Assessable income on disposal
of registered emissions units
(1) Your
assessable income includes an amount that you are entitled to receive because
you cease to *hold a *registered
emissions unit.
Timing
(2) The amount is included
in your assessable income for the income year in which you cease to *hold the unit.
Source
(3) An amount included in
your assessable income under subsection (1) is taken, for the purposes of
the *income tax laws, to have a source in
Australia.
420‑30 Non‑arm’s length transactions
and transactions with associates
If:
(a) an entity (the transferor)
ceases to *hold a *registered
emissions unit; and
(b) the cessation is
because of the transfer of the unit to:
(i) a
Registry account (within the meaning of the Australian National Registry of
Emissions Units Act 2011); or
(ii) a
foreign account (within the meaning of that Act);
kept by another
entity (the transferee); and
(c) either:
(i) the
transferor and the transferee did not deal with each other at *arm’s length; or
(ii) the
transferee is the transferor’s *associate; and
(d) the transferee
did not pay or give consideration equal to the *market
value of the unit for the transfer of the unit;
the transferor is treated as if the
transferor were entitled to receive an amount equal to that market value
because the transferor ceased to be the holder of the unit.
420‑35 Outgoing international
transfers of emissions units
If:
(a) you stop *holding a *registered emissions unit; and
(b) you do so as a
result of the transfer of the unit to:
(ii) if
the unit is a *Kyoto unit—your foreign account (within
the meaning of the Australian National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011)
or your nominee’s foreign account (within the meaning of that Act); or
(iii) if
the unit is an *Australian carbon credit unit—your foreign
account (within the meaning of the Carbon Credits (Carbon Farming
Initiative) Act 2011) or your nominee’s foreign account (within the meaning
of that Act);
you are treated as if:
(c) just before the
transfer, you had sold the unit to someone else for its *market value just before the transfer; and
(d) you had,
immediately after the sale, bought it back for the same amount.
Example: An Australian resident company
carries on a business of trading in emission units. The company owns 10,000
emission reduction units (a type of Kyoto unit) that are registered in
Australia. 5,000 of those units are transferred from the company’s Australian
registry account to the company’s New Zealand registry account.
The company is treated as
having sold each unit to someone else at its market value just before it
stopped being a registered emissions unit. As the unit was a registered
emissions unit, the market value is included in the company’s assessable income
(section 420‑25).
The company is also treated
as having bought 5,000 emission reduction units for the same amount. As those
units are trading stock, the company may be able to deduct that amount under
section 8‑1.
420‑40 Disposal of registered
emissions units for a purpose other than gaining assessable income
(1) If:
(a) an entity (the first
entity) incurs expenditure in:
(i) becoming
the *holder of a *registered
emissions unit; or
(ii) ceasing
to hold a registered emissions unit; and
(b) the first entity
has deducted or can deduct the expenditure under section 420‑15 or 420‑42;
and
(c) the first entity
ceases to hold the unit in a particular income year; and
(d) the cessation is
neither:
(i) in
gaining or producing the first entity’s assessable income; nor
(ii) in
carrying on a *business for the purpose of gaining or
producing the first entity’s assessable income; and
(e) section 420‑30
(non‑arm’s length transactions and transactions with associates) did not apply
to the first entity ceasing to hold the unit;
the first entity’s assessable income for
that income year includes an amount equal to the amount the first entity has
deducted or can deduct.
Death
(2) If:
(a) the first entity
is an individual; and
(b) the cessation is
because of the first entity’s death; and
(c) the *registered emissions unit devolves to the first entity’s *legal personal representative;
then:
(d) the first
entity’s legal personal representative is treated as having bought the unit for
the amount included in the first entity’s assessable income under subsection (1);
and
(e) if the unit *passes to a beneficiary in the first entity’s estate:
(i) the
first entity’s legal personal representative is treated as having disposed of
the unit for the amount included in the first entity’s assessable income under subsection (1);
and
(ii) the
beneficiary is treated as having bought the unit for the amount included in the
first entity’s assessable income under subsection (1).
(3) If:
(a) the first entity
is an individual; and
(b) the cessation is
because of the first entity’s death; and
(c) the *registered emissions unit *passes to a
beneficiary in the first entity’s estate without devolving to the first
entity’s *legal personal representative;
the beneficiary is treated as having
bought the unit for the amount included in the first entity’s assessable income
under subsection (1).
Transfer—treatment of acquirer
(4) If:
(a) the cessation is
because of the transfer of the unit to another entity; and
(b) neither subsection (2)
nor (3) applies;
the other entity is treated as having
bought the unit for the amount included in the first entity’s assessable income
under subsection (1).
(5) If subsection (4)
applies to the transfer of the unit to another entity:
(a) the first entity
must inform the other entity that, as a result of subsection (4) applying,
the other entity is treated as having bought the unit for a particular amount;
and
(b) the first entity
must do so:
(i) at,
or as soon as practicable after, the time of the transfer; or
(ii) by a
later time allowed by the Commissioner.
Source
(6) An amount included in
the first entity’s assessable income under subsection (1) is taken, for
the purposes of the *income tax laws, to have a source
in Australia.
420‑41 Ceasing to be taxable in
Australia on the proceeds of sale of registered emissions units
If:
(a) you start to *hold a *registered emissions unit; and
(b) assuming that you
had sold the unit to someone else immediately after you started to hold the unit,
the proceeds of sale would have been included in your assessable income under
section 420‑25; and
(c) you hold the unit
until a later time (the taxable status cessation time), where the
following conditions are satisfied:
(i) assuming
that you had sold the unit to someone else immediately before the taxable
status cessation time, the proceeds of the sale would have been included in
your assessable income under section 420‑25;
(ii) assuming
that you had sold the unit to someone else at the taxable status cessation
time, the proceeds of sale would not have been included in your assessable
income under section 420‑25;
you are treated as if:
(d) just before the
taxable status cessation time, you had sold the unit to someone else for its *market value; and
(e) you had, at the
taxable status cessation time, bought it back for the same amount.
Note: Under the International
Tax Agreements Act 1953, for some foreign residents, the proceeds of the
sale of a registered emissions unit are not assessable income in Australia.
420‑42 Deduction for expenses
incurred in ceasing to hold a registered emissions unit
(1) You can deduct
expenditure to the extent that you incur it in ceasing to *hold a *registered emissions unit.
Timing
(2) You deduct the
expenditure in the income year in which you cease to *hold
the *registered emissions unit.
Subdivision 420‑D—Accounting for registered emissions units you hold at the
start or end of the income year
Table of sections
420‑45 You include the value of
your registered emissions units in working out your assessable income and
deductions
420‑50 Value of registered
emissions units at start of income year
420‑51 Valuation methods
420‑52 FIFO cost method of
working out the value of units
420‑53 Actual cost method of
working out the value of units
420‑54 Market value method of
working out the value of units
420‑55 Valuation method for
first income year at the end of which you held registered emissions units
420‑57 Valuation method for
later income years at the end of which you held registered emissions units
420‑60 Cost of registered
emissions units
420‑45 You include the value of your
registered emissions units in working out your assessable income and deductions
(1) You compare:
(a) the *value of all *registered emissions
units you *held at the start of the income year; and
(b) the value of all
registered emissions units you held at the end of the income year.
Increase in value is included in
assessable income
(2) Your assessable income includes
any excess of the *value at the end of the income year over
the value at the start of the income year.
Decrease in value is a deduction
(3) On the other hand, you
can deduct any excess of the *value at the start of
the income year over the value at the end of the income year.
Source
(4) An amount included in
your assessable income under subsection (2) is taken, for the purposes of
the *income tax laws, to have a source in
Australia.
Disregard value of unit if sale
proceeds would not be assessable
(5) For the purposes of this
Subdivision, disregard the *value of a *registered emissions unit you *held
at the end of the income year if, assuming that you had sold the unit to
someone else immediately after you started to hold the unit, the proceeds of
the sale would not have been included in your assessable income under section 420‑25.
Note: Under the International
Tax Agreements Act 1953, for some foreign residents, the proceeds of the
sale of a registered emissions unit are not assessable income in Australia.
420‑50 Value of registered emissions
units at start of income year
(1) The value
of a *registered emissions unit you *held at the start of an income year is the same amount at which it
was taken into account under this Subdivision at the end of the last income
year.
(2) The value
of the unit is a nil amount if the unit was not taken into account under this
Subdivision at the end of the last income year.
420‑51 Valuation methods
The value
of a *registered emissions unit you *held at the end of an income year is worked out using one of the
following methods:
(a) the *FIFO cost method;
(b) the *actual cost method;
(c) the *market value method.
Sections 420‑55 and 420‑57 tell you
which method applies.
420‑52 FIFO cost method of working
out the value of units
The FIFO cost
method for working out the *value of the *registered emissions units you *held
at the end of an income year means that the value of the units is the *cost of the registered emissions units, and, for the purposes of the
application of this Subdivision to you for the income year:
(a) if any of the
registered emissions units are:
(ii) eligible
international emissions units (within the meaning of the Australian National
Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011); or
(iii) *Australian carbon credit units;
you must
account for those units on a first‑in first‑out basis; and
(c) if any of the
registered emissions units are *Kyoto units that are not
eligible international emissions units (within the meaning of the Australian
National Registry of Emissions Units Act 2011)—you must account for those
units on a first‑in first‑out basis.
420‑53 Actual cost method of working
out the value of units
The actual cost
method for working out the value of the *registered
emissions units you *held at the end of the income
year means that the value of the units is the *cost
of the units, and, for the purposes of the application of this Subdivision to
you for the income year, you must not account for any of those units on a first‑in
first‑out basis.
420‑54 Market value method of
working out the value of units
The market value
method for working out the value of the *registered
emissions units you *held at the end of the income
year means that the value of the units is the *market
value of the units at the end of the income year.
420‑55 Valuation method for first
income year at the end of which you held registered emissions units
Scope
(1) This section applies if:
(a) you *held one or more *registered emissions
units at the end of an income year; and
(b) the income year
is the first income year at the end of which you held one or more registered
emissions units.
Choice of method
(2) You may choose one of
the following methods:
(a) the *FIFO cost method;
(b) the *actual cost method;
(c) the *market value method;
for working out the value
of the *registered emissions units you *held at the end of the income year.
FIFO cost method applies if no choice
made
(3) If you do not make a
choice under subsection (2) for the income year, the value
of the *registered emissions units you *held at the end of the income year is worked out using the *FIFO cost method.
Time for making choice
(4) You must make a choice
under subsection (2) before you lodge your *income
tax return for the income year for which you make the choice.
No revocation of choice
(5) A choice made under subsection (2)
cannot be revoked.
420‑57 Valuation method for later
income years at the end of which you held registered emissions units
Scope
(1) This section applies if:
(a) you *held one or more *registered emissions
units at the end of an income year (the current income year); and
(b) the current
income year is not the first income year at the end of which you held one or
more registered emissions units.
Choice of method
(2) You may choose one of
the following methods:
(a) the *FIFO cost method;
(b) the *actual cost method;
(c) the *market value method;
for working out the value
of the *registered emissions units you *held at the end of the current income year.
Previous method applies if no choice
made
(3) If you do not make a
choice under subsection (2) for the current income year, the value
of the *registered emissions units you *held at the end of the current income year is worked out using the
method that applied to the most recent income year at the end of which you held
one or more registered emissions units.
Limitation on choice—before 2015‑16
income year
(4) If the current income
year is before the 2015‑16 income year, you must not make a choice under subsection (2)
for the current income year if you have previously made a choice under that
subsection for an earlier income year.
Limitation on choice—2015‑16 income
year or a later income year
(5) If the current income
year is:
(a) the 2015‑16
income year; or
(b) a later income
year;
you must not make a choice under subsection (2)
for the current income year unless:
(c) the same method
applied for each of the 4 most recent income years at the end of which you *held one or more *registered emissions
units; and
(d) the method
mentioned in paragraph (c) is different from the method to which your
choice for the current income year relates.
Limitation on choice—change from FIFO
cost method to actual cost method
(6) You must not choose
under subsection (2) the *actual cost method for
the current income year if the *FIFO cost method applied
for the most recent income year at the end of which you *held one or more *registered emissions
units.
Time for making choice
(7) You must make a choice
under subsection (2) before you lodge your *income
tax return for the income year for which you make the choice.
No revocation of choice
(8) A choice made under subsection (2)
cannot be revoked.
420‑60 Cost of registered emissions
units
Australian carbon credit units
(3) If an *Australian carbon credit unit was issued to you under the Carbon
Credits (Carbon Farming Initiative) Act 2011, the cost of the
unit is its *market value immediately after you began
to *hold the unit.
Other registered emissions units
(4) The cost
of a *registered emissions unit (other than an *Australian carbon credit unit to which subsection (3) applies)
is the total of the expenditure that you:
(a) incurred in
becoming the *holder of the unit; and
(b) can deduct under
section 420‑15.
Subdivision 420‑E—Exclusivity of Division
Table
of sections
420‑65 Exclusivity of deductions
etc.
420‑70 Exclusivity of assessable
income etc.
420‑65 Exclusivity of deductions
etc.
Expenditure incurred in becoming the
holder of a registered emissions unit
(1) You cannot deduct under
any provision of this Act outside this Division any expenditure to the extent
that you incur it in becoming the *holder of a *registered emissions unit.
(2) To the extent you incur
expenditure in becoming the *holder of a *registered emissions unit, the expenditure is not to be taken into
account in working out:
(a) an amount you can
deduct; or
(b) an amount
included in your assessable income;
under any provision of this Act outside
this Division.
Australian carbon credit units
(4) Subsections (1) and
(2) do not affect the application of a provision of this Act outside this
Division to expenditure you incur in becoming the *holder
of an *Australian carbon credit unit issued to
you in accordance with the Carbon Credits (Carbon Farming Initiative) Act
2011 if you do not incur the expenditure in preparing or lodging:
(a) an application
for a certificate of entitlement (within the meaning of that Act); or
(b) an offsets report
(within the meaning of that Act).
(5) Subsections (1) and
(2) do not affect the operation of Division 30 (deductions for gifts and
contributions).
Note: If you make a gift or
contribution, Division 30 applies in the normal way to determine whether
you can deduct the amount of the gift or contribution.
Expenditure incurred in ceasing to
hold a registered emissions unit
(6) You cannot deduct under
any provision of this Act outside this Division any expenditure to the extent
that you incur it in ceasing to *hold a *registered emissions unit.
420‑70 Exclusivity of assessable
income etc.
(1) An amount that you are
entitled to receive because you ceased to *hold
a *registered emissions unit is not to be:
(a) included in your
assessable income; or
(b) taken into
account in working out your assessable income; or
(c) taken into
account in working out an amount you can deduct;
under any provision of this Act outside
this Division.
(2) Subsection (1) does
not affect the operation of Division 6 so far as that Division provides
for the significance of residence or source for the assessability of ordinary
and statutory income.
Note: An amount included in your
assessable income under this Division may be ordinary or statutory income for
the purposes of Division 6.
Australian carbon credit units
(4) An amount is not to be
included in your assessable income under any provision of this Act outside this
Division because an *Australian carbon credit unit was
issued to you in accordance with the Carbon Credits (Carbon Farming
Initiative) Act 2011.
Note 1: A capital gain or capital loss
you make from a registered emissions unit is disregarded (subsection 118‑15(1)).
Note 2: A capital gain or capital loss
you make from a right to receive an Australian carbon credit unit is
disregarded (subsection 118‑15(3)).